diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'docs/docbook/projdoc')
37 files changed, 16475 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/ADS-HOWTO.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/ADS-HOWTO.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..c89a0e4f879 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/ADS-HOWTO.xml @@ -0,0 +1,167 @@ +<chapter id="ADS"> + +<chapterinfo> + &author.tridge; + &author.jelmer; + <pubdate>2002/2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Samba as a ADS domain member</title> + +<para> +This is a rough guide to setting up Samba 3.0 with kerberos authentication against a +Windows2000 KDC. +</para> + +<sect1> +<title>Setup your <filename>smb.conf</filename></title> + +<para>You must use at least the following 3 options in smb.conf:</para> + +<para><programlisting> + realm = YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM + security = ADS + encrypt passwords = yes +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +In case samba can't figure out your ads server using your realm name, use the +<command>ads server</command> option in <filename>smb.conf</filename>: +<programlisting> + ads server = your.kerberos.server +</programlisting> +</para> + +<note><para>You do *not* need a smbpasswd file, and older clients will + be authenticated as if <command>security = domain</command>, + although it won't do any harm + and allows you to have local users not in the domain. + I expect that the above required options will change soon when we get better + active directory integration.</para></note> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Setup your <filename>/etc/krb5.conf</filename></title> + +<para>Note: you will need the krb5 workstation, devel, and libs installed</para> + +<para>The minimal configuration for <filename>krb5.conf</filename> is:</para> + +<para><programlisting> + [realms] + YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM = { + kdc = your.kerberos.server + } +</programlisting></para> + +<para>Test your config by doing a <userinput>kinit +<replaceable>USERNAME</replaceable>@<replaceable>REALM</replaceable></userinput> and +making sure that your password is accepted by the Win2000 KDC. +</para> + +<note><para>The realm must be uppercase or you will get "Cannot find KDC for requested +realm while getting initial credentials" error </para></note> + +<note><para>Time between the two servers must be synchronized. You will get a +"kinit(v5): Clock skew too great while getting initial credentials" if the time +difference is more than five minutes. </para></note> + +<para> +You also must ensure that you can do a reverse DNS lookup on the IP +address of your KDC. Also, the name that this reverse lookup maps to +must either be the netbios name of the KDC (ie. the hostname with no +domain attached) or it can alternatively be the netbios name +followed by the realm. +</para> + +<para> +The easiest way to ensure you get this right is to add a +<filename>/etc/hosts</filename> entry mapping the IP address of your KDC to +its netbios name. If you don't get this right then you will get a +"local error" when you try to join the realm. +</para> + +<para> +If all you want is kerberos support in &smbclient; then you can skip +straight to <link linkend="ads-test-smbclient">Test with &smbclient;</link> now. +<link linkend="ads-create-machine-account">Creating a computer account</link> +and <link linkend="ads-test-server">testing your servers</link> +is only needed if you want kerberos support for &smbd; and &winbindd;. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1 id="ads-create-machine-account"> +<title>Create the computer account</title> + +<para> +As a user that has write permission on the Samba private directory +(usually root) run: +<programlisting> + <userinput>net join -U Administrator%password</userinput> +</programlisting> +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Possible errors</title> + +<para> +<variablelist> + <varlistentry><term>"ADS support not compiled in"</term> + <listitem><para>Samba must be reconfigured (remove config.cache) and recompiled + (make clean all install) after the kerberos libs and headers are installed. + </para></listitem></varlistentry> + + <varlistentry><term>net join prompts for user name</term> + <listitem><para>You need to login to the domain using <userinput>kinit + <replaceable>USERNAME</replaceable>@<replaceable>REALM</replaceable></userinput>. + <replaceable>USERNAME</replaceable> must be a user who has rights to add a machine + to the domain. </para></listitem></varlistentry> +</variablelist> +</para> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + +<sect1 id="ads-test-server"> +<title>Test your server setup</title> + +<para> +If the join was successful, you will see a new computer account with the +NetBIOS name of your Samba server in Active Directory (in the "Computers" +folder under Users and Computers. +</para> + +<para> +On a Windows 2000 client try <userinput>net use * \\server\share</userinput>. You should +be logged in with kerberos without needing to know a password. If +this fails then run <userinput>klist tickets</userinput>. Did you get a ticket for the +server? Does it have an encoding type of DES-CBC-MD5 ? +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1 id="ads-test-smbclient"> +<title>Testing with &smbclient;</title> + +<para> +On your Samba server try to login to a Win2000 server or your Samba +server using &smbclient; and kerberos. Use &smbclient; as usual, but +specify the <parameter>-k</parameter> option to choose kerberos authentication. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Notes</title> + +<para>You must change administrator password at least once after DC +install, to create the right encoding types</para> + +<para>w2k doesn't seem to create the _kerberos._udp and _ldap._tcp in + their defaults DNS setup. Maybe fixed in service packs?</para> +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/AdvancedNetworkAdmin.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/AdvancedNetworkAdmin.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..dc2a78f5a67 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/AdvancedNetworkAdmin.xml @@ -0,0 +1,291 @@ +<chapter id="AdvancedNetworkManagement"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + <pubdate>April 3 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Advanced Network Manangement</title> + +<para> +This section attempts to document peripheral issues that are of great importance to network +administrators who want to improve network resource access control, to automate the user +environment, and to make their lives a little easier. +</para> + +<sect1> +<title>Configuring Samba Share Access Controls</title> + +<para> +This section deals with how to configure Samba per share access control restrictions. +By default samba sets no restrictions on the share itself. Restrictions on the share itself +can be set on MS Windows NT4/200x/XP shares. This can be a very effective way to limit who can +connect to a share. In the absence of specific restrictions the default setting is to allow +the global user <emphasis>Everyone</emphasis> Full Control (ie: Full control, Change and Read). +</para> + +<para> +At this time Samba does NOT provide a tool for configuring access control setting on the Share +itself. Samba does have the capacity to store and act on access control settings, but the only +way to create those settings is to use either the NT4 Server Manager or the Windows 200x MMC for +Computer Management. +</para> + +<para> +Samba stores the per share access control settings in a file called <filename>share_info.tdb</filename>. +The location of this file on your system will depend on how samba was compiled. The default location +for samba's tdb files is under <filename>/usr/local/samba/var</filename>. If the <filename>tdbdump</filename> +utility has been compiled and installed on your system then you can examine the contents of this file +by: <userinput>tdbdump share_info.tdb</userinput>. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Share Permissions Management</title> + +<para> +The best tool for the task is platform dependant. Choose the best tool for your environmemt. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>Windows NT4 Workstation/Server</title> +<para> +The tool you need to use to manage share permissions on a Samba server is the NT Server Manager. +Server Manager is shipped with Windows NT4 Server products but not with Windows NT4 Workstation. +You can obtain the NT Server Manager for MS Windows NT4 Workstation from Microsoft - see details below. +</para> + +<procedure> +<title>Instructions</title> +<step><para> +Launch the NT4 Server Manager, click on the Samba server you want to administer, then from the menu +select Computer, then click on the Shared Directories entry. +</para></step> + +<step><para> + Now click on the share that you wish to manage, then click on the Properties tab, next click on + the Permissions tab. Now you can Add or change access control settings as you wish. +</para></step> +</procedure> + +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Windows 200x/XP</title> + +<para> +On MS Windows NT4/200x/XP system access control lists on the share itself are set using native +tools, usually from filemanager. For example, in Windows 200x: right click on the shared folder, +then select 'Sharing', then click on 'Permissions'. The default Windows NT4/200x permission allows +<emphasis>Everyone</emphasis> Full Control on the Share. +</para> + +<para> +MS Windows 200x and later all comes with a tool called the 'Computer Management' snap-in for the +Microsoft Management Console (MMC). This tool is located by clicking on <filename>Control Panel -> +Administrative Tools -> Computer Management</filename>. +</para> + +<procedure> +<title>Instructions</title> +<step><para> + After launching the MMC with the Computer Management snap-in, click on the menu item 'Action', + select 'Connect to another computer'. If you are not logged onto a domain you will be prompted + to enter a domain login user identifier and a password. This will authenticate you to the domain. + If you where already logged in with administrative privilidge this step is not offered. +</para></step> + +<step><para> +If the Samba server is not shown in the Select Computer box, then type in the name of the target +Samba server in the field 'Name:'. Now click on the [+] next to 'System Tools', then on the [+] +next to 'Shared Folders' in the left panel. +</para></step> + +<step><para> +Now in the right panel, double-click on the share you wish to set access control permissions on. +Then click on the tab 'Share Permissions'. It is now possible to add access control entities +to the shared folder. Do NOT forget to set what type of access (full control, change, read) you +wish to assign for each entry. +</para></step> +</procedure> + +<warning> +<para> +Be careful. If you take away all permissions from the Everyone user without removing this user +then effectively no user will be able to access the share. This is a result of what is known as +ACL precidence. ie: Everyone with NO ACCESS means that MaryK who is part of the group Everyone +will have no access even if this user is given explicit full control access. +</para> +</warning> + +</sect3> +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Remote Server Administration</title> + +<para> +<emphasis>How do I get 'User Manager' and 'Server Manager'?</emphasis> +</para> + +<para> +Since I don't need to buy an NT4 Server, how do I get the 'User Manager for Domains', +the 'Server Manager'? +</para> + +<para> +Microsoft distributes a version of these tools called nexus for installation on Windows 9x / Me +systems. The tools set includes: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Server Manager</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>User Manager for Domains</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Event Viewer</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Click here to download the archived file <ulink +url="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/NEXUS.EXE">ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/NEXUS.EXE</ulink> +</para> + +<para> +The Windows NT 4.0 version of the 'User Manager for +Domains' and 'Server Manager' are available from Microsoft via ftp +from <ulink url="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/SRVTOOLS.EXE">ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/SRVTOOLS.EXE</ulink> +</para> + +</sect1> +<sect1> +<title>Network Logon Script Magic</title> + +<para> +This section needs work. Volunteer contributions most welcome. Please send your patches or updates +to <ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">John Terpstra</ulink>. +</para> + +<para> +There are several opportunities for creating a custom network startup configuration environment. +</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>No Logon Script</member> + <member>Simple universal Logon Script that applies to all users</member> + <member>Use of a conditional Logon Script that applies per user or per group attirbutes</member> + <member>Use of Samba's Preexec and Postexec functions on access to the NETLOGON share to create + a custom Logon Script and then execute it.</member> + <member>User of a tool such as KixStart</member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +The Samba source code tree includes two logon script generation/execution tools. See <filename>examples</filename> directory <filename>genlogon</filename> and <filename>ntlogon</filename> subdirectories. +</para> + +<para> +The following listings are from the genlogon directory. +</para> + +<para> +This is the genlogon.pl file: + +<programlisting> + #!/usr/bin/perl + # + # genlogon.pl + # + # Perl script to generate user logon scripts on the fly, when users + # connect from a Windows client. This script should be called from smb.conf + # with the %U, %G and %L parameters. I.e: + # + # root preexec = genlogon.pl %U %G %L + # + # The script generated will perform + # the following: + # + # 1. Log the user connection to /var/log/samba/netlogon.log + # 2. Set the PC's time to the Linux server time (which is maintained + # daily to the National Institute of Standard's Atomic clock on the + # internet. + # 3. Connect the user's home drive to H: (H for Home). + # 4. Connect common drives that everyone uses. + # 5. Connect group-specific drives for certain user groups. + # 6. Connect user-specific drives for certain users. + # 7. Connect network printers. + + # Log client connection + #($sec,$min,$hour,$mday,$mon,$year,$wday,$yday,$isdst) = localtime(time); + ($sec,$min,$hour,$mday,$mon,$year,$wday,$yday,$isdst) = localtime(time); + open LOG, ">>/var/log/samba/netlogon.log"; + print LOG "$mon/$mday/$year $hour:$min:$sec - User $ARGV[0] logged into $ARGV[1]\n"; + close LOG; + + # Start generating logon script + open LOGON, ">/shared/netlogon/$ARGV[0].bat"; + print LOGON "\@ECHO OFF\r\n"; + + # Connect shares just use by Software Development group + if ($ARGV[1] eq "SOFTDEV" || $ARGV[0] eq "softdev") + { + print LOGON "NET USE M: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\SOURCE\r\n"; + } + + # Connect shares just use by Technical Support staff + if ($ARGV[1] eq "SUPPORT" || $ARGV[0] eq "support") + { + print LOGON "NET USE S: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\SUPPORT\r\n"; + } + + # Connect shares just used by Administration staff + If ($ARGV[1] eq "ADMIN" || $ARGV[0] eq "admin") + { + print LOGON "NET USE L: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\ADMIN\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE K: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\MKTING\r\n"; + } + + # Now connect Printers. We handle just two or three users a little + # differently, because they are the exceptions that have desktop + # printers on LPT1: - all other user's go to the LaserJet on the + # server. + if ($ARGV[0] eq 'jim' + || $ARGV[0] eq 'yvonne') + { + print LOGON "NET USE LPT2: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\LJET3\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE LPT3: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\FAXQ\r\n"; + } + else + { + print LOGON "NET USE LPT1: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\LJET3\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE LPT3: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\FAXQ\r\n"; + } + + # All done! Close the output file. + close LOGON; +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +Those wishing to use more elaborate or capable logon processing system should check out the following sites: +</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>http://www.craigelachie.org/rhacer/ntlogon</member> + <member>http://www.kixtart.org</member> + <member>http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105</member> +</simplelist> + +<sect2> +<title>Adding printers without user intervention</title> + +<para> +Printers may be added automatically during logon script processing through the use of: + +<programlisting> + rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /? +</programlisting> + +See the documentation in the Microsoft knowledgebase article no: 189105 referred to above. +</para> +</sect2> + +</sect1> +</chapter> + diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Bugs.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Bugs.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..d782920457f --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Bugs.xml @@ -0,0 +1,201 @@ +<chapter id="bugreport"> + +<chapterinfo> + &author.jelmer; + <author> + <affiliation> + <orgname>Samba Team</orgname> + </affiliation> + </author> + <pubdate> 27 June 1997 </pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Reporting Bugs</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Introduction</title> + +<para>Please report bugs using <ulink url="https://bugzilla.samba.org/">bugzilla</ulink>.</para> + +<para> +Please take the time to read this file before you submit a bug +report. Also, please see if it has changed between releases, as we +may be changing the bug reporting mechanism at some time. +</para> + +<para> +Please also do as much as you can yourself to help track down the +bug. Samba is maintained by a dedicated group of people who volunteer +their time, skills and efforts. We receive far more mail about it than +we can possibly answer, so you have a much higher chance of an answer +and a fix if you send us a "developer friendly" bug report that lets +us fix it fast. +</para> + +<para> +Do not assume that if you post the bug to the comp.protocols.smb +newsgroup or the mailing list that we will read it. If you suspect that your +problem is not a bug but a configuration problem then it is better to send +it to the Samba mailing list, as there are (at last count) 5000 other users on +that list that may be able to help you. +</para> + +<para> +You may also like to look though the recent mailing list archives, +which are conveniently accessible on the Samba web pages +at <ulink url="http://samba.org/samba/">http://samba.org/samba/</ulink>. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>General info</title> + +<para> +Before submitting a bug report check your config for silly +errors. Look in your log files for obvious messages that tell you that +you've misconfigured something and run testparm to test your config +file for correct syntax. +</para> + +<para> +Have you run through the <link linkend="diagnosis">diagnosis</link>? +This is very important. +</para> + +<para> +If you include part of a log file with your bug report then be sure to +annotate it with exactly what you were doing on the client at the +time, and exactly what the results were. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Debug levels</title> + +<para> +If the bug has anything to do with Samba behaving incorrectly as a +server (like refusing to open a file) then the log files will probably +be very useful. Depending on the problem a log level of between 3 and +10 showing the problem may be appropriate. A higher level givesmore +detail, but may use too much disk space. +</para> + +<para> +To set the debug level use <command>log level =</command> in your +&smb.conf;. You may also find it useful to set the log +level higher for just one machine and keep separate logs for each machine. +To do this use: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +log level = 10 +log file = /usr/local/samba/lib/log.%m +include = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +then create a file +<filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.<replaceable>machine</replaceable></filename> where +<replaceable>machine</replaceable> is the name of the client you wish to debug. In that file +put any &smb.conf; commands you want, for example +<command>log level=</command> may be useful. This also allows you to +experiment with different security systems, protocol levels etc on just +one machine. +</para> + +<para> +The &smb.conf; entry <command>log level =</command> +is synonymous with the entry <command>debuglevel =</command> that has been +used in older versions of Samba and is being retained for backwards +compatibility of &smb.conf; files. +</para> + +<para> +As the <command>log level =</command> value is increased you will record +a significantly increasing level of debugging information. For most +debugging operations you may not need a setting higher than 3. Nearly +all bugs can be tracked at a setting of 10, but be prepared for a VERY +large volume of log data. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Internal errors</title> + +<para> +If you get a "INTERNAL ERROR" message in your log files it means that +Samba got an unexpected signal while running. It is probably a +segmentation fault and almost certainly means a bug in Samba (unless +you have faulty hardware or system software). +</para> + +<para> +If the message came from smbd then it will probably be accompanied by +a message which details the last SMB message received by smbd. This +info is often very useful in tracking down the problem so please +include it in your bug report. +</para> + +<para> +You should also detail how to reproduce the problem, if +possible. Please make this reasonably detailed. +</para> + +<para> +You may also find that a core file appeared in a <filename>corefiles</filename> +subdirectory of the directory where you keep your samba log +files. This file is the most useful tool for tracking down the bug. To +use it you do this: +</para> + +<para><command>gdb smbd core</command></para> + +<para> +adding appropriate paths to smbd and core so gdb can find them. If you +don't have gdb then try <userinput>dbx</userinput>. Then within the debugger use the +command <userinput>where</userinput> to give a stack trace of where the problem +occurred. Include this in your mail. +</para> + +<para> +If you know any assembly language then do a <userinput>disass</userinput> of the routine +where the problem occurred (if its in a library routine then +disassemble the routine that called it) and try to work out exactly +where the problem is by looking at the surrounding code. Even if you +don't know assembly then incuding this info in the bug report can be +useful. +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Attaching to a running process</title> + +<para> +Unfortunately some unixes (in particular some recent linux kernels) +refuse to dump a core file if the task has changed uid (which smbd +does often). To debug with this sort of system you could try to attach +to the running process using <userinput>gdb smbd <replaceable>PID</replaceable></userinput> where you get <replaceable>PID</replaceable> from +<application>smbstatus</application>. Then use <userinput>c</userinput> to continue and try to cause the core dump +using the client. The debugger should catch the fault and tell you +where it occurred. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Patches</title> + +<para> +The best sort of bug report is one that includes a fix! If you send us +patches please use <userinput>diff -u</userinput> format if your version of +diff supports it, otherwise use <userinput>diff -c4</userinput>. Make sure +you do the diff against a clean version of the source and let me know +exactly what version you used. +</para> + +</sect1> +</chapter> + diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/CUPS-printing.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/CUPS-printing.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..7e302000e60 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/CUPS-printing.xml @@ -0,0 +1,1793 @@ +<chapter id="CUPS-printing"> + + +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + <author> + <firstname>Kurt</firstname><surname>Pfeifle</surname> + <affiliation> + <address><email>kpfeifle@danka.de</email></address> + </affiliation> + </author> + <pubdate> (25 March 2003) </pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>CUPS Printing Support</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Introduction</title> + +<para> +The Common Unix Print System (CUPS) has become very popular, but to many it is +a very mystical tool. There is a great deal of uncertainty regarding CUPS and how +it works. The result is seen in a large number of posting on the samba mailing lists +expressing frustration when MS Windows printers appear not to work with a CUPS +backr-end. +</para> + +<para> +This is a good time to point out how CUPS can be used and what it does. CUPS is more +than just a print spooling system - it is a complete printer management system that +complies with HTTP and IPP protocols. It can be managed remotely via a web browser +and it can print using http and ipp protocols. +</para> + +<para> +CUPS allows to creation of RAW printers (ie: NO file format translation) as well as +SMART printers (ie: CUPS does file format conversion as required for the printer). In +many ways this gives CUPS similar capabilities to the MS Windows print monitoring +system. Of course, if you are a CUPS advocate, you would agrue that CUPS is better! +In any case, let us now move on to explore how one may configure CUPS for interfacing +with MS Windows print clients via Samba. +</para> + +<para> +<ulink url="http://www.cups.org/">CUPS</ulink> is a newcomer in the UNIX printing scene, +which has convinced many people upon first trial already. However, it has quite a few +new features, which make it different from other, more traditional printing systems. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Configuring &smb.conf; for CUPS</title> + +<para> +Printing with CUPS in the most basic &smb.conf; +setup in Samba-3 only needs two settings: <command>printing = cups</command> and +<command>printcap = cups</command>. While CUPS itself doesn't need a printcap +anymore, the <filename>cupsd.conf</filename> configuration file knows two directives +(example: <command>Printcap /etc/printcap</command> and <command>PrintcapFormat +BSD</command>), which control if such a file should be created for the +convenience of third party applications. Make sure it is set! For details see +<command>man cupsd.conf</command> and other CUPS-related documentation. +</para> + +<para> +If SAMBA is compiled against libcups, then <command>printcap = cups</command> uses the +CUPS API to list printers, submit jobs, etc. Otherwise it maps to the System V commands +with an additional <parameter>-oraw</parameter> option for printing. On a Linux system, +you can use the <command>ldd</command> command to find out details (ldd may not be +present on other OS platforms, or its function may be embodied by a different command): +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting>transmeta:/home/kurt # ldd `which smbd` + libssl.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libssl.so.0.9.6 (0x4002d000) + libcrypto.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libcrypto.so.0.9.6 (0x4005a000) + libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 (0x40123000) + libdl.so.2 => /lib/libdl.so.2 (0x401e8000) + libnsl.so.1 => /lib/libnsl.so.1 (0x401ec000) + libpam.so.0 => /lib/libpam.so.0 (0x40202000) + libc.so.6 => /lib/libc.so.6 (0x4020b000) + /lib/ld-linux.so.2 => /lib/ld-linux.so.2 (0x40000000) +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The line "libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 +(0x40123000)" shows there is CUPS support compiled into this version of +Samba. If this is the case, and <command>printing = cups</command> is set, then any +otherwise manually set print command in &smb.conf; is ignored. +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>CUPS - RAW Print Through Mode</title> + +<note> +<para> +When used in raw print through mode is will be necessary to use the printer +vendor's drivers in each Windows client PC. +</para> +</note> + +<para> +When CUPS printers are configured for RAW print-through mode operation it is the +responsibility of the Samba client to fully render the print job (file) in a format +that is suitable for direct delivery to the printer. In this case CUPS will NOT +do any print file format conversion work. +</para> + +<para> +The CUPS files that need to be correctly set for RAW mode printers to work are: + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para><filename>/etc/cups/mime.types</filename></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><filename>/etc/cups/mime.convs</filename></para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +Both contain entries that must be uncommented to allow <emphasis>RAW</emphasis> mode +operation. +</para> + +<para> +Firstly, to enable CUPS based printing from Samba the following options must be +enabled in your &smb.conf; file [globals] section: + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>printing = CUPS</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>printcap = CUPS</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +When these parameters are specified the print directives in &smb.conf; (as well as in +samba itself) will be ignored because samba will directly interface with CUPS through +it's application program interface (API) - so long as Samba has been compiled with +CUPS library (libcups) support. If samba has NOT been compiled with CUPS support then +printing will use the System V AT&T command set with the <emphasis>-oraw</emphasis> +option automatically passing through. +</para> + +<para> +Cupsomatic (an enhanced printing utility that is part of some CUPS implementations) +on the Samba/CUPS server does *not* add any features if a file is really +printed "raw". However, if you have loaded the driver for the Windows client from +the CUPS server, using the "cupsaddsmb" utility, and if this driver is one using +a "Foomatic" PPD, the PJL header in question is already added on the Windows client, +at the time when the driver initially generated the PostScript data and CUPS in true +"-oraw" manner doesn't remove this PJL header and passes the file "as is" to its +printer communication backend. +</para> + +<note><para>NOTE: editing in the "mime.convs" and the "mime.types" file does not *enforce* +"raw" printing, it only *allows* it.</para></note> + +<para> +Print files that arrive from MS Windows printing are "auto-typed" by CUPS. This aids +the process of determining proper treatment while in the print queue system. + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + Files generated by PCL drivers and directed at PCK printers get auto-typed as + <filename>application/octet-stream</filename>. Unknown file format types also + get auto-typed with this tag. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Files generated by a Postscript driver and directed at a Postscript printer + are auto-typed depending on the auto-detected most suitable MIME type as: + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>* application/postscript</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>* application/vnd.cups-postscript</para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </listitem> +</itemizedlist> +</para> + + +<para> +"application/postscript" first goes thru the "pstops" filter (where the page counting +and accounting takes place). The outcome will be of MIME type +"application/vnd.cups-postscript". The pstopsfilter reads and uses information from +the PPD and inserts user-provided options into the PostScript file. As a consequence, +the filtered file could possibly have an unwanted PJL header. +</para> + +<para> +"application/postscript" will be all files with a ".ps", ".ai", ".eps" suffix or which +have as their first character string one of "%!" or ">04<%". +</para> + +<para> +"application/vnd.cups-postscript" will files which contain the string +"LANGUAGE=POSTSCRIPT" (or similar variations with different capitalization) in the +first 512 bytes, and also contain the "PJL super escape code" in the first 128 bytes +(">1B<%-12345X"). Very likely, most PostScript files generated on Windows using a CUPS +or other PPD, will have to be auto-typed as "vnd.cups-postscript". A file produced +with a "Generic PostScript driver" will just be tagged "application/postscript". +</para> + +<para> +Once the file is in "application/vnd.cups-postscript" format, either "pstoraster" +or "cupsomatic" will take over (depending on the printer configuration, as +determined by the PPD in use). +</para> + +<note><para> +A printer queue with *no* PPD associated to it is a "raw" printer and all files +will go directly there as received by the spooler. The exeptions are file types +"application/octet-stream" which need "passthrough feature" enabled. +"Raw" queues don't do any filtering at all, they hand the file directly to the +CUPS backend. This backend is responsible for the sending of the data to the device +(as in the "device URI" notation as lpd://, socket://, smb://, ipp://, http://, +parallel:/, serial:/, usb:/ etc.) +</para></note> + +<note><para> +"cupsomatic"/Foomatic are *not* native CUPS drivers and they don't ship with CUPS. +They are a Third Party add-on, developed at Linuxprinting.org. As such, they are +a brilliant hack to make all models (driven by Ghostscript drivers/filters in +traditional spoolers) also work via CUPS, with the same (good or bad!) quality +as in these other spoolers. "cupsomatic" is only a vehicle to execute a ghostscript +commandline at that stage in the CUPS filtering chain, where "normally" the native +CUPS "pstoraster" filter would kick in. cupsomatic by-passes pstoraster, "kidnaps" +the printfile from CUPS away and re-directs it to go through Ghostscipt. CUPS accepts this, +because the associated CUPS-O-Matic-/Foomatic-PPD specifies: +</para> + +<programlisting> + *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" +</programlisting> + +<para> +This line persuades CUPS to hand the file to cupsomatic, once it has successfully +converted it to the MIME type "application/vnd.cups-postscript". This conversion will not +happen for Jobs arriving from Windows which are auto-typed "application/octet-stream", +with the according changes in "/etc/cups/mime.types" in place. +</para></note> + +<para> +CUPS is widely configurable and flexible, even regarding its filtering mechanism. +Another workaround in some situations would be to have +in "/etc/cups/mime.types" entries as follows: +</para> + +<programlisting> + application/postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - + application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - +</programlisting> + +<para> +This would prevent all Postscript files from being filtered (rather, they will go +thru the virtual "nullfilter" denoted with "-"). This could only be useful for +PS printers. If you want to print PS code on non-PS printers an entry as follows +could be useful: +</para> + +<programlisting> + */* application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - +</programlisting> + +<para> +and would effectively send *all* files to the backend without further processing. +</para> + +<para> +Lastly, you could have the following entry: +</para> + +<programlisting> + application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 my_PJL_stripping_filter +</programlisting> + +<para> +You will need to write a "my_PJL_stripping_filter" (could be a shellscript) that +parses the PostScript and removes the unwanted PJL. This would need to conform to +CUPS filter design (mainly, receive and pass the parameters printername, job-id, +username, jobtitle, copies, print options and possibly the filename). It would +be installed as world executable into "/usr/lib/cups/filters/" and will be called +by CUPS if it encounters a MIME type "application/vnd.cups-postscript". +</para> + +<para> +CUPS can handle "-o job-hold-until=indefinite". This keeps the job in the queue +"on hold". It will only be printed upon manual release by the printer operator. +This is a requirement in many "central reproduction departments", where a few +operators manage the jobs of hundreds of users on some big machine, where no +user is allowed to have direct access. (The operators often need to load the +proper paper type before running the 10.000 page job requested by marketing +for the mailing, etc.). +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>CUPS as a network PostScript RIP</title> + +<para> +This is the configuration where CUPS drivers are working on server, and where the +Adobe PostScript driver with CUPS-PPDs is downloaded to clients. +</para> + +<para> +CUPS is perfectly able to use PPD files (PostScript +Printer Descriptions). PPDs can control all print device options. They +are usually provided by the manufacturer -- if you own a PostSript printer, +that is. PPD files are always a component of PostScript printer drivers on MS +Windows or Apple Mac OS systems. They are ASCII files containing +user-selectable print options, mapped to appropriate PostScript, PCL or PJL +commands for the target printer. Printer driver GUI dialogs translate these +options "on-the-fly" into buttons and drop-down lists for the user to +select. +</para> + +<para> +CUPS can load, without any conversions, the PPD file from +any Windows (NT is recommended) PostScript driver and handle the options. +There is a web browser interface to the print options (select +http://localhost:631/printers/ and click on one "Configure Printer" button +to see it), a commandline interface (see <command>man lpoptions</command> or +try if you have <command>lphelp</command> on your system) plus some different GUI frontends on Linux +UNIX, which can present PPD options to the users. PPD options are normally +meant to become evaluated by the PostScript RIP on the real PostScript +printer. +</para> + +<para> +CUPS doesn't stop at "real" PostScript printers in its +usage of PPDs. The CUPS developers have extended the PPD concept, to also +describe available device and driver options for non-PostScript printers +through CUPS-PPDs. +</para> + +<para> +This is logical, as CUPS includes a fully featured +PostScript interpreter (RIP). This RIP is based on Ghostscript. It can +process all received PostScript (and additionally many other file formats) +from clients. All CUPS-PPDs geared to non-PostScript printers contain an +additional line, starting with the keyword <parameter>*cupsFilter</parameter>. +This line +tells the CUPS print system which printer-specific filter to use for the +interpretation of the accompanying PostScript. Thus CUPS lets all its +printers appear as PostScript devices to its clients, because it can act as a +PostScript RIP for those printers, processing the received PostScript code +into a proper raster print format. +</para> + +<para> +CUPS-PPDs can also be used on Windows-Clients, on top of a +PostScript driver (recommended is the Adobe one). +</para> + +<para> +This feature enables CUPS to do a few tricks no other +spooler can do: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>act as a networked PostScript RIP (Raster Image Processor), handling + printfiles from all client platforms in a uniform way;</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>act as a central accounting and billing server, as all files are passed + through the <command>pstops</command> Filter and are therefor logged in + the CUPS <filename>page_log</filename>. - <emphasis>NOTE: </emphasis>this + can not happen with "raw" print jobs, which always remain unfiltered + per definition;</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>enable clients to consolidate on a single PostScript driver, even for + many different target printers.</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS clients</title> + +<para> +This setup may be of special interest to people +experiencing major problems in WTS environments. WTS need often a multitude +of non-PostScript drivers installed to run their clients' variety of +different printer models. This often imposes the price of much increased +instability. In many cases, in an attempt to overcome this problem, site +administrators have resorted to restrict the allowed drivers installed on +their WTS to one generic PCL- and one PostScript driver. This however +restricts the clients in the amount of printer options available for them -- +often they can't get out more then simplex prints from one standard paper +tray, while their devices could do much better, if driven by a different +driver! +</para> + +<para> +Using an Adobe PostScript driver, enabled with a CUPS-PPD, +seems to be a very elegant way to overcome all these shortcomings. The +PostScript driver is not known to cause major stability problems on WTS (even +if used with many different PPDs). The clients will be able to (again) chose +paper trays, duplex printing and other settings. However, there is a certain +price for this too: a CUPS server acting as a PostScript RIP for its clients +requires more CPU and RAM than just to act as a "raw spooling" device. Plus, +this setup is not yet widely tested, although the first feedbacks look very +promising... +</para> +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>Setting up CUPS for driver download</title> + +<para> +The <command>cupsadsmb</command> utility (shipped with all current +CUPS versions) makes the sharing of any (or all) installed CUPS printers very +easy. Prior to using it, you need the following settings in &smb.conf;: +</para> + + <para><programlisting>[global] + load printers = yes + printing = cups + printcap name = cups + + [printers] + comment = All Printers + path = /var/spool/samba + browseable = no + public = yes + guest ok = yes + writable = no + printable = yes + printer admin = root + + [print$] + comment = Printer Drivers + path = /etc/samba/drivers + browseable = yes + guest ok = no + read only = yes + write list = root + </programlisting></para> + +<para> +For licensing reasons the necessary files of the Adobe +Postscript driver can not be distributed with either Samba or CUPS. You need +to download them yourself from the Adobe website. Once extracted, create a +<filename>drivers</filename> directory in the CUPS data directory (usually +<filename>/usr/share/cups/</filename>). Copy the Adobe files using +UPPERCASE filenames, to this directory as follows: +</para> + + <para><programlisting> + ADFONTS.MFM + ADOBEPS4.DRV + ADOBEPS4.HLP + ADOBEPS5.DLL + ADOBEPSU.DLL + ADOBEPSU.HLP + DEFPRTR2.PPD + ICONLIB.DLL + </programlisting></para> + +<para> +Users of the ESP Print Pro software are able to install +their "Samba Drivers" package for this purpose with no problem. +</para> +</sect1> + + + +<sect1> +<title>Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</title> + +<para> +On the internet you can find now many thousand CUPS-PPD +files (with their companion filters), in many national languages, +supporting more than 1.000 non-PostScript models. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para><ulink url="http://wwwl.easysw.com/printpro/">ESP PrintPro + (http://wwwl.easysw.com/printpro/)</ulink> + (commercial, non-Free) is packaged with more than 3.000 PPDs, ready for + successful usage "out of the box" on Linux, IBM-AIX, HP-UX, Sun-Solaris, + SGI-IRIX, Compaq Tru64, Digital Unix and some more commercial Unices (it + is written by the CUPS developers themselves and its sales help finance + the further development of CUPS, as they feed their creators)</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>the <ulink + url="http://gimp-print.sourceforge.net/">Gimp-Print-Project + (http://gimp-print.sourceforge.net/)</ulink> + (GPL, Free Software) provides around 120 PPDs (supporting nearly 300 + printers, many driven to photo quality output), to be used alongside the + Gimp-Print CUPS filters;</para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="http://www.turboprint.com/">TurboPrint + (http://www.turboprint.com/)</ulink> + (Shareware, non-Freee) supports roughly the same amount of printers in + excellent quality;</para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink + url="http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/">OMNI + (http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/)</ulink> + (LPGL, Free) is a package made by IBM, now containing support for more + than 400 printers, stemming from the inheritance of IBM OS/2 KnowHow + ported over to Linux (CUPS support is in a Beta-stage at present);</para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="http://hpinkjet.sourceforge.net/">HPIJS + (http://hpinkjet.sourceforge.net/)</ulink> + (BSD-style licnes, Free) supports around 120 of HP's own printers and is + also providing excellent print quality now;</para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink + url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/">Foomatic/cupsomatic (http://www.linuxprinting.org/)</ulink> + (LPGL, Free) from Linuxprinting.org are providing PPDs for practically every + Ghostscript filter known to the world, now usable with CUPS.</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +<emphasis>NOTE: </emphasis>the cupsomatic trick from Linuxprinting.org is +working different from the other drivers. While the other drivers take the +generic CUPS raster (produced by CUPS' own pstoraster PostScript RIP) as +their input, cupsomatic "kidnaps" the PostScript inside CUPS, before +RIP-ping, deviates it to an external Ghostscript installation (which now +becomes the RIP) and gives it back to a CUPS backend once Ghostscript is +finished. -- CUPS versions from 1.1.15 and later will provide their pstoraster +PostScript RIP function again inside a system-wide Ghostscript +installation rather than in "their own" pstoraster filter. (This +CUPS-enabling Ghostscript version may be installed either as a +patch to GNU or AFPL Ghostscript, or as a complete ESP Ghostscript package). +However, this will not change the cupsomatic approach of guiding the printjob +along a different path through the filtering system than the standard CUPS +way... +</para> + +<para> +Once you installed a printer inside CUPS with one of the +recommended methods (the lpadmin command, the web browser interface or one of +the available GUI wizards), you can use <command>cupsaddsmb</command> to share the +printer via Samba. <command>cupsaddsmb</command> prepares the driver files for +comfortable client download and installation upon their first contact with +this printer share. +</para> + + + +<sect2> +<title><command>cupsaddsmb</command></title> + + +<para> +The <command>cupsaddsmb</command> command copies the needed files +for convenient Windows client installations from the previously prepared CUPS +data directory to your [print$] share. Additionally, the PPD +associated with this printer is copied from <filename>/etc/cups/ppd/</filename> to +[print$]. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +<prompt>root# </prompt> <command>cupsaddsmb -U root infotec_IS2027</command> +Password for root required to access localhost via +SAMBA: <userinput>[type in password 'secret']</userinput> +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +To share all printers and drivers, use the <parameter>-a</parameter> +parameter instead of a printer name. +</para> + + +<para> +Probably you want to see what's going on. Use the +<parameter>-v</parameter> parameter to get a more verbose output: +</para> + +<para> +Probably you want to see what's going on. Use the +<parameter>-v</parameter> parameter to get a more verbose output: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +Note: The following line shave been wrapped so that information is not lost. + +<prompt>root# </prompt> cupsaddsmb -v -U root infotec_IS2027 + Password for root required to access localhost via SAMBA: + Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' -c 'mkdir W32X86;put + /var/spool/cups/tmp/3cd1cc66376c0 W32X86/infotec_IS2027.PPD;put + /usr/share/cups/drivers/ + ADOBEPS5.DLL W32X86/ADOBEPS5.DLL;put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPSU.DLLr + W32X86/ADOBEPSU.DLL;put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPSU.HLP W32X86/ADOBEPSU.HLP' + added interface ip=10.160.16.45 bcast=10.160.31.255 nmask=255.255.240.0 + added interface ip=192.168.182.1 bcast=192.168.182.255 nmask=255.255.255.0 + added interface ip=172.16.200.1 bcast=172.16.200.255 nmask=255.255.255.0 + Domain=[TUX-NET] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.3a.200204262025cvs] + NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \W32X86 + putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3cd1cc66376c0 as + \W32X86/infotec_IS2027.PPD (17394.6 kb/s) (average 17395.2 kb/s) + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS5.DLL as + \W32X86/ADOBEPS5.DLL (10877.4 kb/s) (average 11343.0 kb/s) + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPSU.DLL as + \W32X86/ADOBEPSU.DLL (5095.2 kb/s) (average 9260.4 kb/s) + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPSU.HLP as + \W32X86/ADOBEPSU.HLP (8828.7 kb/s) (average 9247.1 kb/s) + + Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' -c 'mkdir WIN40;put + /var/spool/cups/tmp/3cd1cc66376c0 WIN40/infotec_IS2027.PPD;put + /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM;put + /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV;put + /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP;put + /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD;put + /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL;put + /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL WIN40/PSMON.DLL;' + added interface ip=10.160.16.45 bcast=10.160.31.255 nmask=255.255.240.0 + added interface ip=192.168.182.1 bcast=192.168.182.255 nmask=255.255.255.0 + added interface ip=172.16.200.1 bcast=172.16.200.255 nmask=255.255.255.0 + Domain=[TUX-NET] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.3a.200204262025cvs] + NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \WIN40 + putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3cd1cc66376c0 as + \WIN40/infotec_IS2027.PPD (26091.5 kb/s) (average 26092.8 kb/s) + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM as + \WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM (11241.6 kb/s) (average 11812.9 kb/s) + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV as + \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV (16640.6 kb/s) (average 14679.3 kb/s) + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP as + \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP (11285.6 kb/s) (average 14281.5 kb/s) + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD as + \WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD (823.5 kb/s) (average 12944.0 kb/s) + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL as + \WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL (19226.2 kb/s) (average 13169.7 kb/s) + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL as + \WIN40/PSMON.DLL (18666.1 kb/s) (average 13266.7 kb/s) + + Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' + -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" + "infotec_IS2027:ADOBEPS5.DLL:infotec_IS2027.PPD:ADOBEPSU.DLL: + ADOBEPSU.HLP:NULL:RAW:NULL"' + cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" + "infotec_IS2027:ADOBEPS5.DLL:infotec_IS2027.PPD:ADOBEPSU.DLL: + ADOBEPSU.HLP:NULL:RAW:NULL" + Printer Driver infotec_IS2027 successfully installed. + + Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' + -c 'adddriver "Windows 4.0" + "infotec_IS2027:ADOBEPS4.DRV:infotec_IS2027.PPD:NULL: + ADOBEPS4.HLP:PSMON.DLL:RAW: ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL"' + cmd = adddriver "Windows 4.0" "infotec_IS2027:ADOBEPS4.DRV: + infotec_IS2027.PPD:NULL:ADOBEPS4.HLP:PSMON.DLL:RAW: + ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL" + Printer Driver infotec_IS2027 successfully installed. + + Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' + -c 'setdriver infotec_IS2027 infotec_IS2027' + cmd = setdriver infotec_IS2027 infotec_IS2027 + Succesfully set infotec_IS2027 to driver infotec_IS2027. + + <prompt>root# </prompt> +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +If you look closely, you'll discover your root password was transfered unencrypted over +the wire, so beware! Also, if you look further her, you'll discover error messages like +<constant>NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION</constant> in between. They occur, because +the directories <filename>WIN40</filename> and <filename>W32X86</filename> already +existed in the [print$] driver download share (from a previous driver +installation). They are harmless here. +</para> + +<para> +Now your printer is prepared for the clients to use. From +a client, browse to the CUPS/Samba server, open the "Printers" +share, right-click on this printer and select "Install..." or +"Connect..." (depending on the Windows version you use). Now their +should be a new printer in your client's local "Printers" folder, +named (in my case) "infotec_IS2027 on kdebitshop" +</para> + +<para> +<emphasis>NOTE: </emphasis> +<command>cupsaddsmb</command> will only reliably work i +with CUPS version 1.1.15 or higher +and Samba from 2.2.4. If it doesn't work, or if the automatic printer +driver download to the clients doesn't succeed, you can still manually +install the CUPS printer PPD on top of the Adobe PostScript driver on +clients and then point the client's printer queue to the Samba printer +share for connection, should you desire to use the CUPS networked +PostScript RIP functions. +</para> +</sect2> +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>The CUPS Filter Chains</title> + +<para> +The following diagrams reveal how CUPS handles print jobs. +</para> + +<programlisting> +######################################################################### +# +# CUPS in and of itself has this (general) filter chain (CAPITAL +# letters are FILE-FORMATS or MIME types, other are filters (this is +# true for pre-1.1.15 of pre-4.3 versions of CUPS and ESP PrintPro): +# +# <replaceable>SOMETHNG</replaceable>-FILEFORMAT +# | +# | +# V +# <replaceable>something</replaceable>tops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT +# | +# | +# V +# pstops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT +# | +# | +# V +# pstoraster # as shipped with CUPS, independent from any Ghostscipt +# | # installation on the system +# | (= "postscipt interpreter") +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER +# | +# | +# V +# rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> (f.e. Gimp-Print filters may be plugged in here) +# | (= "raster driver") +# | +# V +# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC +# | +# | +# V +# backend +# +# +# ESP PrintPro has some enhanced "rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable>" filters as compared to +# CUPS, and also a somewhat improved "pstoraster" filter. +# +# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to +# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> is noted. +# +######################################################################### +</programlisting> + +<programlisting> +######################################################################### +# +# This is how "cupsomatic" comes into play: +# ========================================= +# +# <replaceable>SOMETHNG</replaceable>-FILEFORMAT +# | +# | +# V +# <replaceable>something</replaceable>tops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT +# | +# | +# V +# pstops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT ----------------+ +# | | +# | V +# V cupsomatic +# pstoraster (constructs complicated +# | (= "postscipt interpreter") Ghostscript commandline +# | to let the file be +# V processed by a +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER "-sDEVICE=<replaceable>s.th.</replaceable>" +# | call...) +# | | +# V | +# rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> V +# | (= "raster driver") +-------------------------+ +# | | Ghostscript at work.... | +# V | | +# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC *-------------------------+ +# | | +# | | +# V | +# backend >------------------------------------+ +# | +# | +# V +# THE PRINTER +# +# +# Note, that cupsomatic "kidnaps" the printfile after the +# "APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRPT" stage and deviates it through +# the CUPS-external, systemwide Ghostscript installation, bypassing the +# "pstoraster" filter (therefor also bypassing the CUPS-raster-drivers +# "rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable>", and hands the rasterized file directly to the CUPS +# backend... +# +# cupsomatic is not made by the CUPS developers. It is an independent +# contribution to printing development, made by people from +# Linuxprinting.org. (see also http://www.cups.org/cups-help.html) +# +# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to +# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> is noted. +# +######################################################################### +</programlisting> + +<programlisting> +######################################################################### +# +# And this is how it works for ESP PrintPro from 4.3: +# =================================================== +# +# <replaceable>SOMETHNG</replaceable>-FILEFORMAT +# | +# | +# V +# <replaceable>something</replaceable>tops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT +# | +# | +# V +# pstops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT +# | +# | +# V +# gsrip +# | (= "postscipt interpreter") +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER +# | +# | +# V +# rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> (f.e. Gimp-Print filters may be plugged in here) +# | (= "raster driver") +# | +# V +# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC +# | +# | +# V +# backend +# +# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to +# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> is noted. +# +######################################################################### +</programlisting> + +<programlisting> +######################################################################### +# +# This is how "cupsomatic" would come into play with ESP PrintPro: +# ================================================================ +# +# +# <replaceable>SOMETHNG</replaceable>-FILEFORMAT +# | +# | +# V +# <replaceable>something</replaceable>tops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT +# | +# | +# V +# pstops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT ----------------+ +# | | +# | V +# V cupsomatic +# gsrip (constructs complicated +# | (= "postscipt interpreter") Ghostscript commandline +# | to let the file be +# V processed by a +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER "-sDEVICE=<replaceable>s.th.</replaceable>" +# | call...) +# | | +# V | +# rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> V +# | (= "raster driver") +-------------------------+ +# | | Ghostscript at work.... | +# V | | +# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC *-------------------------+ +# | | +# | | +# V | +# backend >------------------------------------+ +# | +# | +# V +# THE PRINTER +# +# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to +# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> is noted. +# +######################################################################### +</programlisting> + +<programlisting> +######################################################################### +# +# And this is how it works for CUPS from 1.1.15: +# ============================================== +# +# <replaceable>SOMETHNG</replaceable>-FILEFORMAT +# | +# | +# V +# <replaceable>something</replaceable>tops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT +# | +# | +# V +# pstops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT-----+ +# | +# +------------------v------------------------------+ +# | Ghostscript | +# | at work... | +# | (with | +# | "-sDEVICE=cups") | +# | | +# | (= "postscipt interpreter") | +# | | +# +------------------v------------------------------+ +# | +# | +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER >-------+ +# | +# | +# V +# rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> +# | (= "raster driver") +# | +# V +# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC +# | +# | +# V +# backend +# +# +# NOTE: since version 1.1.15 CUPS "outsourced" the pstoraster process to +# Ghostscript. GNU Ghostscript needs to be patched to handle the +# CUPS requirement; ESP Ghostscript has this builtin. In any case, +# "gs -h" needs to show up a "cups" device. pstoraster is now a +# calling an appropriate "gs -sDEVICE=cups..." commandline to do +# the job. It will output "application/vnd.cup-raster", which will +# be finally processed by a CUPS raster driver "rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable>" +# Note the difference to "cupsomatic", which will *not* output +# CUPS-raster, but a final version of the printfile, ready to be +# sent to the printer. cupsomatic also doesn't use the "cups" +# devicemode in Ghostscript, but one of the classical devicemodes.... +# +# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to +# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> is noted. +# +######################################################################### +</programlisting> + +<programlisting> +######################################################################### +# +# And this is how it works for CUPS from 1.1.15, with cupsomatic included: +# ======================================================================== +# +# <replaceable>SOMETHNG</replaceable>-FILEFORMAT +# | +# | +# V +# <replaceable>something</replaceable>tops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT +# | +# | +# V +# pstops +# | +# | +# V +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT-----+ +# | +# +------------------v------------------------------+ +# | Ghostscript . Ghostscript at work.... | +# | at work... . (with "-sDEVICE= | +# | (with . <replaceable>s.th.</replaceable>" | +# | "-sDEVICE=cups") . | +# | . | +# | (CUPS standard) . (cupsomatic) | +# | . | +# | (= "postscript interpreter") | +# | . | +# +------------------v--------------v---------------+ +# | | +# | | +# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER >-------+ | +# | | +# | | +# V | +# rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> | +# | (= "raster driver") | +# | | +# V | +# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC >------------------------+ +# | +# | +# V +# backend +# +# +# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to +# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rasterto<replaceable>something</replaceable> is noted. +# +########################################################################## +</programlisting> + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>CUPS Print Drivers and Devices</title> + +<para> +CUPS ships with good support for HP LaserJet type printers. You can install +the driver as follows: + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -m laserjet.ppd + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +(The "-m" switch will retrieve the "laserjet.ppd" from the standard repository +for not-yet-installed-PPDs, which CUPS typically stores in +<filename>/usr/share/cups/model</filename>. Alternatively, you may use +"-P /absolute/filesystem/path/to/where/there/is/PPD/your.ppd"). +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Further printing steps</title> + +<para> +Always also consult the database on linuxprinting.org for all recommendations +about which driver is best used for each printer: +</para> + +<para><ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi">http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi</ulink></para> + +<para> +There select your model and click on "Show". You'll arrive at a page listing +all drivers working with your model. There will always be *one* +<emphasis>recommended</emphasis> one. Try this one first. In your case +("HP LaserJet 4 Plus"), you'll arrive here: +</para> + +<para><ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=75104">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=75104</ulink></para> + +<para> +The recommended driver is "ljet4". It has a link to the page for the ljet4 +driver too: +</para> + +<para><ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4</ulink></para> + +<para> +On the driver's page, you'll find important and detailed info about how to use +that driver within the various available spoolers. You can generate a PPD for +CUPS. The PPD contains all the info about how to use your model and the driver; +this is, once installed, working transparently for the user -- you'll only +need to choose resolution, paper size etc. from the web-based menu or from +the print dialog GUI or from the commandline... +</para> + +<para> +On the driver's page, choose to use the "PPD-O-Matic" online PPD generator +program. Select your model and click "Generate PPD file". When you safe the +appearing ASCII text file, don't use "cut'n'past" (as it could possiblly corrupt +line endings and tabs), but use "Save as..." in your browser's menu. Save it +at "/some/path/on/your/filesystem/somewhere/my-name-for-my-printer.ppd" +</para> + +<para> +Then install the printer: +</para> +<para><programlisting> + "lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E \ + -P /some/path/on/your/filesystem/somewhere/my-name-for-my-printer.ppd" +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Note, that for all the "Foomatic-PPDs" from Linuxprinting.org, you also need +a special "CUPS filter" named "cupsomatic". Get the latest version of +"cupsomatic" from: +</para> + +<para><ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/cupsomatic">http://www.linuxprinting.org/cupsomatic</ulink></para> + +<para> +This needs to be copied to <filename>/usr/lib/cups/filter/cupsomatic</filename> +and be made world executable. This filter is needed to read and act upon the +specially encoded Foomatic comments, embedded in the printfile, which in turn +are used to construct (transparently for you, the user) the complicated +ghostscript command line needed for your printer/driver combo. +</para> + +<para> +You can have a look at all the options for the Ghostscript commandline supported +by your printer and the ljet4 driver by going to the section "Execution details", +selecting your model (Laserjet 4 Plus) and clicking on "Show execution details". +This will bring up this web page: +</para> + +<para><ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/execution.cgi?driver=ljet4&printer=75104&.submit=Show+execution+details">http://www.linuxprinting.org/execution.cgi?driver=ljet4&printer=75104&.submit=Show+execution+details</ulink></para> + +<para> +The ingenious thing is that the database is kept current. If there +is a bug fix and an improvement somewhere in the database, you will +always get the most current and stable and feature-rich driver by following +the steps described above. +</para> + +<note><para> +Till Kamppeter from MandrakeSoft is doing an excellent job here that too few +people are aware of. (So if you use it often, please send him a note showing +your appreciation).</para></note> + +<para> +The latest and greatest improvement now is support for "custom page sizes" +for all those printers which support it. +</para> + +<para> +"cupsomatic" is documented here: +</para> + +<para><ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/cups-doc.html">http://www.linuxprinting.org/cups-doc.html</ulink></para> + +<para> +More printing tutorial info may be found here: +</para> + +<para><ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/kpfeifle/LinuxKongress2002/Tutorial/">http://www.linuxprinting.org/kpfeifle/LinuxKongress2002/Tutorial/</ulink></para> + +<para> +Note, that *all* the Foomatic drivers listed on Linuxprinting.org (now +approaching the "all-time high" number of 1.000 for the supported models) +are using a special filtering chain involving Ghostscript, as described +in this document. +</para> + +<para> +Summary - You need: +</para> + +<para> +<simplelist> + <member>A "foomatic+<replaceable>something</replaceable>" PPD is not enough to print with CUPS (but it is *one* important component)</member> + <member>The "cupsomatic" filter script (Perl) in <filename>/usr/lib/cups/filters/</filename></member> + <member>Perl to make cupsomatic run</member> + <member>Ghostscript (because it is called and controlled by the PPD/cupsomatic combo in a way to fit your printermodel/driver combo.</member> + <member>Ghostscript *must*, depending on the driver/model, contain support for a certain "device" (as shown by "gs -h")</member> +</simplelist> +</para> + +<para> +In the case of the "hpijs" driver, you need a Ghostscript version, which +has "ijs" amongst its supported devices in "gs -h". In the case of +"hpijs+foomatic", a valid ghostscript commandline would be reading like this: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + gs -q -dBATCH -dPARANOIDSAFER -dQUIET -dNOPAUSE -sDEVICE=ijs \ + -sIjsServer=hpijs<replaceable>PageSize</replaceable> -dDuplex=<replaceable>Duplex</replaceable> <replaceable>Model</replaceable> \ + -r<replaceable>Resolution</replaceable>,PS:MediaPosition=<replaceable>InputSlot</replaceable> -dIjsUseOutputFD \ + -sOutputFile=- - +</programlisting></para> + +<note><para> +Note, that with CUPS and the "hpijs+foomatic" PPD (plus Perl and cupsomatic) +you don't need to remember this. You can choose the available print options +thru a GUI print command (like "glp" from ESP's commercially supported +PrintPro software, or KDE's "kprinter", or GNOME's "gtklp" or the independent +"xpp") or the CUPS web interface via human-readable drop-down selection +menus. +</para></note> + +<para> +If you use "ESP Ghostscript" (also under the GPL, provided by Easy Software +Products, the makers of CUPS, downloadable from +<ulink url="http://www.cups.org/software.html">http://www.cups.org/software.html</ulink>, +co-maintained by the developers of linuxprinting.org), you are guaranteed to +have in use the most uptodate, bug-fixed, enhanced and stable version of a Free +Ghostscript. It contains support for ~300 devices, whereas plain vanilla +GNU Ghostscript 7.05 only has ~200. +</para> + +<para> +If you print only one CUPS test page, from the web interface and when you try to +print a windows test page, it acts like the job was never sent: + +<simplelist> + <member>Can you print "standard" jobs from the CUPS machine?</member> + <member>Are the jobs from Windows visible in the Web interface on CUPS (http://localhost:631/)?</member> + <member><emphasis>Most important:</emphasis> What kind of printer driver are you using on the Windows clients?</member> +</simplelist> + +You can try to get a more detailed debugging info by setting "LogLevel debug" in +<filename>/etc/cups/cupsd.conf</filename>, re-start cupsd and investigate <filename>/var/log/cups/error_log</filename> +for the whereabouts of your Windows-originating printjobs: +</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>what does the "auto-typing" line say? which is the "MIME type" CUPS thinks is arriving from the Windows clients?</member> + <member>are there "filter" available for this MIME type?</member> + <member>are there "filter rules" defined in "/etc/cups/mime.convs" for this MIME type?</member> +</simplelist> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>Limiting the number of pages users can print</title> + +<para> +The feature you want is dependent on the real print subsystem you're using. +Samba's part is always to receive the job files from the clients (filtered +*or* unfiltered) and hand it over to this printing subsystem. +</para> + +<para> +Of course one could "hack" things with one's own scripts. +</para> + +<para> +But there is CUPS (Common Unix Printing System). CUPS supports "quotas". +Quotas can be based on sizes of jobs or on the number of pages or both, +and are spanning any time period you want. +</para> + +<para> +This is an example command how root would set a print quota in CUPS, +assuming an existing printer named "quotaprinter": +</para> + +<programlisting> + lpadmin -p quotaprinter -o job-quota-period=604800 -o job-k-limit=1024 \ + -o job-page-limit=100 +</programlisting> + +<para> +This would limit every single user to print 100 pages or 1024 KB of +data (whichever comes first) within the last 604.800 seconds ( = 1 week). +</para> + +<para> +For CUPS to count correctly, the printfile needs to pass the CUPS "pstops" filter, +otherwise it uses a "dummy" count of "1". Some printfiles don't pass it +(eg: image files) but then those are mostly 1 page jobs anyway. This also means, +proprietary drivers for the target printer running on the client computers and +CUPS/Samba then spooling these files as "raw" (i.e. leaving them untouched, not +filtering them), will be counted as "1-pagers" too! +</para> + +<para> +You need to send PostScript from the clients (i.e. run a PostScript driver there) +for having the chance to get accounting done. If the printer is a non-PostScript model, +you need to let CUPS do the job to convert the file to a print-ready format for the +target printer. This will be working for currently ~1.000 different printer models, see +</para> + +<programlisting> + http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi +</programlisting> + +<para> +Before CUPS-1.1.16 your only option was to use the Adobe PostScript +Driver on the Windows clients. The output of this driver was not always +passed thru the "pstops" filter on the CUPS/Samba side, and therefor was +not counted correctly (the reason is that it often --- depending on the +"PPD" being used --- did write a "PJL"-header in front of the real +PostScript which made CUPS to skip the pstops and go directy to +the "pstoraster" stage). +</para> + +<para> +From CUPS-1.1.16 onward you can use the "CUPS PostScript Driver +for Windows NT/2K/XP clients" (it is tagged in the download area of +http://www.cups.org/ as the "cups-samba-1.1.16.tar.gz" package). +It is *not* working for Win9x/ME clients. But it: +</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>it guarantees to not write an PJL-header</member> + <member>it guarantees to still read and support all PJL-options named in the driver PPD with its own means</member> + <member>it guarantees the file going thru the "pstops" filter on the CUPS/Samba server</member> + <member>it guarantees to page-count correctly the printfile</member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +You can read more about the setup of this combination in the +manpage for "cupsaddsmb" (only present with CUPS installed, only +current with CUPS 1.1.16). +</para> + +<para> +These are the items CUPS logs in the "page_log" for every single *page* of a job: +</para> + +<para><simplelist> +<member>Printer name</member> +<member>User name</member> +<member>Job ID</member> +<member>Time of printing</member> +<member>the page number</member> +<member>the number of copies</member> +<member>a billing info string (optional)</member> +</simplelist> +</para> + +<para> +Here is an extract of my CUPS server's page_log file to illustrate +the format and included items: +</para> + +<para><computeroutput> + infotec_IS2027 kurt 40 [22/Nov/2002:13:18:03 +0100] 1 2 #marketing + infotec_IS2027 kurt 40 [22/Nov/2002:13:18:03 +0100] 2 2 #marketing + infotec_IS2027 kurt 40 [22/Nov/2002:13:18:03 +0100] 3 2 #marketing + infotec_IS2027 kurt 40 [22/Nov/2002:13:18:03 +0100] 4 2 #marketing + infotec_IS2027 kurt 40 [22/Nov/2002:13:18:03 +0100] 5 2 #marketing + infotec_IS2027 kurt 40 [22/Nov/2002:13:18:03 +0100] 6 2 #marketing +</computeroutput></para> + +<para> +This was Job ID "40", printed on "infotec_IS2027" by user "kurt", a 6-page job +printed in 2 copies and billed to "#marketing"... +</para> + +<para> +What flaws or shortcomings are there? +</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>the ones named above</member> + + <member> + CUPS really counts the job pages being *processsed in software* + (going thru the "RIP") rather than the physical sheets successfully + leaving the printing device -- if there is a jam while printing + the 5th sheet out of 1000 and the job is aborted by the printer, + the "page count" will still show the figure of 1000 for that job + </member> + + <member> + all quotas are the same for all users (no flexibility to give the + boss a higher quota than the clerk) no support for groups + </member> + + <member> + no means to read out the current balance or "used-up" number of current quota + </member> + + <member> + a user having used up 99 sheets of 100 quota will still be able to send and print a 1.000 sheet job + </member> + + <member> + a user being denied a job because of a filled-up quota doesn't get a meaningful + error message from CUPS other than "client-error-not-possible". + </member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +But this is the best system out there currently. And there are +huge improvements under development: +</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>page counting will go into the "backends" (these talk + directly to the printer and will increase the count in sync with the + actual printing process -- a jam at the 5th sheet will lead to a stop in the counting)</member> + + <member>quotas will be handled more flexibly</member> + + <member>probably there will be support for users to inquire their "accounts" in advance</member> + + <member>probably there will be support for some other tools around this topic</member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +Other than the current stage of the CUPS development, I don't +know any other ready-to-use tool which you could consider. +</para> + +<para> +You can download the driver files from +<ulink url="http://www.cups.org/software.html">http://www.cups.org/software.html</ulink>. +It is a separate package from the CUPS base software files, tagged as "CUPS 1.1.16 +Windows NT/2k/XP Printer Driver for SAMBA (tar.gz, 192k)". The filename to +download is "cups-samba-1.1.16.tar.gz". Upon untar-/unzip-ping it will reveal +the files: +</para> + +<para> +<computeroutput> + cups-samba.install + cups-samba.license + cups-samba.readme + cups-samba.remove + cups-samba.ss +</computeroutput> +</para> + +<para> +These have been packaged with the ESP meta packager software "EPM". The +*.install and *.remove files are simple shell script, which untars the +*.ss (which is nothing else than a tar-archive) and puts its contents +into <filename>/usr/share/cups/drivers/</filename>. Its contents are 3 files: +</para> + +<para> +<computeroutput> + cupsdrvr.dll + cupsui.dll + cups.hlp +</computeroutput> +</para> + +<caution><para> +Due to a bug one CUPS release puts the <filename>cups.hlp</filename> +into <filename>/usr/share/drivers/</filename> instead of +<filename>/usr/share/cups/drivers/</filename>. To work around this, copy/move +the file after running the "./cups-samba.install" script manually to the right place: +</para> + + <para> +<userinput> cp /usr/share/drivers/cups.hlp /usr/share/cups/drivers/ +</userinput> + </para></caution> + +<note> +<para> +This new CUPS PostScript driver is currently binary-only, but free +no source code is provided (yet). The reason is this: it has +been developed with the help of the Microsoft Driver Developer Kit (DDK) +and compiled with Microsoft Visual Studio 6. It is not clear to the driver +developers if they are allowed to distribute the whole of the source code +as Free Software. However, they will likely release the "diff" in source +code under the GPL, so anybody with a license of Visual Studio and a DDK +will be able to compile for him/herself. +</para> + +<para> +Once you have run the install script (and possibly manually moved the +"cups.hlp" file to "/usr/share/cups/drivers/"), the driver is ready to be +put into Samba's [print$] share (which often maps to "/etc/samba/drivers/" +and contains a subdir tree with WIN40 and W32X86 branches), by running +"cupsaddsmb" (see also "man cupsaddsmb" for CUPS 1.1.16). [Don't forget to +put root into the smbpasswd file by running "smbpasswd" should you run +this whole procedure for the first time.] Once the driver files are in the +[print$] share, they are ready to be downloaded and installed by the +Win NT/2k/XP clients. +</para></note> + + + <note><para> + Win 9x/ME clients won't work with this driver. For these you'd + still need to use the ADOBE*.* drivers as previously. + </para></note> + + <note><para> + It is not harming if you've still the ADOBE*.* driver files from + previous installations in the "/usr/share/cups/drivers/" directory. + The new cupsaddsmb (from 1.1.16) will automatically use the + "newest" installed driver (which here then is the CUPS drivers). + </para></note> + + <note><para> + Should your Win clients have had the old ADOBE*.* files and the + Adobe PostScript drivers installed, the download and installation + of the new CUPS PostScript driver for Windows NT/2k/XP will fail + at first. + </para> + <para> + It is not enough to "delete" the printer (as the driver files + will still be kept by the clients and re-used if you try to + re-install the printer). To really get rid of the Adobe driver + files on the clients, open the "Printers" folder (possibly via + "Start --> Settings --> Control Panel --> Printers"), right-click + onto the folder background and select "Server Properties". A + new dialog opens; select the "Drivers" tab; on the list select + the driver you want to delete and click on the "Delete" button. + (This will only work if there is no single printer left which + uses that particular driver -- you need to "delete" all printers + using this driver in the "Printers" folder first.) + </para> + </note> + + <note><para> + Once you have successfully downloaded the CUPS PostScript driver + to a client, you can easily switch all printers to this one + by proceeding as described elsewhere in the "Samba HOWTO + Collection" to change a driver for an existing printer. + </para></note> + +<para> +What are the benefits with the "CUPS PostScript driver for Windows NT/2k/XP" +as compared to the Adobe drivers? +</para> + +<para> +<simplelist> + <member><para> + no hassle with the Adobe EULA + </para></member> + + <member><para> + no hassle with the question "where do I get the ADOBE*.* driver files from?" + </para></member> + + <member><para> + the Adobe drivers (depending on the printer PPD associated with them) + often put a PJL header in front of the core PostScript part of the print + file (thus the file starts with "<replaceable>1B</replaceable>%-12345X" + or "<replaceable>escape</replaceable>%-12345X" + instead of "%!PS"). This leads to the CUPS daemon autotyping the + arriving file as a print-ready file, not requiring a pass thru the + "pstops" filter (to speak more technical, it is not regarded as the + generic MIME type "application/postscript", but as the more special + MIME type "application/cups.vnd-postscript"), which therefore also + leads to the page accounting in "/var/log/cups/page_log" not receiving + the exact mumber of pages; instead the dummy page number of "1" is + logged in a standard setup) + </para></member> + + <member><para> + the Adobe driver has more options to "mis-configure" the PostScript + generated by it (like setting it inadvertedly to "Optimize for Speed", + instead of "Optimize for Portability", which could lead to CUPS being + unable to process it) + </para></member> + + <member><para> + the CUPS PostScript driver output sent by Windows clients to the CUPS + server will be guaranteed to be auto-typed as generic MIME type + "application/postscript", thusly passing thru the CUPS "pstops" filter + and logging the correct number of pages in the page_log for accounting + and quota purposes + </para></member> + + <member><para> + the CUPS PostScript driver supports the sending of additional print + options by the Win NT/2k/XP clients, such as naming the CUPS standard + banner pages (or the custom ones, should they be installed at the time + of driver download), using the CUPS "page-label" option, setting a + job-priority and setting the scheduled time of printing (with the option + to support additional useful IPP job attributes in the future). + </para></member> + + <member><para> + the CUPS PostScript driver supports the inclusion of the new + "*cupsJobTicket" comments at the beginnig of the PostScript file (which + could be used in the future for all sort of beneficial extensions on + the CUPS side, but which will not disturb any other application as those + will regard it as a comment and simply ignore it). + </para></member> + + <member><para> + the CUPS PostScript driver will be the heart of the fully fledged CUPS + IPP client for Windows NT/2k/XP to be released soon (probably alongside + the first Beta release for CUPS 1.2). + </para></member> + +</simplelist> +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Advanced Postscript Printing from MS Windows</title> + +<para> +Let the Windows Clients use a PostScript driver to deliver poistscript to +the samba print server (just like any Linux or Unix Client would also use +PostScript to send to the server) +</para> + +<para> +Make the Unix printing subsystem to which Samba sends the job convert the +incoming PostScript files to the native print format of the target printers +(would be PCL if you have an HP printer) +</para> + +<para> +Now if you are afraid that this would just mean using a *Generic* PostScript +driver for the clients that has no Simplex/Duplex selection, and no paper tray +choice, but you need them to be able to set up print jobs, with all the bells +and whistles of your printers:- +</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>Not possible with traditional spooling systems</member> + + <member> + But perfectly supported by CUPS (which uses "PPD" files to + describe how to control the print options for PostScript and + non-PostScript devices alike... + </member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +CUPS PPDs are working perfectly on Windows clients who use Adobe PostScript +drivers (or the new CUPS PostScript driver for Windows NT/2K/XP). Clients can use +them to setup the job to their liking and CUPS will use the received job options +to make the (PCL-, ESC/P- or PostScript-) printer behave as required. +</para> + +<para> +If you want to have the additional benefit of page count logging and accounting +then the CUPS PostScript driver is the best choice (better than the Adobe one). +</para> + +<para> +If you want to make the drivers downloadable for the clients then "cupsaddsmb" is +your friend. It will setup the [print$] share on the Samba host to be ready to serve +the clients for a "point and print" driver installation. +</para> + +<warning> +<para>What strings are attached?</para></warning> + +<para> +There are some. But, given the sheer CPU power you can buy nowadays, +these can be overcome easily. The strings: +</para> + +<para> +Well, if the CUPS/Samba side will have to print to many printers serving many users, +you probably will need to set up a second server (which can do automatic load balancing +with the first one, plus a degree of fail-over mechanism). Converting the incoming +PostScript jobs, "interpreting" them for non-PostScript printers, amounts to the work +of a "RIP" (Raster Image Processor) done in software. This requires more CPU and RAM +than for the mere "raw spooling" task your current setup is solving. It all depends +on the avarage and peak printing load the server should be able to handle. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Auto-Deletion of CUPS spool files</title> + +<para> +Samba print files pass thru two "spool" directories. One the incoming directory +managed by Samba, (set eg: in the <command>path = /var/spool/samba</command> directive in the [printers] +section of &smb.conf;). Second is the spool directory of your UNIX print subsystem. +For CUPS it is normally "/var/spool/cups/", as set by the cupsd.conf directive +"RequestRoot /var/spool/cups". +</para> + +<para> +I am not sure, which one of your directories keeps the files. From what you say, +it is most likely the Samba part. +</para> + +<para> +For the CUPS part, you may want to consult: +</para> + +<simplelist> +<member>http://localhost:631/sam.html#PreserveJobFiles</member> +<member>http://localhost:631/sam.html#PreserveJobHistory</member> +<member>http://localhost:631/sam.html#MaxJobs</member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +There are the settings described for your CUPS daemon, which could lead to completed +job files not being deleted. +</para> + +<para> +"PreserveJobHistory Yes" -- keeps some details of jobs in +cupsd's mind (well it keeps the "c12345", "c12346" etc. files +in the CUPS spool directory, which do a similar job as the +old-fashioned BSD-LPD control files). This is set to "Yes" +as a default. +</para> + +<para> +"PreserveJobFiles Yes" -- keeps the job files themselves in +cupsd's mind (well it keeps the "d12345", "d12346" etc. files +in the CUPS spool directory...). This is set to "No" as the +CUPS default. +</para> + +<para> +"MaxJobs 500" -- this directive controls the maximum number +of jobs that are kept in memory. Once the number of jobs +reaches the limit, the oldest completed job is automatically +purged from the system to make room for the new one. If all +of the known jobs are still pending or active then the new +job will be rejected. Setting the maximum to 0 disables this +functionality. The default setting is 0. +</para> + +<para> +(There are also additional settings for "MaxJobsPerUser" and +"MaxJobsPerPrinter"...) +</para> + +<para> +For everything to work as announced, you need to have three things: +</para> + +<simplelist> + + <member> + a Samba-&smbd; which is compiled against "libcups" (Check on Linux by running <userinput>ldd `which smbd`</userinput>) + </member> + + <member> + a Samba-&smb.conf; setting of <command>printing = cups</command> + </member> + + <member> + another Samba-&smb.conf; setting of <command>printcap = cups</command> + </member> + +</simplelist> + +<note><para> +Note, that in this case all other manually set printing-related +commands (like "print command", "lpq command", "lprm command", +"lppause command" or "lpresume command") are ignored and they +should normally have no influence what-so-ever on your printing. +</para></note> + +<para> +If you want to do things manually, replace the "printing = cups" +by "printing = bsd". Then your manually set commands may work +(haven't tested this), and a "print command = lp -d %P %s; rm %s" +may do what you need. +</para> + +<para> +You forgot to mention the CUPS version you're using. If you did +set things up as described in the man pages, then the Samba +spool files should be deleted. Otherwise it may be a bug. On +the CUPS side, you can control the behaviour as described +above. +</para> + +<para> +If you have more problems, post the output of these commands: +</para> + +<para> +<userinput> + grep -v ^# /etc/cups/cupsd.conf | grep -v ^$ + grep -v ^# /etc/samba/smb.conf | grep -v ^$ | grep -v "^;" +</userinput> +</para> + +<para> +(adapt paths as needed). These commands sanitize the files +and cut out the empty lines and lines with comments, providing +the "naked settings" in a compact way. +</para> +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Compiling.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Compiling.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..9638663dde7 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Compiling.xml @@ -0,0 +1,438 @@ +<chapter id="compiling"> +<chapterinfo> + <author> + <affiliation> + <orgname>Samba Team</orgname> + </affiliation> + </author> + &author.jelmer; + + <pubdate> (22 May 2001) </pubdate> + <pubdate> 18 March 2003 </pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>How to compile SAMBA</title> + +<para> +You can obtain the samba source from the <ulink url="http://samba.org/">samba website</ulink>. To obtain a development version, +you can download samba from CVS or using rsync. +</para> + +<sect1> +<title>Access Samba source code via CVS</title> + +<sect2> +<title>Introduction</title> + +<para> +Samba is developed in an open environment. Developers use CVS +(Concurrent Versioning System) to "checkin" (also known as +"commit") new source code. Samba's various CVS branches can +be accessed via anonymous CVS using the instructions +detailed in this chapter. +</para> + +<para> +This chapter is a modified version of the instructions found at +<ulink url="http://samba.org/samba/cvs.html">http://samba.org/samba/cvs.html</ulink> +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>CVS Access to samba.org</title> + +<para> +The machine samba.org runs a publicly accessible CVS +repository for access to the source code of several packages, +including samba, rsync and jitterbug. There are two main ways of +accessing the CVS server on this host. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>Access via CVSweb</title> + +<para> +You can access the source code via your +favourite WWW browser. This allows you to access the contents of +individual files in the repository and also to look at the revision +history and commit logs of individual files. You can also ask for a diff +listing between any two versions on the repository. +</para> + +<para> +Use the URL : <ulink +url="http://samba.org/cgi-bin/cvsweb">http://samba.org/cgi-bin/cvsweb</ulink> +</para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Access via cvs</title> + +<para> +You can also access the source code via a +normal cvs client. This gives you much more control over what you can +do with the repository and allows you to checkout whole source trees +and keep them up to date via normal cvs commands. This is the +preferred method of access if you are a developer and not +just a casual browser. +</para> + +<para> +To download the latest cvs source code, point your +browser at the URL : <ulink url="http://www.cyclic.com/">http://www.cyclic.com/</ulink>. +and click on the 'How to get cvs' link. CVS is free software under +the GNU GPL (as is Samba). Note that there are several graphical CVS clients +which provide a graphical interface to the sometimes mundane CVS commands. +Links to theses clients are also available from http://www.cyclic.com. +</para> + +<para> +To gain access via anonymous cvs use the following steps. +For this example it is assumed that you want a copy of the +samba source code. For the other source code repositories +on this system just substitute the correct package name +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem> + <para> + Install a recent copy of cvs. All you really need is a + copy of the cvs client binary. + </para> +</listitem> + + +<listitem> + <para> + Run the command + </para> + + <para> + <userinput>cvs -d :pserver:cvs@samba.org:/cvsroot login</userinput> + </para> + + <para> + When it asks you for a password type <userinput>cvs</userinput>. + </para> +</listitem> + + +<listitem> + <para> + Run the command + </para> + + <para> + <userinput>cvs -d :pserver:cvs@samba.org:/cvsroot co samba</userinput> + </para> + + <para> + This will create a directory called samba containing the + latest samba source code (i.e. the HEAD tagged cvs branch). This + currently corresponds to the 3.0 development tree. + </para> + + <para> + CVS branches other then HEAD can be obtained by using the <parameter>-r</parameter> + and defining a tag name. A list of branch tag names can be found on the + "Development" page of the samba web site. A common request is to obtain the + latest 2.2 release code. This could be done by using the following userinput. + </para> + + <para> + <userinput>cvs -d :pserver:cvs@samba.org:/cvsroot co -r SAMBA_2_2 samba</userinput> + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + Whenever you want to merge in the latest code changes use + the following command from within the samba directory: + </para> + + <para> + <userinput>cvs update -d -P</userinput> + </para> +</listitem> +</orderedlist> + +</sect3> +</sect2> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</title> + + <para> + pserver.samba.org also exports unpacked copies of most parts of the CVS tree at <ulink url="ftp://pserver.samba.org/pub/unpacked">ftp://pserver.samba.org/pub/unpacked</ulink> and also via anonymous rsync at rsync://pserver.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/. I recommend using rsync rather than ftp. + See <ulink url="http://rsync.samba.org/">the rsync homepage</ulink> for more info on rsync. + </para> + + <para> + The disadvantage of the unpacked trees + is that they do not support automatic + merging of local changes like CVS does. + rsync access is most convenient for an + initial install. + </para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Verifying Samba's PGP signature</title> + +<para> +In these days of insecurity, it's strongly recommended that you verify the PGP signature for any +source file before installing it. According to Jerry Carter of the Samba Team, only about 22% of +all Samba downloads have had a corresponding PGP signature download (a very low percentage, which +should be considered a bad thing). Even if you're not downloading from a mirror site, verifying PGP +signatures should be a standard reflex. +</para> + + +<para> +With that said, go ahead and download the following files: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + $ wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc + $ wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-pubkey.asc +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The first file is the PGP signature for the Samba source file; the other is the Samba public +PGP key itself. Import the public PGP key with: +</para> + +<programlisting> + $ gpg --import samba-pubkey.asc +</programlisting> + +<para> +And verify the Samba source code integrity with: +</para> + +<programlisting> + $ gzip -d samba-2.2.8a.tar.gz + $ gpg --verify samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc +</programlisting> + +<para> +If you receive a message like, "Good signature from Samba Distribution Verification Key..." +then all is well. The warnings about trust relationships can be ignored. An example of what +you would not want to see would be: +</para> + +<programlisting> + gpg: BAD signature from "Samba Distribution Verification Key" +</programlisting> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Building the Binaries</title> + + <para>To do this, first run the program <userinput>./configure + </userinput> in the source directory. This should automatically + configure Samba for your operating system. If you have unusual + needs then you may wish to run</para> + + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>./configure --help + </userinput></para> + + <para>first to see what special options you can enable. + Then executing</para> + + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>make</userinput></para> + + <para>will create the binaries. Once it's successfully + compiled you can use </para> + + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>make install</userinput></para> + + <para>to install the binaries and manual pages. You can + separately install the binaries and/or man pages using</para> + + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>make installbin + </userinput></para> + + <para>and</para> + + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>make installman + </userinput></para> + + <para>Note that if you are upgrading for a previous version + of Samba you might like to know that the old versions of + the binaries will be renamed with a ".old" extension. You + can go back to the previous version with</para> + + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>make revert + </userinput></para> + + <para>if you find this version a disaster!</para> + + <sect2> + <title>Compiling samba with Active Directory support</title> + + <para>In order to compile samba with ADS support, you need to have installed + on your system:</para> + <itemizedlist> + + <listitem><para>the MIT kerberos development libraries + (either install from the sources or use a package). The + heimdal libraries will not work.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>the OpenLDAP development libraries.</para></listitem> + + </itemizedlist> + + <para>If your kerberos libraries are in a non-standard location then + remember to add the configure option --with-krb5=DIR.</para> + + <para>After you run configure make sure that <filename>include/config.h</filename> it generates contains lines like this:</para> + + <para><programlisting> +#define HAVE_KRB5 1 +#define HAVE_LDAP 1 +</programlisting></para> + + <para>If it doesn't then configure did not find your krb5 libraries or + your ldap libraries. Look in config.log to figure out why and fix + it.</para> + + <sect3> + <title>Installing the required packages for Debian</title> + + <para>On Debian you need to install the following packages:</para> + <para> + <itemizedlist> + <listitem>libkrb5-dev</listitem> + <listitem>krb5-user</listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3> + <title>Installing the required packages for RedHat</title> + + <para>On RedHat this means you should have at least: </para> + <para> + <itemizedlist> + <listitem>krb5-workstation (for kinit)</listitem> + <listitem>krb5-libs (for linking with)</listitem> + <listitem>krb5-devel (because you are compiling from source)</listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + + <para>in addition to the standard development environment.</para> + + <para>Note that these are not standard on a RedHat install, and you may need + to get them off CD2.</para> + + </sect3> + + </sect2> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Starting the smbd and nmbd</title> + + <para>You must choose to start smbd and nmbd either + as daemons or from <application>inetd</application>Don't try + to do both! Either you can put them in <filename> + inetd.conf</filename> and have them started on demand + by <application>inetd</application>, or you can start them as + daemons either from the command line or in <filename> + /etc/rc.local</filename>. See the man pages for details + on the command line options. Take particular care to read + the bit about what user you need to be in order to start + Samba. In many cases you must be root.</para> + + <para>The main advantage of starting <application>smbd</application> + and <application>nmbd</application> using the recommended daemon method + is that they will respond slightly more quickly to an initial connection + request.</para> + + <sect2> + <title>Starting from inetd.conf</title> + + <para>NOTE; The following will be different if + you use NIS, NIS+ or LDAP to distribute services maps.</para> + + <para>Look at your <filename>/etc/services</filename>. + What is defined at port 139/tcp. If nothing is defined + then add a line like this:</para> + + <para><userinput>netbios-ssn 139/tcp</userinput></para> + + <para>similarly for 137/udp you should have an entry like:</para> + + <para><userinput>netbios-ns 137/udp</userinput></para> + + <para>Next edit your <filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename> + and add two lines something like this:</para> + + <para><programlisting> + netbios-ssn stream tcp nowait root /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd smbd + netbios-ns dgram udp wait root /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd nmbd + </programlisting></para> + + <para>The exact syntax of <filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename> + varies between unixes. Look at the other entries in inetd.conf + for a guide.</para> + + <note><para>Some unixes already have entries like netbios_ns + (note the underscore) in <filename>/etc/services</filename>. + You must either edit <filename>/etc/services</filename> or + <filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename> to make them consistent.</para></note> + + <note><para>On many systems you may need to use the + <command>interfaces</command> option in &smb.conf; to specify the IP address + and netmask of your interfaces. Run <application>ifconfig</application> + as root if you don't know what the broadcast is for your + net. &nmbd; tries to determine it at run + time, but fails on some unixes. + </para></note> + + <warning><para>Many unixes only accept around 5 + parameters on the command line in <filename>inetd.conf</filename>. + This means you shouldn't use spaces between the options and + arguments, or you should use a script, and start the script + from <command>inetd</command>.</para></warning> + + <para>Restart <command>inetd</command>, perhaps just send + it a HUP. If you have installed an earlier version of <application> + nmbd</application> then you may need to kill nmbd as well.</para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Alternative: starting it as a daemon</title> + + <para>To start the server as a daemon you should create + a script something like this one, perhaps calling + it <filename>startsmb</filename>.</para> + + <para><programlisting> + #!/bin/sh + /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -D + /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd -D + </programlisting></para> + + <para>then make it executable with <command>chmod + +x startsmb</command></para> + + <para>You can then run <command>startsmb</command> by + hand or execute it from <filename>/etc/rc.local</filename> + </para> + + <para>To kill it send a kill signal to the processes + <command>nmbd</command> and <command>smbd</command>.</para> + + <note><para>If you use the SVR4 style init system then + you may like to look at the <filename>examples/svr4-startup</filename> + script to make Samba fit into that system.</para></note> + </sect2> +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/DOMAIN_MEMBER.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/DOMAIN_MEMBER.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..a5921e8ce37 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/DOMAIN_MEMBER.xml @@ -0,0 +1,161 @@ +<chapter id="domain-member"> + +<chapterinfo> + &author.jeremy; + &author.jerry; + <pubdate>16 Apr 2001</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + + +<title>Samba as a NT4 or Win2k domain member</title> + +<sect1> + + <title>Joining an NT Domain with Samba 3.0</title> + <para><emphasis>Assumptions:</emphasis> + <programlisting> + NetBIOS name: SERV1 + Win2K/NT domain name: DOM + Domain's PDC NetBIOS name: DOMPDC + Domain's BDC NetBIOS names: DOMBDC1 and DOMBDC2 + </programlisting> + </para> + + <para>First, you must edit your &smb.conf; file to tell Samba it should + now use domain security.</para> + + <para>Change (or add) your <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY"> + <parameter>security =</parameter></ulink> line in the [global] section + of your &smb.conf; to read:</para> + + <para><command>security = domain</command></para> + + <para>Next change the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP"><parameter> + workgroup =</parameter></ulink> line in the [global] section to read: </para> + + <para><command>workgroup = DOM</command></para> + + <para>as this is the name of the domain we are joining. </para> + + <para>You must also have the parameter <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"> + <parameter>encrypt passwords</parameter></ulink> set to <constant>yes + </constant> in order for your users to authenticate to the NT PDC.</para> + + <para>Finally, add (or modify) a <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDSERVER"> + <parameter>password server =</parameter></ulink> line in the [global] + section to read: </para> + + <para><command>password server = DOMPDC DOMBDC1 DOMBDC2</command></para> + + <para>These are the primary and backup domain controllers Samba + will attempt to contact in order to authenticate users. Samba will + try to contact each of these servers in order, so you may want to + rearrange this list in order to spread out the authentication load + among domain controllers.</para> + + <para>Alternatively, if you want smbd to automatically determine + the list of Domain controllers to use for authentication, you may + set this line to be :</para> + + <para><command>password server = *</command></para> + + <para>This method, allows Samba to use exactly the same + mechanism that NT does. This + method either broadcasts or uses a WINS database in order to + find domain controllers to authenticate against.</para> + + <para>In order to actually join the domain, you must run this + command:</para> + + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>net join -S DOMPDC + -U<replaceable>Administrator%password</replaceable></userinput></para> + + <para> + If the <userinput>-S DOMPDC</userinput> argument is not given then + the domain name will be obtained from smb.conf. + </para> + + <para>as we are joining the domain DOM and the PDC for that domain + (the only machine that has write access to the domain SAM database) + is DOMPDC. The <replaceable>Administrator%password</replaceable> is + the login name and password for an account which has the necessary + privilege to add machines to the domain. If this is successful + you will see the message:</para> + + <para><computeroutput>Joined domain DOM.</computeroutput> + or <computeroutput>Joined 'SERV1' to realm 'MYREALM'</computeroutput> + </para> + + <para>in your terminal window. See the <ulink url="net.8.html"> + net(8)</ulink> man page for more details.</para> + + <para>This process joins the server to the domain + without having to create the machine trust account on the PDC + beforehand.</para> + + <para>This command goes through the machine account password + change protocol, then writes the new (random) machine account + password for this Samba server into a file in the same directory + in which an smbpasswd file would be stored - normally :</para> + + <para><filename>/usr/local/samba/private/secrets.tdb</filename></para> + + <para>This file is created and owned by root and is not + readable by any other user. It is the key to the domain-level + security for your system, and should be treated as carefully + as a shadow password file.</para> + + <para>Finally, restart your Samba daemons and get ready for + clients to begin using domain security!</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Why is this better than security = server?</title> + + <para>Currently, domain security in Samba doesn't free you from + having to create local Unix users to represent the users attaching + to your server. This means that if domain user <constant>DOM\fred + </constant> attaches to your domain security Samba server, there needs + to be a local Unix user fred to represent that user in the Unix + filesystem. This is very similar to the older Samba security mode + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYEQUALSSERVER">security = server</ulink>, + where Samba would pass through the authentication request to a Windows + NT server in the same way as a Windows 95 or Windows 98 server would. + </para> + + <para>Please refer to the <ulink url="winbind.html">Winbind + paper</ulink> for information on a system to automatically + assign UNIX uids and gids to Windows NT Domain users and groups. + </para> + + <para>The advantage to domain-level security is that the + authentication in domain-level security is passed down the authenticated + RPC channel in exactly the same way that an NT server would do it. This + means Samba servers now participate in domain trust relationships in + exactly the same way NT servers do (i.e., you can add Samba servers into + a resource domain and have the authentication passed on from a resource + domain PDC to an account domain PDC).</para> + + <para>In addition, with <command>security = server</command> every Samba + daemon on a server has to keep a connection open to the + authenticating server for as long as that daemon lasts. This can drain + the connection resources on a Microsoft NT server and cause it to run + out of available connections. With <command>security = domain</command>, + however, the Samba daemons connect to the PDC/BDC only for as long + as is necessary to authenticate the user, and then drop the connection, + thus conserving PDC connection resources.</para> + + <para>And finally, acting in the same manner as an NT server + authenticating to a PDC means that as part of the authentication + reply, the Samba server gets the user identification information such + as the user SID, the list of NT groups the user belongs to, etc. </para> + + <note><para> Much of the text of this document + was first published in the Web magazine <ulink url="http://www.linuxworld.com"> + LinuxWorld</ulink> as the article <ulink + url="http://www.linuxworld.com/linuxworld/lw-1998-10/lw-10-samba.html">Doing + the NIS/NT Samba</ulink>.</para></note> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Diagnosis.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Diagnosis.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..150f071b780 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Diagnosis.xml @@ -0,0 +1,522 @@ +<chapter id="diagnosis"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.tridge; + &author.jelmer; + <pubdate>Wed Jan 15</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>The samba checklist</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Introduction</title> + +<para> +This file contains a list of tests you can perform to validate your +Samba server. It also tells you what the likely cause of the problem +is if it fails any one of these steps. If it passes all these tests +then it is probably working fine. +</para> + +<para> +You should do ALL the tests, in the order shown. We have tried to +carefully choose them so later tests only use capabilities verified in +the earlier tests. However, do not stop at the first error as there +have been some instances when continuing with the tests has helped +to solve a problem. +</para> + +<para> +If you send one of the samba mailing lists an email saying "it doesn't work" +and you have not followed this test procedure then you should not be surprised +if your email is ignored. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Assumptions</title> + +<para> +In all of the tests it is assumed you have a Samba server called +BIGSERVER and a PC called ACLIENT both in workgroup TESTGROUP. +</para> + +<para> +The procedure is similar for other types of clients. +</para> + +<para> +It is also assumed you know the name of an available share in your +&smb.conf;. I will assume this share is called <replaceable>tmp</replaceable>. +You can add a <replaceable>tmp</replaceable> share like this by adding the +following to &smb.conf;: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + +[tmp] + comment = temporary files + path = /tmp + read only = yes + +</programlisting> +</para> + +<note><para> +These tests assume version 3.0 or later of the samba suite. +Some commands shown did not exist in earlier versions. +</para></note> + +<para> +Please pay attention to the error messages you receive. If any error message +reports that your server is being unfriendly you should first check that your +IP name resolution is correctly set up. eg: Make sure your <filename>/etc/resolv.conf</filename> +file points to name servers that really do exist. +</para> + +<para> +Also, if you do not have DNS server access for name resolution please check +that the settings for your &smb.conf; file results in <command>dns proxy = no</command>. The +best way to check this is with <userinput>testparm smb.conf</userinput>. +</para> + +<para> +It is helpful to monitor the log files during testing by using the +<command>tail -F <replaceable>log_file_name</replaceable></command> in a separate +terminal console (use ctrl-alt-F1 through F6 or multiple terminals in X). +Relevant log files can be found (for default installations) in +<filename>/usr/local/samba/var</filename>. Also, connection logs from +machines can be found here or possibly in <filename>/var/log/samba</filename> +depending on how or if you specified logging in your &smb.conf; file. +</para> + +<para> +If you make changes to your &smb.conf; file while going through these test, +don't forget to restart &smbd; and &nmbd;. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>The tests</title> +<procedure> +<title>Diagnosing your samba server</title> + +<step performance="required"> +<para> +In the directory in which you store your &smb.conf; file, run the command +<userinput>testparm smb.conf</userinput>. If it reports any errors then your &smb.conf; +configuration file is faulty. +</para> + +<note><para> +Your &smb.conf; file may be located in: <filename>/etc/samba</filename> +Or in: <filename>/usr/local/samba/lib</filename> +</para></note> +</step> + +<step performance="required"> +<para> +Run the command <userinput>ping BIGSERVER</userinput> from the PC and +<userinput>ping ACLIENT</userinput> from +the unix box. If you don't get a valid response then your TCP/IP +software is not correctly installed. +</para> + +<para> +Note that you will need to start a "dos prompt" window on the PC to +run ping. +</para> + +<para> +If you get a message saying "host not found" or similar then your DNS +software or <filename>/etc/hosts</filename> file is not correctly setup. +It is possible to +run samba without DNS entries for the server and client, but I assume +you do have correct entries for the remainder of these tests. +</para> + +<para> +Another reason why ping might fail is if your host is running firewall +software. You will need to relax the rules to let in the workstation +in question, perhaps by allowing access from another subnet (on Linux +this is done via the <application>ipfwadm</application> program.) +</para> + +<para> +Note: Modern Linux distributions install ipchains/iptables by default. +This is a common problem that is often overlooked. +</para> +</step> + +<step performance="required"> +<para> +Run the command <userinput>smbclient -L BIGSERVER</userinput> on the unix box. You +should get a list of available shares back. +</para> + +<para> +If you get a error message containing the string "Bad password" then +you probably have either an incorrect <command>hosts allow</command>, +<command>hosts deny</command> or <command>valid users</command> line in your +&smb.conf;, or your guest account is not +valid. Check what your guest account is using &testparm; and +temporarily remove any <command>hosts allow</command>, <command>hosts deny</command>, <command>valid users</command> or <command>invalid users</command> lines. +</para> + +<para> +If you get a "connection refused" response then the smbd server may +not be running. If you installed it in inetd.conf then you probably edited +that file incorrectly. If you installed it as a daemon then check that +it is running, and check that the netbios-ssn port is in a LISTEN +state using <userinput>netstat -a</userinput>. +</para> + +<note><para> +Some Unix / Linux systems use <command>xinetd</command> in place of +<command>inetd</command>. Check your system documentation for the location +of the control file/s for your particular system implementation of +this network super daemon. +</para></note> + +<para> +If you get a "session request failed" then the server refused the +connection. If it says "Your server software is being unfriendly" then +its probably because you have invalid command line parameters to &smbd;, +or a similar fatal problem with the initial startup of &smbd;. Also +check your config file (&smb.conf;) for syntax errors with &testparm; +and that the various directories where samba keeps its log and lock +files exist. +</para> + +<para> +There are a number of reasons for which smbd may refuse or decline +a session request. The most common of these involve one or more of +the following &smb.conf; file entries: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + hosts deny = ALL + hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy + bind interfaces only = Yes +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +In the above, no allowance has been made for any session requests that +will automatically translate to the loopback adaptor address 127.0.0.1. +To solve this problem change these lines to: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + hosts deny = ALL + hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy 127. +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Do NOT use the <command>bind interfaces only</command> parameter where you +may wish to +use the samba password change facility, or where &smbclient; may need to +access a local service for name resolution or for local resource +connections. (Note: the <command>bind interfaces only</command> parameter deficiency +where it will not allow connections to the loopback address will be +fixed soon). +</para> + +<para> +Another common cause of these two errors is having something already running +on port 139, such as Samba (ie: smbd is running from <application>inetd</application> already) or +something like Digital's Pathworks. Check your <filename>inetd.conf</filename> file before trying +to start &smbd; as a daemon, it can avoid a lot of frustration! +</para> + +<para> +And yet another possible cause for failure of this test is when the subnet mask +and / or broadcast address settings are incorrect. Please check that the +network interface IP Address / Broadcast Address / Subnet Mask settings are +correct and that Samba has correctly noted these in the <filename>log.nmb</filename> file. +</para> + +</step> + +<step performance="required"> + +<para> +Run the command <userinput>nmblookup -B BIGSERVER __SAMBA__</userinput>. You should get the +IP address of your Samba server back. +</para> + +<para> +If you don't then nmbd is incorrectly installed. Check your <filename>inetd.conf</filename> +if you run it from there, or that the daemon is running and listening +to udp port 137. +</para> + +<para> +One common problem is that many inetd implementations can't take many +parameters on the command line. If this is the case then create a +one-line script that contains the right parameters and run that from +inetd. +</para> + +</step> + +<step performance="required"> + +<para>run the command <userinput>nmblookup -B ACLIENT '*'</userinput></para> + +<para> +You should get the PCs IP address back. If you don't then the client +software on the PC isn't installed correctly, or isn't started, or you +got the name of the PC wrong. +</para> + +<para> +If ACLIENT doesn't resolve via DNS then use the IP address of the +client in the above test. +</para> + +</step> + +<step performance="required"> + +<para> +Run the command <userinput>nmblookup -d 2 '*'</userinput> +</para> + +<para> +This time we are trying the same as the previous test but are trying +it via a broadcast to the default broadcast address. A number of +Netbios/TCPIP hosts on the network should respond, although Samba may +not catch all of the responses in the short time it listens. You +should see "got a positive name query response" messages from several +hosts. +</para> + +<para> +If this doesn't give a similar result to the previous test then +nmblookup isn't correctly getting your broadcast address through its +automatic mechanism. In this case you should experiment with the +<command>interfaces</command> option in &smb.conf; to manually configure your IP +address, broadcast and netmask. +</para> + +<para> +If your PC and server aren't on the same subnet then you will need to +use the <parameter>-B</parameter> option to set the broadcast address to that of the PCs +subnet. +</para> + +<para> +This test will probably fail if your subnet mask and broadcast address are +not correct. (Refer to TEST 3 notes above). +</para> + +</step> + +<step performance="required"> + +<para> +Run the command <userinput>smbclient //BIGSERVER/TMP</userinput>. You should +then be prompted for a password. You should use the password of the account +you are logged into the unix box with. If you want to test with +another account then add the <parameter>-U <replaceable>accountname</replaceable></parameter> option to the end of +the command line. eg: +<userinput>smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe</userinput> +</para> + +<note><para> +It is possible to specify the password along with the username +as follows: +<userinput>smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe%secret</userinput> +</para></note> + +<para> +Once you enter the password you should get the <prompt>smb></prompt> prompt. If you +don't then look at the error message. If it says "invalid network +name" then the service "tmp" is not correctly setup in your &smb.conf;. +</para> + +<para> +If it says "bad password" then the likely causes are: +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem> + <para> + you have shadow passords (or some other password system) but didn't + compile in support for them in &smbd; + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + your <command>valid users</command> configuration is incorrect + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + you have a mixed case password and you haven't enabled the <command>password + level</command> option at a high enough level + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + the <command>path =</command> line in &smb.conf; is incorrect. Check it with &testparm; + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + you enabled password encryption but didn't create the SMB encrypted + password file + </para> +</listitem> +</orderedlist> + +<para> +Once connected you should be able to use the commands +<command>dir</command> <command>get</command> <command>put</command> etc. +Type <command>help <replaceable>command</replaceable></command> for instructions. You should +especially check that the amount of free disk space shown is correct +when you type <command>dir</command>. +</para> + +</step> + +<step performance="required"> + +<para> +On the PC, type the command <userinput>net view \\BIGSERVER</userinput>. You will +need to do this from within a "dos prompt" window. You should get back a +list of available shares on the server. +</para> + +<para> +If you get a "network name not found" or similar error then netbios +name resolution is not working. This is usually caused by a problem in +nmbd. To overcome it you could do one of the following (you only need +to choose one of them): +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem><para> + fixup the &nmbd; installation +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> + add the IP address of BIGSERVER to the <command>wins server</command> box in the + advanced tcp/ip setup on the PC. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> + enable windows name resolution via DNS in the advanced section of + the tcp/ip setup +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> + add BIGSERVER to your lmhosts file on the PC. +</para></listitem> +</orderedlist> + +<para> +If you get a "invalid network name" or "bad password error" then the +same fixes apply as they did for the <userinput>smbclient -L</userinput> test above. In +particular, make sure your <command>hosts allow</command> line is correct (see the man +pages) +</para> + +<para> +Also, do not overlook that fact that when the workstation requests the +connection to the samba server it will attempt to connect using the +name with which you logged onto your Windows machine. You need to make +sure that an account exists on your Samba server with that exact same +name and password. +</para> + +<para> +If you get "specified computer is not receiving requests" or similar +it probably means that the host is not contactable via tcp services. +Check to see if the host is running tcp wrappers, and if so add an entry in +the <filename>hosts.allow</filename> file for your client (or subnet, etc.) +</para> + +</step> + +<step performance="required"> + +<para> +Run the command <userinput>net use x: \\BIGSERVER\TMP</userinput>. You should +be prompted for a password then you should get a "command completed +successfully" message. If not then your PC software is incorrectly +installed or your smb.conf is incorrect. make sure your <command>hosts allow</command> +and other config lines in &smb.conf; are correct. +</para> + +<para> +It's also possible that the server can't work out what user name to +connect you as. To see if this is the problem add the line <command>user = +<replaceable>username</replaceable></command> to the <command>[tmp]</command> section of +&smb.conf; where <replaceable>username</replaceable> is the +username corresponding to the password you typed. If you find this +fixes things you may need the username mapping option. +</para> + +<para> +It might also be the case that your client only sends encrypted passwords +and you have <command>encrypt passwords = no</command> in &smb.conf; +Turn it back on to fix. +</para> + +</step> + +<step performance="required"> + +<para> +Run the command <userinput>nmblookup -M <replaceable>testgroup</replaceable></userinput> where +<replaceable>testgroup</replaceable> is the name of the workgroup that your Samba server and +Windows PCs belong to. You should get back the IP address of the +master browser for that workgroup. +</para> + +<para> +If you don't then the election process has failed. Wait a minute to +see if it is just being slow then try again. If it still fails after +that then look at the browsing options you have set in &smb.conf;. Make +sure you have <command>preferred master = yes</command> to ensure that +an election is held at startup. +</para> + +</step> + +<step performance="required"> + +<para> +>From file manager try to browse the server. Your samba server should +appear in the browse list of your local workgroup (or the one you +specified in smb.conf). You should be able to double click on the name +of the server and get a list of shares. If you get a "invalid +password" error when you do then you are probably running WinNT and it +is refusing to browse a server that has no encrypted password +capability and is in user level security mode. In this case either set +<command>security = server</command> AND +<command>password server = Windows_NT_Machine</command> in your +&smb.conf; file, or make sure <command>encrypted passwords</command> is +set to "yes". +</para> + +</step> +</procedure> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Still having troubles?</title> + +<para>Read the chapter on +<link linkend="problems">Analysing and Solving Problems</link>. +</para> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/GROUP-MAPPING-HOWTO.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/GROUP-MAPPING-HOWTO.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..af6ddff9bf9 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/GROUP-MAPPING-HOWTO.xml @@ -0,0 +1,104 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso8859-1"?> +<chapter id="groupmapping"> +<chapterinfo> + <author> + <firstname>Jean François</firstname><surname>Micouleau</surname> + </author> + &author.jerry; +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Configuring Group Mapping</title> + +<para> +Starting with Samba 3.0 alpha 2, new group mapping functionality +is available to create associations between Windows SIDs and UNIX +groups. The <parameter>groupmap</parameter> subcommand included with +the <command>net</command> tool can be used to manage these associations. +</para> + +<para> +The first immediate reason to use the group mapping on a Samba PDC, is that +the <parameter>domain admin group</parameter> &smb.conf; has been removed. +This parameter was used to give the listed users membership in the "Domain Admins" +Windows group which gave local admin rights on their workstations (in +default configurations). +</para> + +<para> +When installing NT/W2K on a computer, the installer program creates some users +and groups. Notably the 'Administrators' group, and gives to that group some +privileges like the ability to change the date and time or to kill any process +(or close too) running on the local machine. The 'Administrator' user is a +member of the 'Administrators' group, and thus 'inherit' the 'Administrators' +group privileges. If a 'joe' user is created and become a member of the +'Administrator' group, 'joe' has exactly the same rights as 'Administrator'. +</para> + +<para> +When a NT/W2K machine is joined to a domain, the "Domain Adminis" group of the +PDC is added to the local 'Administrators' group of the workstation. Every +member of the 'Domain Administrators' group 'inherit' the +rights of the local 'Administrators' group when logging on the workstation. +</para> + +<para> +The following steps describe how to make samba PDC users members of the +'Domain Admins' group? +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem><para>create a unix group (usually in <filename>/etc/group</filename>), + let's call it domadm</para></listitem> +<listitem><para>add to this group the users that must be Administrators. For example + if you want joe,john and mary, your entry in <filename>/etc/group</filename> will + look like:</para> + + <para><programlisting> + domadm:x:502:joe,john,mary + </programlisting></para> + + </listitem> + +<listitem><para>Map this domadm group to the "Domain Admins" group + by running the command:</para> + + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>net groupmap add ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=domadm</userinput></para> + + <para>The quotes around "Domain Admins" are necessary due to the space in the group name. Also make + sure to leave no whitespace surrounding the equal character (=).</para> + </listitem> + +</orderedlist> + +<para>Now joe, john and mary are domain administrators!</para> + +<para> +It is possible to map any arbitrary UNIX group to any Windows NT +group as well as making any UNIX group a Windows domain group. +For example, if you wanted to include a UNIX group (e.g. acct) in a ACL on a +local file or printer on a domain member machine, you would flag +that group as a domain group by running the following on the Samba PDC: +</para> + +<para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>net groupmap add rid=1000 ntgroup="Accounting" unixgroup=acct</userinput></para> + +<para>Be aware that the rid parmeter is a unsigned 32 bit integer that should +normally start at 1000. However, this rid must not overlap with any RID assigned +to a user. Verifying this is done differently depending on on the passdb backend +you are using. Future versions of the tools may perform the verification automatically, +but for now the burden in on you.</para> + +<para>You can list the various groups in the mapping database by executing +<command>net groupmap list</command>. Here is an example:</para> + +<para><programlisting><prompt>root# </prompt>net groupmap list +System Administrators (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-1002) -> sysadmin +Domain Admins (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-512) -> domadmin +Domain Users (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-513) -> domuser +Domain Guests (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-514) -> domguest +</programlisting></para> + +<para>For complete details on <command>net groupmap</command>, refer to the +net(8) man page.</para> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Integrating-with-Windows.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Integrating-with-Windows.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..9f0de0a56a0 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Integrating-with-Windows.xml @@ -0,0 +1,545 @@ +<chapter id="integrate-ms-networks"> + +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + <pubdate> (Jan 01 2001) </pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</title> + +<para> +This section deals with NetBIOS over TCP/IP name to IP address resolution. If +your MS Windows clients are NOT configured to use NetBIOS over TCP/IP then this +section does not apply to your installation. If your installation involves use of +NetBIOS over TCP/IP then this section may help you to resolve networking problems. +</para> + +<note> +<para> + NetBIOS over TCP/IP has nothing to do with NetBEUI. NetBEUI is NetBIOS + over Logical Link Control (LLC). On modern networks it is highly advised + to NOT run NetBEUI at all. Note also that there is NO such thing as + NetBEUI over TCP/IP - the existence of such a protocol is a complete + and utter mis-apprehension. +</para> +</note> + +<para> +Since the introduction of MS Windows 2000 it is possible to run MS Windows networking +without the use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP. NetBIOS over TCP/IP uses UDP port 137 for NetBIOS +name resolution and uses TCP port 139 for NetBIOS session services. When NetBIOS over +TCP/IP is disabled on MS Windows 2000 and later clients then only TCP port 445 will be +used and UDP port 137 and TCP port 139 will not. +</para> + +<note> +<para> +When using Windows 2000 or later clients, if NetBIOS over TCP/IP is NOT disabled, then +the client will use UDP port 137 (NetBIOS Name Service, also known as the Windows Internet +Name Service or WINS), TCP port 139 AND TCP port 445 (for actual file and print traffic). +</para> +</note> + +<para> +When NetBIOS over TCP/IP is disabled the use of DNS is essential. Most installations that +disable NetBIOS over TCP/IP today use MS Active Directory Service (ADS). ADS requires +Dynamic DNS with Service Resource Records (SRV RR) and with Incremental Zone Transfers (IXFR). +Use of DHCP with ADS is recommended as a further means of maintaining central control +over client workstation network configuration. +</para> + + +<sect1> +<title>Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</title> + +<para> +The key configuration files covered in this section are: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para><filename>/etc/hosts</filename></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><filename>/etc/resolv.conf</filename></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><filename>/etc/host.conf</filename></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename></para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<sect2> +<title><filename>/etc/hosts</filename></title> + +<para> +Contains a static list of IP Addresses and names. +eg: +</para> +<para><programlisting> + 127.0.0.1 localhost localhost.localdomain + 192.168.1.1 bigbox.caldera.com bigbox alias4box +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The purpose of <filename>/etc/hosts</filename> is to provide a +name resolution mechanism so that uses do not need to remember +IP addresses. +</para> + + +<para> +Network packets that are sent over the physical network transport +layer communicate not via IP addresses but rather using the Media +Access Control address, or MAC address. IP Addresses are currently +32 bits in length and are typically presented as four (4) decimal +numbers that are separated by a dot (or period). eg: 168.192.1.1 +</para> + +<para> +MAC Addresses use 48 bits (or 6 bytes) and are typically represented +as two digit hexadecimal numbers separated by colons. eg: +40:8e:0a:12:34:56 +</para> + +<para> +Every network interfrace must have an MAC address. Associated with +a MAC address there may be one or more IP addresses. There is NO +relationship between an IP address and a MAC address, all such assignments +are arbitary or discretionary in nature. At the most basic level all +network communications takes place using MAC addressing. Since MAC +addresses must be globally unique, and generally remains fixed for +any particular interface, the assignment of an IP address makes sense +from a network management perspective. More than one IP address can +be assigned per MAC address. One address must be the primary IP address, +this is the address that will be returned in the ARP reply. +</para> + +<para> +When a user or a process wants to communicate with another machine +the protocol implementation ensures that the "machine name" or "host +name" is resolved to an IP address in a manner that is controlled +by the TCP/IP configuration control files. The file +<filename>/etc/hosts</filename> is one such file. +</para> + +<para> +When the IP address of the destination interface has been +determined a protocol called ARP/RARP is used to identify +the MAC address of the target interface. ARP stands for Address +Resolution Protocol, and is a broadcast oriented method that +uses UDP (User Datagram Protocol) to send a request to all +interfaces on the local network segment using the all 1's MAC +address. Network interfaces are programmed to respond to two +MAC addresses only; their own unique address and the address +ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff. The reply packet from an ARP request will +contain the MAC address and the primary IP address for each +interface. +</para> + +<para> +The <filename>/etc/hosts</filename> file is foundational to all +Unix/Linux TCP/IP installations and as a minumum will contain +the localhost and local network interface IP addresses and the +primary names by which they are known within the local machine. +This file helps to prime the pump so that a basic level of name +resolution can exist before any other method of name resolution +becomes available. +</para> + +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title><filename>/etc/resolv.conf</filename></title> + +<para> +This file tells the name resolution libraries: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>The name of the domain to which the machine + belongs + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>The name(s) of any domains that should be + automatically searched when trying to resolve unqualified + host names to their IP address + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>The name or IP address of available Domain + Name Servers that may be asked to perform name to address + translation lookups + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title><filename>/etc/host.conf</filename></title> + + +<para> +<filename>/etc/host.conf</filename> is the primary means by +which the setting in /etc/resolv.conf may be affected. It is a +critical configuration file. This file controls the order by +which name resolution may procede. The typical structure is: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + order hosts,bind + multi on +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +then both addresses should be returned. Please refer to the +man page for host.conf for further details. +</para> + + +</sect2> + + + +<sect2> +<title><filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename></title> + +<para> +This file controls the actual name resolution targets. The +file typically has resolver object specifications as follows: +</para> + + +<para><programlisting> + # /etc/nsswitch.conf + # + # Name Service Switch configuration file. + # + + passwd: compat + # Alternative entries for password authentication are: + # passwd: compat files nis ldap winbind + shadow: compat + group: compat + + hosts: files nis dns + # Alternative entries for host name resolution are: + # hosts: files dns nis nis+ hesoid db compat ldap wins + networks: nis files dns + + ethers: nis files + protocols: nis files + rpc: nis files + services: nis files +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Of course, each of these mechanisms requires that the appropriate +facilities and/or services are correctly configured. +</para> + +<para> +It should be noted that unless a network request/message must be +sent, TCP/IP networks are silent. All TCP/IP communications assumes a +principal of speaking only when necessary. +</para> + +<para> +Starting with version 2.2.0 samba has Linux support for extensions to +the name service switch infrastructure so that linux clients will +be able to obtain resolution of MS Windows NetBIOS names to IP +Addresses. To gain this functionality Samba needs to be compiled +with appropriate arguments to the make command (ie: <command>make +nsswitch/libnss_wins.so</command>). The resulting library should +then be installed in the <filename>/lib</filename> directory and +the "wins" parameter needs to be added to the "hosts:" line in +the <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> file. At this point it +will be possible to ping any MS Windows machine by it's NetBIOS +machine name, so long as that machine is within the workgroup to +which both the samba machine and the MS Windows machine belong. +</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</title> + +<para> +MS Windows networking is predicated about the name each machine +is given. This name is known variously (and inconsistently) as +the "computer name", "machine name", "networking name", "netbios name", +"SMB name". All terms mean the same thing with the exception of +"netbios name" which can apply also to the name of the workgroup or the +domain name. The terms "workgroup" and "domain" are really just a +simply name with which the machine is associated. All NetBIOS names +are exactly 16 characters in length. The 16th character is reserved. +It is used to store a one byte value that indicates service level +information for the NetBIOS name that is registered. A NetBIOS machine +name is therefore registered for each service type that is provided by +the client/server. +</para> + +<para> +The following are typical NetBIOS name/service type registrations: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + Unique NetBIOS Names: + MACHINENAME<00> = Server Service is running on MACHINENAME + MACHINENAME<03> = Generic Machine Name (NetBIOS name) + MACHINENAME<20> = LanMan Server service is running on MACHINENAME + WORKGROUP<1b> = Domain Master Browser + + Group Names: + WORKGROUP<03> = Generic Name registered by all members of WORKGROUP + WORKGROUP<1c> = Domain Controllers / Netlogon Servers + WORKGROUP<1d> = Local Master Browsers + WORKGROUP<1e> = Internet Name Resolvers +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +It should be noted that all NetBIOS machines register their own +names as per the above. This is in vast contrast to TCP/IP +installations where traditionally the system administrator will +determine in the /etc/hosts or in the DNS database what names +are associated with each IP address. +</para> + +<para> +One further point of clarification should be noted, the <filename>/etc/hosts</filename> +file and the DNS records do not provide the NetBIOS name type information +that MS Windows clients depend on to locate the type of service that may +be needed. An example of this is what happens when an MS Windows client +wants to locate a domain logon server. It finds this service and the IP +address of a server that provides it by performing a lookup (via a +NetBIOS broadcast) for enumeration of all machines that have +registered the name type *<1c>. A logon request is then sent to each +IP address that is returned in the enumerated list of IP addresses. Which +ever machine first replies then ends up providing the logon services. +</para> + +<para> +The name "workgroup" or "domain" really can be confusing since these +have the added significance of indicating what is the security +architecture of the MS Windows network. The term "workgroup" indicates +that the primary nature of the network environment is that of a +peer-to-peer design. In a WORKGROUP all machines are responsible for +their own security, and generally such security is limited to use of +just a password (known as SHARE MODE security). In most situations +with peer-to-peer networking the users who control their own machines +will simply opt to have no security at all. It is possible to have +USER MODE security in a WORKGROUP environment, thus requiring use +of a user name and a matching password. +</para> + +<para> +MS Windows networking is thus predetermined to use machine names +for all local and remote machine message passing. The protocol used is +called Server Message Block (SMB) and this is implemented using +the NetBIOS protocol (Network Basic Input Output System). NetBIOS can +be encapsulated using LLC (Logical Link Control) protocol - in which case +the resulting protocol is called NetBEUI (Network Basic Extended User +Interface). NetBIOS can also be run over IPX (Internetworking Packet +Exchange) protocol as used by Novell NetWare, and it can be run +over TCP/IP protocols - in which case the resulting protocol is called +NBT or NetBT, the NetBIOS over TCP/IP. +</para> + +<para> +MS Windows machines use a complex array of name resolution mechanisms. +Since we are primarily concerned with TCP/IP this demonstration is +limited to this area. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>The NetBIOS Name Cache</title> + +<para> +All MS Windows machines employ an in memory buffer in which is +stored the NetBIOS names and IP addresses for all external +machines that that machine has communicated with over the +past 10-15 minutes. It is more efficient to obtain an IP address +for a machine from the local cache than it is to go through all the +configured name resolution mechanisms. +</para> + +<para> +If a machine whose name is in the local name cache has been shut +down before the name had been expired and flushed from the cache, then +an attempt to exchange a message with that machine will be subject +to time-out delays. i.e.: Its name is in the cache, so a name resolution +lookup will succeed, but the machine can not respond. This can be +frustrating for users - but it is a characteristic of the protocol. +</para> + +<para> +The MS Windows utility that allows examination of the NetBIOS +name cache is called "nbtstat". The Samba equivalent of this +is called "nmblookup". +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>The LMHOSTS file</title> + +<para> +This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or +2000 in <filename>C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</filename> and contains +the IP Address and the machine name in matched pairs. The +<filename>LMHOSTS</filename> file performs NetBIOS name +to IP address mapping. +</para> + +<para> +It typically looks like: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + # Copyright (c) 1998 Microsoft Corp. + # + # This is a sample LMHOSTS file used by the Microsoft Wins Client (NetBIOS + # over TCP/IP) stack for Windows98 + # + # This file contains the mappings of IP addresses to NT computernames + # (NetBIOS) names. Each entry should be kept on an individual line. + # The IP address should be placed in the first column followed by the + # corresponding computername. The address and the comptername + # should be separated by at least one space or tab. The "#" character + # is generally used to denote the start of a comment (see the exceptions + # below). + # + # This file is compatible with Microsoft LAN Manager 2.x TCP/IP lmhosts + # files and offers the following extensions: + # + # #PRE + # #DOM:<domain> + # #INCLUDE <filename> + # #BEGIN_ALTERNATE + # #END_ALTERNATE + # \0xnn (non-printing character support) + # + # Following any entry in the file with the characters "#PRE" will cause + # the entry to be preloaded into the name cache. By default, entries are + # not preloaded, but are parsed only after dynamic name resolution fails. + # + # Following an entry with the "#DOM:<domain>" tag will associate the + # entry with the domain specified by <domain>. This affects how the + # browser and logon services behave in TCP/IP environments. To preload + # the host name associated with #DOM entry, it is necessary to also add a + # #PRE to the line. The <domain> is always preloaded although it will not + # be shown when the name cache is viewed. + # + # Specifying "#INCLUDE <filename>" will force the RFC NetBIOS (NBT) + # software to seek the specified <filename> and parse it as if it were + # local. <filename> is generally a UNC-based name, allowing a + # centralized lmhosts file to be maintained on a server. + # It is ALWAYS necessary to provide a mapping for the IP address of the + # server prior to the #INCLUDE. This mapping must use the #PRE directive. + # In addtion the share "public" in the example below must be in the + # LanManServer list of "NullSessionShares" in order for client machines to + # be able to read the lmhosts file successfully. This key is under + # \machine\system\currentcontrolset\services\lanmanserver\parameters\nullsessionshares + # in the registry. Simply add "public" to the list found there. + # + # The #BEGIN_ and #END_ALTERNATE keywords allow multiple #INCLUDE + # statements to be grouped together. Any single successful include + # will cause the group to succeed. + # + # Finally, non-printing characters can be embedded in mappings by + # first surrounding the NetBIOS name in quotations, then using the + # \0xnn notation to specify a hex value for a non-printing character. + # + # The following example illustrates all of these extensions: + # + # 102.54.94.97 rhino #PRE #DOM:networking #net group's DC + # 102.54.94.102 "appname \0x14" #special app server + # 102.54.94.123 popular #PRE #source server + # 102.54.94.117 localsrv #PRE #needed for the include + # + # #BEGIN_ALTERNATE + # #INCLUDE \\localsrv\public\lmhosts + # #INCLUDE \\rhino\public\lmhosts + # #END_ALTERNATE + # + # In the above example, the "appname" server contains a special + # character in its name, the "popular" and "localsrv" server names are + # preloaded, and the "rhino" server name is specified so it can be used + # to later #INCLUDE a centrally maintained lmhosts file if the "localsrv" + # system is unavailable. + # + # Note that the whole file is parsed including comments on each lookup, + # so keeping the number of comments to a minimum will improve performance. + # Therefore it is not advisable to simply add lmhosts file entries onto the + # end of this file. +</programlisting></para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>HOSTS file</title> + +<para> +This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or 2000 in +<filename>C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</filename> and contains +the IP Address and the IP hostname in matched pairs. It can be +used by the name resolution infrastructure in MS Windows, depending +on how the TCP/IP environment is configured. This file is in +every way the equivalent of the Unix/Linux <filename>/etc/hosts</filename> file. +</para> +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title>DNS Lookup</title> + +<para> +This capability is configured in the TCP/IP setup area in the network +configuration facility. If enabled an elaborate name resolution sequence +is followed the precise nature of which is dependant on what the NetBIOS +Node Type parameter is configured to. A Node Type of 0 means use +NetBIOS broadcast (over UDP broadcast) is first used if the name +that is the subject of a name lookup is not found in the NetBIOS name +cache. If that fails then DNS, HOSTS and LMHOSTS are checked. If set to +Node Type 8, then a NetBIOS Unicast (over UDP Unicast) is sent to the +WINS Server to obtain a lookup before DNS, HOSTS, LMHOSTS, or broadcast +lookup is used. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>WINS Lookup</title> + +<para> +A WINS (Windows Internet Name Server) service is the equivaent of the +rfc1001/1002 specified NBNS (NetBIOS Name Server). A WINS server stores +the names and IP addresses that are registered by a Windows client +if the TCP/IP setup has been given at least one WINS Server IP Address. +</para> + +<para> +To configure Samba to be a WINS server the following parameter needs +to be added to the &smb.conf; file: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + wins support = Yes +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +To configure Samba to use a WINS server the following parameters are +needed in the &smb.conf; file: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + wins support = No + wins server = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +where <replaceable>xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</replaceable> is the IP address +of the WINS server. +</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/InterdomainTrusts.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/InterdomainTrusts.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..2c492d4ac06 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/InterdomainTrusts.xml @@ -0,0 +1,222 @@ +<chapter id="InterdomainTrusts"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + &author.mimir; + <pubdate>April 3, 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Interdomain Trust Relationships</title> + +<para> +Samba-3 supports NT4 style domain trust relationships. This is feature that many sites +will want to use if they migrate to Samba-3 from and NT4 style domain and do NOT want to +adopt Active Directory or an LDAP based authentication back end. This section explains +some background information regarding trust relationships and how to create them. It is now +possible for Samba-3 to NT4 trust (and vice versa), as well as Samba3 to Samba3 trusts. +</para> + +<sect1> +<title>Trust Relationship Background</title> + +<para> +MS Windows NT3.x/4.0 type security domains employ a non-hierarchical security structure. +The limitations of this architecture as it affects the scalability of MS Windows networking +in large organisations is well known. Additionally, the flat-name space that results from +this design significantly impacts the delegation of administrative responsibilities in +large and diverse organisations. +</para> + +<para> +Microsoft developed Active Directory Service (ADS), based on Kerberos and LDAP, as a means +of circumventing the limitations of the older technologies. Not every organisation is ready +or willing to embrace ADS. For small companies the older NT4 style domain security paradigm +is quite adequate, there thus remains an entrenched user base for whom there is no direct +desire to go through a disruptive change to adopt ADS. +</para> + +<para> +Microsoft introduced with MS Windows NT the ability to allow differing security domains +to affect a mechanism so that users from one domain may be given access rights and privileges +in another domain. The language that describes this capability is couched in terms of +<emphasis>Trusts</emphasis>. Specifically, one domain will <emphasis>trust</emphasis> the users +from another domain. The domain from which users are available to another security domain is +said to be a trusted domain. The domain in which those users have assigned rights and privileges +is the trusting domain. With NT3.x/4.0 all trust relationships are always in one direction only, +thus if users in both domains are to have privileges and rights in each others' domain, then it is +necessary to establish two (2) relationships, one in each direction. +</para> + +<para> +In an NT4 style MS security domain, all trusts are non-transitive. This means that if there +are three (3) domains (let's call them RED, WHITE, and BLUE) where RED and WHITE have a trust +relationship, and WHITE and BLUE have a trust relationship, then it holds that there is no +implied trust between the RED and BLUE domains. ie: Relationships are explicit and not +transitive. +</para> + +<para> +New to MS Windows 2000 ADS security contexts is the fact that trust relationships are two-way +by default. Also, all inter-ADS domain trusts are transitive. In the case of the RED, WHITE and BLUE +domains above, with Windows 2000 and ADS the RED and BLUE domains CAN trust each other. This is +an inherent feature of ADS domains. Samba-3 implements MS Windows NT4 +style Interdomain trusts and interoperates with MS Windows 200x ADS +security domains in similar manner to MS Windows NT4 style domains. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</title> + +<para> +There are two steps to creating an interdomain trust relationship. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>NT4 as the Trusting Domain (ie. creating the trusted account)</title> + +<para> +For MS Windows NT4, all domain trust relationships are configured using the Domain User Manager. +To affect a two way trust relationship it is necessary for each domain administrator to make +available (for use by an external domain) it's security resources. This is done from the Domain +User Manager Policies entry on the menu bar. From the Policy menu, select Trust Relationships, then +next to the lower box that is labelled "Permitted to Trust this Domain" are two buttons, "Add" and +"Remove". The "Add" button will open a panel in which needs to be entered the remote domain that +will be able to assign user rights to your domain. In addition it is necessary to enter a password +that is specific to this trust relationship. The password needs to be +typed twice (for standard confirmation). +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>NT4 as the Trusted Domain (ie. creating trusted account's password)</title> + +<para> +A trust relationship will work only when the other (trusting) domain makes the appropriate connections +with the trusted domain. To consumate the trust relationship the administrator will launch the +Domain User Manager, from the menu select Policies, then select Trust Relationships, then click on the +"Add" button that is next to the box that is labelled "Trusted Domains". A panel will open in +which must be entered the name of the remote domain as well as the password assigned to that trust. +</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</title> + +<para> +This description is meant to be a fairly short introduction about how to set up a Samba server so +that it could participate in interdomain trust relationships. Trust relationship support in Samba +is in its early stage, so lot of things don't work yet. +</para> + +<para> +Each of the procedures described below is treated as they were performed with Windows NT4 Server on +one end. The remote end could just as well be another Samba-3 domain. It can be clearly seen, after +reading this document, that combining Samba-specific parts of what's written below leads to trust +between domains in purely Samba environment. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Samba-3 as the Trusting Domain</title> + +<para> +In order to set the Samba PDC to be the trusted party of the relationship first you need +to create special account for the domain that will be the trusting party. To do that, +you can use the 'smbpasswd' utility. Creating the trusted domain account is very +similiar to creating a trusted machine account. Suppose, your domain is +called SAMBA, and the remote domain is called RUMBA. The first step +will be to issue this command from your favourite shell: +</para> + +<para> +<screen> +<prompt>deity#</prompt> <userinput>smbpasswd -a -i rumba</userinput> + New SMB password: XXXXXXXX + Retype SMB password: XXXXXXXX + Added user rumba$ +</screen> + +where <parameter>-a</parameter> means to add a new account into the +passdb database and <parameter>-i</parameter> means: ''create this +account with the InterDomain trust flag'' +</para> + +<para> +The account name will be 'rumba$' (the name of the remote domain) +</para> + +<para> +After issuing this command you'll be asked to enter the password for +the account. You can use any password you want, but be aware that Windows NT will +not change this password until 7 days following account creation. +After the command returns successfully, you can look at the entry for the new account +(in the stardard way depending on your configuration) and see that account's name is +really RUMBA$ and it has 'I' flag in the flags field. Now you're ready to confirm +the trust by establishing it from Windows NT Server. +</para> + +<para> +Open 'User Manager for Domains' and from menu 'Policies' select 'Trust Relationships...'. +Right beside 'Trusted domains' list box press 'Add...' button. You will be prompted for +the trusted domain name and the relationship password. Type in SAMBA, as this is +your domain name, and the password used at the time of account creation. +Press OK and, if everything went without incident, you will see 'Trusted domain relationship +successfully established' message. +</para> + +</sect2> +<sect2> +<title>Samba-3 as the Trusted Domain</title> + +<para> +This time activities are somewhat reversed. Again, we'll assume that your domain +controlled by the Samba PDC is called SAMBA and NT-controlled domain is called RUMBA. +</para> + +<para> +The very first thing requirement is to add an account for the SAMBA domain on RUMBA's PDC. +</para> + +<para> +Launch the Domain User Manager, then from the menu select 'Policies', 'Trust Relationships'. +Now, next to 'Trusted Domains' box press the 'Add' button, and type in the name of the trusted +domain (SAMBA) and password securing the relationship. +</para> + +<para> +The password can be arbitrarily chosen. It is easy to change the password +from the Samba server whenever you want. After confirming the password your account is +ready for use. Now it's Samba's turn. +</para> + +<para> +Using your favourite shell while being logged in as root, issue this command: +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>deity# </prompt><userinput>net rpc trustdom establish rumba</userinput> +</para> + +<para> +You will be prompted for the password you just typed on your Windows NT4 Server box. +Do not worry if you see an error message that mentions a returned code of +<errorname>NT_STATUS_NOLOGON_INTERDOMAIN_TRUST_ACCOUNT</errorname>. It means the +password you gave is correct and the NT4 Server says the account is +ready for interdomain connection and not for ordinary +connection. After that, be patient it can take a while (especially +in large networks), you should see the 'Success' message. Congratulations! Your trust +relationship has just been established. +</para> + +<note><para> +Note that you have to run this command as root because you must have write access to +the <filename>secrets.tdb</filename> file. +</para></note> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/IntroSMB.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/IntroSMB.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..4ead422fb84 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/IntroSMB.xml @@ -0,0 +1,370 @@ +<chapter id="IntroSMB"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.dlechnyr; + <pubdate>April 14, 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Introduction to Samba</title> + +<para><emphasis> +"If you understand what you're doing, you're not learning anything." +-- Anonymous +</emphasis></para> + +<para> +Samba is a file and print server for Windows-based clients using TCP/IP as the underlying +transport protocol. In fact, it can support any SMB/CIFS-enabled client. One of Samba's big +strengths is that you can use it to blend your mix of Windows and Linux machines together +without requiring a separate Windows NT/2000/2003 Server. Samba is actively being developed +by a global team of about 30 active programmers and was originally developed by Andrew Tridgell. +</para> + +<sect1> +<title>Background</title> + +<para> +Once long ago, there was a buzzword referred to as DCE/RPC. This stood for Distributed +Computing Environment/Remote Procedure Calls and conceptually was a good idea. It was +originally developed by Apollo/HP as NCA 1.0 (Network Computing Architecture) and only +ran over UDP. When there was a need to run it over TCP so that it would be compatible +with DECnet 3.0, it was redesigned, submitted to The Open Group, and officially became +known as DCE/RPC. Microsoft came along and decided, rather than pay $20 per seat to +license this technology, to reimplement DCE/RPC themselves as MSRPC. From this, the +concept continued in the form of SMB (Server Message Block, or the "what") using the +NetBIOS (Network Basic Input/Output System, or the "how") compatibility layer. You can +run SMB (i.e., transport) over several different protocols; many different implementations +arose as a result, including NBIPX (NetBIOS over IPX, NwLnkNb, or NWNBLink) and NBT +(NetBIOS over TCP/IP, or NetBT). As the years passed, NBT became the most common form +of implementation until the advance of "Direct-Hosted TCP" -- the Microsoft marketing +term for eliminating NetBIOS entirely and running SMB by itself across TCP port 445 +only. As of yet, direct-hosted TCP has yet to catch on. +</para> + +<para> +Perhaps the best summary of the origins of SMB are voiced in the 1997 article titled, CIFS: +Common Insecurities Fail Scrutiny: +</para> + +<para><emphasis> +Several megabytes of NT-security archives, random whitepapers, RFCs, the CIFS spec, the Samba +stuff, a few MS knowledge-base articles, strings extracted from binaries, and packet dumps have +been dutifully waded through during the information-gathering stages of this project, and there +are *still* many missing pieces... While often tedious, at least the way has been generously +littered with occurrences of clapping hand to forehead and muttering 'crikey, what are they +thinking? +</emphasis></para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Terminology</title> + +<itemizedlist> + + <listitem><para> + SMB: Acronym for "Server Message Block". This is Microsoft's file and printer sharing protocol. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + CIFS: Acronym for "Common Internet File System". Around 1996, Microsoft apparently + decided that SMB needed the word "Internet" in it, so they changed it to CIFS. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Direct-Hosted: A method of providing file/printer sharing services over port 445/tcp + only using DNS for name resolution instead of WINS. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + IPC: Acronym for "Inter-Process Communication". A method to communicate specific + information between programs. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Marshalling: - A method of serializing (i.e., sequential ordering of) variable data + suitable for transmission via a network connection or storing in a file. The source + data can be re-created using a similar process called unmarshalling. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + NetBIOS: Acronym for "Network Basic Input/Output System". This is not a protocol; + it is a method of communication across an existing protocol. This is a standard which + was originally developed for IBM by Sytek in 1983. To exaggerate the analogy a bit, + it can help to think of this in comparison your computer's BIOS -- it controls the + essential functions of your input/output hardware -- whereas NetBIOS controls the + essential functions of your input/output traffic via the network. Again, this is a bit + of an exaggeration but it should help that paradigm shift. What is important to realize + is that NetBIOS is a transport standard, not a protocol. Unfortunately, even technically + brilliant people tend to interchange NetBIOS with terms like NetBEUI without a second + thought; this will cause no end (and no doubt) of confusion. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + NetBEUI: Acronym for the "NetBIOS Extended User Interface". Unlike NetBIOS, NetBEUI + is a protocol, not a standard. It is also not routable, so traffic on one side of a + router will be unable to communicate with the other side. Understanding NetBEUI is + not essential to deciphering SMB; however it helps to point out that it is not the + same as NetBIOS and to improve your score in trivia at parties. NetBEUI was originally + referred to by Microsoft as "NBF", or "The Windows NT NetBEUI Frame protocol driver". + It is not often heard from these days. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + NBT: Acronym for "NetBIOS over TCP"; also known as "NetBT". Allows the continued use + of NetBIOS traffic proxied over TCP/IP. As a result, NetBIOS names are made + to IP addresses and NetBIOS name types are conceptually equivalent to TCP/IP ports. + This is how file and printer sharing are accomplished in Windows 95/98/ME. They + traditionally rely on three ports: NetBIOS Name Service (nbname) via UDP port 137, + NetBIOS Datagram Service (nbdatagram) via UDP port 138, and NetBIOS Session Service + (nbsession) via TCP port 139. All name resolution is done via WINS, NetBIOS broadcasts, + and DNS. NetBIOS over TCP is documented in RFC 1001 (Concepts and methods) and RFC 1002 + (Detailed specifications). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + W2K: Acronym for Windows 2000 Professional or Server + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + W3K: Acronym for Windows 2003 Server + </para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +<para>If you plan on getting help, make sure to subscribe to the Samba Mailing List (available at +http://www.samba.org). Optionally, you could just search mailing.unix.samba at http://groups.google.com +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Related Projects</title> + +<para> +There are currently two network filesystem client projects for Linux that are directly +related to Samba: SMBFS and CIFS VFS. These are both available in the Linux kernel itself. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + + <listitem><para> + SMBFS (Server Message Block File System) allows you to mount SMB shares (the protocol + that Microsoft Windows and OS/2 Lan Manager use to share files and printers + over local networks) and access them just like any other Unix directory. This is useful + if you just want to mount such filesystems without being a SMBFS server. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + CIFS VFS (Common Internet File System Virtual File System) is the successor to SMBFS, and + is being actively developed for the upcoming version of the Linux kernel. The intent of this module + is to provide advanced network file system functionality including support for dfs (heirarchical + name space), secure per-user session establishment, safe distributed caching (oplock), + optional packet signing, Unicode and other internationalization improvements, and optional + Winbind (nsswitch) integration. + </para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Again, it's important to note that these are implementations for client filesystems, and have +nothing to do with acting as a file and print server for SMB/CIFS clients. +</para> + +<para> +There are other Open Source CIFS client implementations, such as the jCIFS project +(jcifs.samba.org) which provides an SMB client toolkit written in Java. +</para> + + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>SMB Methodology</title> + +<para> +Traditionally, SMB uses UDP port 137 (NetBIOS name service, or netbios-ns), +UDP port 138 (NetBIOS datagram service, or netbios-dgm), and TCP port 139 (NetBIOS +session service, or netbios-ssn). Anyone looking at their network with a good +packet sniffer will be amazed at the amount of traffic generated by just opening +up a single file. In general, SMB sessions are established in the following order: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + "TCP Connection" - establish 3-way handshake (connection) to port 139/tcp + or 445/tcp. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + "NetBIOS Session Request" - using the following "Calling Names": The local + machine's NetBIOS name plus the 16th character 0x00; The server's NetBIOS + name plus the 16th character 0x20 + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + "SMB Negotiate Protocol" - determine the protocol dialect to use, which will + be one of the following: PC Network Program 1.0 (Core) - share level security + mode only; Microsoft Networks 1.03 (Core Plus) - share level security + mode only; Lanman1.0 (LAN Manager 1.0) - uses Challenge/Response + Authentication; Lanman2.1 (LAN Manager 2.1) - uses Challenge/Response + Authentication; NT LM 0.12 (NT LM 0.12) - uses Challenge/Response + Authentication + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + SMB Session Startup. Passwords are encrypted (or not) according to one of + the following methods: Null (no encryption); Cleartext (no encryption); LM + and NTLM; NTLM; NTLMv2 + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + SMB Tree Connect: Connect to a share name (e.g., \\servername\share); Connect + to a service type (e.g., IPC$ named pipe) + </para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +A good way to examine this process in depth is to try out SecurityFriday's SWB program +at http://www.securityfriday.com/ToolDownload/SWB/swb_doc.html. It allows you to +walk through the establishment of a SMB/CIFS session step by step. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Additional Resources</title> + +<itemizedlist> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/cifs.txt"> + <emphasis>CIFS: Common Insecurities Fail Scrutiny</emphasis> by "Hobbit"</ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://afr.com/it/2002/10/01/FFXDF43AP6D.html"> + <emphasis>Doing the Samba on Windows</emphasis> by Financial Review + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://ubiqx.org/cifs/"> + <emphasis>Implementing CIFS</emphasis> by Christopher R. Hertel + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://samba.anu.edu.au/cifs/docs/what-is-smb.html"> + <emphasis>Just What Is SMB?</emphasis> by Richard Sharpe + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://www.linux-mag.com/1999-05/samba_01.html"> + <emphasis>Opening Windows Everywhere</emphasis> by Mike Warfield + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://www.tldp.org/HOWTO/SMB-HOWTO.html"> + <emphasis>SMB HOWTO</emphasis> by David Wood + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://www.phrack.org/phrack/60/p60-0x0b.txt"> + <emphasis>SMB/CIFS by The Root</emphasis> by "ledin" + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://www.linux-mag.com/1999-09/samba_01.html"> + <emphasis>The Story of Samba</emphasis> by Christopher R. Hertel + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/samba/"> + <emphasis>The Unofficial Samba HOWTO</emphasis> by David Lechnyr + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://www.linux-mag.com/2001-05/smb_01.html"> + <emphasis>Understanding the Network Neighborhood</emphasis> by Christopher R. Hertel + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <ulink url="http://www.linux-mag.com/2002-02/samba_01.html"> + <emphasis>Using Samba as a PDC</emphasis> by Andrew Bartlett + </ulink> + </para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Epilogue</title> + +<para><emphasis> +"What's fundamentally wrong is that nobody ever had any taste when they +did it. Microsoft has been very much into making the user interface look good, +but internally it's just a complete mess. And even people who program for Microsoft +and who have had years of experience, just don't know how it works internally. +Worse, nobody dares change it. Nobody dares to fix bugs because it's such a +mess that fixing one bug might just break a hundred programs that depend on +that bug. And Microsoft isn't interested in anyone fixing bugs -- they're interested +in making money. They don't have anybody who takes pride in Windows 95 as an +operating system. +</emphasis></para> + +<para><emphasis> +People inside Microsoft know it's a bad operating system and they still +continue obviously working on it because they want to get the next version out +because they want to have all these new features to sell more copies of the +system. +</emphasis></para> + +<para><emphasis> +The problem with that is that over time, when you have this kind of approach, +and because nobody understands it, because nobody REALLY fixes bugs (other than +when they're really obvious), the end result is really messy. You can't trust +it because under certain circumstances it just spontaneously reboots or just +halts in the middle of something that shouldn't be strange. Normally it works +fine and then once in a blue moon for some completely unknown reason, it's dead, +and nobody knows why. Not Microsoft, not the experienced user and certainly +not the completely clueless user who probably sits there shivering thinking +"What did I do wrong?" when they didn't do anything wrong at all. +</emphasis></para> + +<para><emphasis> +That's what's really irritating to me." +</emphasis></para> + +<para>-- +<ulink url="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/boot.txt">Linus Torvalds, from an interview with BOOT Magazine, Sept 1998</ulink> +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Miscellaneous</title> + +<para> +This chapter was lovingly handcrafted on a Dell Latitude C400 laptop running Slackware Linux 9.0, +in case anyone asks. +</para> + +<para> +This chapter is Copyright © 2003 David Lechnyr (david at lechnyr dot com). +Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms +of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or any later version published by the Free +Software Foundation. A copy of the license is available at http://www.gnu.org/licenses/fdl.txt. +</para> + +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/NT4Migration.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/NT4Migration.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..585cfe6a476 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/NT4Migration.xml @@ -0,0 +1,507 @@ +<chapter id="NT4Migration"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + <pubdate>April 3, 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</title> + +<para> +This is a rough guide to assist those wishing to migrate from NT4 domain control to +Samba-3 based domain control. +</para> + +<sect1> +<title>Planning and Getting Started</title> + +<para> +In the IT world there is often a saying that all problems are encountered because of +poor planning. The corrollary to this saying is that not all problems can be anticpated +and planned for. Then again, good planning will anticpate most show stopper type situations. +</para> + +<para> +Those wishing to migrate from MS Windows NT4 domain control to a Samba-3 domain control +environment would do well to develop a detailed migration plan. So here are a few pointers to +help migration get under way. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Objectives</title> + +<para> +The key objective for most organisations will be to make the migration from MS Windows NT4 +to Samba-3 domain control as painless as possible. One of the challenges you may experience +in your migration process may well be one of convincing management that the new environment +should remain in place. Many who have introduced open source technologies have experienced +pressure to return to a Microsoft based platform solution at the first sign of trouble. +</para> + +<para> +It is strongly advised that before attempting a migration to a Samba-3 controlled network +that every possible effort be made to gain all-round commitment to the change. Firstly, you +should know precisely <emphasis>why</emphasis> the change is important for the organisation. +Possible motivations to make a change include: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> +<listitem> + <para>Improve network manageability</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Obtain better user level functionality</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Reduce network operating costs</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Reduce exposure caused by Microsoft withdrawal of NT4 support</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Avoid MS License 6 implications</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Reduce organisation's dependency on Microsoft</para> +</listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +It is vital that it be well recognised that Samba-3 is NOT MS Windows NT4. Samba-3 offers +an alternative solution that is both different from MS Windows NT4 and that offers some +advantages compared with it. It should also be recognised that Samba-3 lacks many of the +features that Microsoft has promoted as core values in migration from MS Windows NT4 to +MS Windows 2000 and beyond (with or without Active Directory services). +</para> + +<para> +What are the features that Samba-3 can NOT provide? +</para> + +<itemizedlist> +<listitem> + <para>Active Directory Server</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Group Policy Objects (in Active Direcrtory)</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Machine Policy objects</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Logon Scripts in Active Directorty</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Software Application and Access Controls in Active Directory</para> +</listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +The features that Samba-3 DOES provide and that may be of compelling interest to your site +includes: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> +<listitem> + <para>Lower Cost of Ownership</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Global availability of support with no strings attached</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Dynamic SMB Servers (ie:Can run more than one server per Unix/Linux system)</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Creation of on-the-fly logon scripts</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Creation of on-the-fly Policy Files</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Greater Stability, Reliability, Performance and Availability</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Manageability via an ssh connection</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Flexible choices of back-end authentication technologies (tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam)</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Ability to implement a full single-signon architecture</para> +</listitem> +<listitem> + <para>Ability to distribute authentication systems for absolute minimum wide area network bandwidth demand</para> +</listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Before migrating a network from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3 it is vital that all necessary factors are +considered. Users should be educated about changes they may experience so that the change will be a +welcome one and not become an obstacle to the work they need to do. The following are some of the +factors that will go into a successful migration: +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>Domain Layout</title> + +<para> +Samba-3 can be configured as a domain controller, a back-up domain controller (probably best called +a secondary controller), a domain member, or as a stand-alone server. The Windows network security +domain context should be sized and scoped before implementation. Particular attention needs to be +paid to the location of the primary domain controller (PDC) as well as backup controllers (BDCs). +It should be noted that one way in which Samba-3 differs from Microsoft technology is that if one +chooses to use an LDAP authentication backend then the same database can be used by several different +domains. This means that in a complex organisation there can be a single LDAP database, that itself +can be distributed, that can simultaneously serve multiple domains (that can also be widely distributed). +</para> + +<para> +It is recommended that from a design perspective, the number of users per server, as well as the number +of servers, per domain should be scaled according to needs and should also consider server capacity +and network bandwidth. +</para> + +<para> +A physical network segment may house several domains, each of which may span multiple network segments. +Where domains span routed network segments it is most advisable to consider and test the performance +implications of the design and layout of a network. A Centrally located domain controller that is being +designed to serve mulitple routed network segments may result in severe performance problems if the +response time (eg: ping timing) between the remote segment and the PDC is more than 100 ms. In situations +where the delay is too long it is highly recommended to locate a backup controller (BDC) to serve as +the local authentication and access control server. +</para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Server Share and Directory Layout</title> + +<para> +There are few cardinal rules to effective network design that can be broken with impunity. +The most important rule of effective network management is that simplicity is king in every +well controlled network. Every part of the infrastructure must be managed, the more complex +it is, the greater will be the demand of keeping systems secure and functional. +</para> + +<para> +The nature of the data that must be stored needs to be born in mind when deciding how many +shares must be created. The physical disk space layout should also be taken into account +when designing where share points will be created. Keep in mind that all data needs to be +backed up, thus the simpler the disk layout the easier it will be to keep track of what must +be backed up to tape or other off-line storage medium. Always plan and implement for minimum +maintenance. Leave nothing to chance in your design, above all, do not leave backups to chance: +Backup and test, validate every backup, create a disaster recovery plan and prove that it works. +</para> + +<para> +Users should be grouped according to data access control needs. File and directory access +is best controlled via group permissions and the use of the "sticky bit" on group controlled +directories may substantially avoid file access complaints from samba share users. +</para> + +<para> +Many network administrators who are new to the game will attempt to use elaborate techniques +to set access controls, on files, directories, shares, as well as in share definitions. +There is the ever present danger that that administrator's successor will not understand the +complex mess that has been inherited. Remember, apparent job security through complex design +and implementation may ultimately cause loss of operations and downtime to users as the new +administrator learns to untangle your web. Keep access controls simple and effective and +make sure that users will never be interrupted by the stupidity of complexity. +</para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Logon Scripts</title> + +<para> +Please refer to the section of this document on Advanced Network Adminsitration for information +regarding the network logon script options for Samba-3. Logon scripts can help to ensure that +all users gain share and printer connections they need. +</para> + +<para> +Logon scripts can be created on-the-fly so that all commands executed are specific to the +rights and privilidges granted to the user. The preferred controls should be affected through +group membership so that group information can be used to custom create a logong script using +the <filename>root preexec</filename> parameters to the <filename>NETLOGON</filename> share. +</para> + +<para> +Some sites prefer to use a tool such as <filename>kixstart</filename> to establish a controlled +user environment. In any case you may wish to do a google search for logon script process controls. +In particular, you may wish to explore the use of the Microsoft knowledgebase article KB189105 that +deals with how to add printers without user intervention via the logon script process. +</para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Profile Migration/Creation</title> + +<para> +User and Group Profiles may be migrated using the tools described in the section titled Desktop Profile +Management. +</para> + +<para> +Profiles may also be managed using the Samba-3 tool <filename>profiles</filename>. This tool allows +the MS Windows NT style security identifiers (SIDs) that are stored inside the profile NTuser.DAT file +to be changed to the SID of the Samba-3 domain. +</para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>User and Group Accounts</title> + +<para> +It is possible to migrate all account settings from an MS Windows NT4 domain to Samba-3. Before +attempting to migrate user and group accounts it is STRONGLY advised to create in Samba-3 the +groups that are present on the MS Windows NT4 domain <emphasis>AND</emphasis> to connect these to +suitable Unix/Linux groups. Following this simple advice will mean that all user and group attributes +should migrate painlessly. +</para> +</sect3> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Steps In Migration Process</title> + +<para> +The approximate migration process is described below. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> +<listitem><para> +You will have an NT4 PDC that has the users, groups, policies and profiles to be migrated +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> +Samba-3 set up as a DC with netlogon share, profile share, etc. +</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<procedure><title>The Account Migration Process</title> + <step><para>Create a BDC account for the samba server using NT Server Manager</para> + <substeps><step><para>Samba must NOT be running</para></step></substeps></step> + + <step> + <para>rpcclient NT4PDC -U Administrator%passwd</para> + <substeps><step><para>lsaquery</para></step> + <step><para>Note the SID returned</para></step> + </substeps> + </step> + + <step><para>net getsid -S NT4PDC -w DOMNAME -U Administrator%passwd</para> + <substeps><step><para>Note the SID</para></step></substeps> + </step> + + <step><para>net getlocalsid</para> + <substeps> + <step><para>Note the SID, now check that all three SIDS reported are the same!</para></step> + </substeps> + </step> + + <step><para>net rpc join -S NT4PDC -w DOMNAME -U Administrator%passwd</para></step> + + <step><para>net rpc vampire -S NT4PDC -U administrator%passwd</para></step> + + <step><para>pdbedit -l</para> + <substeps><step><para>Note - did the users migrate?</para></step></substeps> + </step> + + <step><para>initGrps.sh DOMNAME</para></step> + + <step><para>net groupmap list</para> + <substeps><step><para>Now check that all groups are recognised</para></step></substeps> + </step> + + <step><para>net rpc campire -S NT4PDC -U administrator%passwd</para></step> + + <step><para>pdbedit -lv</para> + <substeps><step> + <para>Note - check that all group membership has been migrated</para> + </step></substeps> + </step> +</procedure> + +<para> +Now it is time to migrate all the profiles, then migrate all policy files. +More later. +</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Migration Options</title> + +<para> +Based on feedback from many sites as well as from actual installation and maintenance +experience sites that wish to migrate from MS Windows NT4 Domain Control to a Samba +based solution fit into three basic categories. +</para> + +<table frame="all"><title>The 3 Major Site Types</title> +<tgroup cols="2"> + <thead> + <row><entry>Number of Users</entry><entry>Description</entry></row> + </thead> + <tbody> + <row><entry>< 50</entry><entry><para>Want simple conversion with NO pain</para></entry></row> + <row><entry>50 - 250</entry><entry><para>Want new features, can manage some in-house complexity</para></entry></row> + <row><entry>> 250</entry><entry><para>Solution/Implementation MUST scale well, complex needs. Cross departmental decision process. Local expertise in most areas</para></entry></row> + </tbody> +</tgroup> +</table> + +<sect2> +<title>Planning for Success</title> + +<para> +There are three basic choices for sites that intend to migrate from MS Windwows NT4 +to Samba-3. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + Simple Conversion (total replacement) + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Upgraded Conversion (could be one of integration) + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Complete Redesign (completely new solution) + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +No matter what choice you make, the following rules will minimise down-stream problems: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + Take sufficient time + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Avoid Panic + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Test ALL assumptions + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Test full roll-out program, including workstation deployment + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<table frame="top"><title>Nature of the Conversion Choices</title> +<tgroup cols="3"> + <thead> + <row><entry>Simple</entry><entry>Upgraded</entry><entry>Redesign</entry></row> + </thead> + <tbody> + <row> + <entry><para>Make use of minimal OS specific features</para></entry> + <entry><para>Translate NT4 features to new host OS features</para></entry> + <entry><para>Decide:</para></entry> + </row> + <row> + <entry><para>Suck all accounts from NT4 into Samba-3</para></entry> + <entry><para>Copy and improve:</para></entry> + <entry><para>Authentication Regime (database location and access)</para></entry> + </row> + <row> + <entry><para>Make least number of operational changes</para></entry> + <entry><para>Make progressive improvements</para></entry> + <entry><para>Desktop Management Methods</para></entry> + </row> + <row> + <entry><para>Take least amount of time to migrate</para></entry> + <entry><para>Minimise user impact</para></entry> + <entry><para>Better Control of Desktops / Users</para></entry> + </row> + <row> + <entry><para>Live versus Isolated Conversion</para></entry> + <entry><para>Maximise functionality</para></entry> + <entry><para>Identify Needs for: Manageability, Scalability, Security, Availability</para></entry> + </row> + <row> + <entry><para>Integrate Samba-3 then migrate while users are active, then Change of control (ie: swap out)</para></entry> + <entry><para>Take advantage of lower maintenance opportunity</para></entry> + <entry><para></para></entry> + </row> + </tbody> +</tgroup> +</table> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Samba Implementation Choices</title> + +<para><programlisting> +Authentication database back end + Winbind (external Samba or NT4/200x server) + Can use pam_mkhomedir.so to auto-create home dirs + External server could use Active Directory or NT4 Domain + +Database type + smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, MySQLsam + +Access Control Points + On the Share itself (Use NT4 Server Manager) + On the file system + Unix permissions on files and directories + Posix ACLs enablement in file system? + Through Samba share parameters + Not recommended - except as only resort + +Policies (migrate or create new ones) + Group Policy Editor (NT4) + Watch out for Tattoo effect + +User and Group Profiles + Platform specific so use platform tool to change from a Local + to a Roaming profile Can use new profiles tool to change SIDs + (NTUser.DAT) + +Logon Scripts (Know how they work) + +User and Group mapping to Unix/Linux + username map facility may be needed + Use 'net groupmap' to connect NT4 groups to Unix groups + Use pdbedit to set/change user configuration +NOTE: +If migrating to LDAP back end it may be easier to dump initial LDAP database +to LDIF, then edit, then reload into LDAP + + OS specific scripts / programs may be needed + Add / delete Users + Note OS limits on size of name (Linux 8 chars) + NT4 up to 254 chars + Add / delete machines + Applied only to domain members (note up to 16 chars) + Add / delete Groups + Note OS limits on size and nature + Linux limit is 16 char, + no spaces and no upper case chars (groupadd) + +Migration Tools + Domain Control (NT4 Style) + Profiles, Policies, Access Controls, Security + +Migration Tools + Samba: net, rpcclient, smbpasswd, pdbedit, profiles + Windows: NT4 Domain User Manager, Server Manager (NEXUS) + +Authentication + New SAM back end (smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam) +</programlisting> +</para> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/NT_Security.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/NT_Security.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..9bff25337c3 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/NT_Security.xml @@ -0,0 +1,335 @@ +<chapter id="unix-permissions"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jeremy; + <pubdate>12 Apr 1999</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>UNIX Permission Bits and Windows NT Access Control Lists</title> + +<sect1> + <title>Viewing and changing UNIX permissions using the NT + security dialogs</title> + + <para>Windows NT clients can use their native security settings + dialog box to view and modify the underlying UNIX permissions.</para> + + <para>Note that this ability is careful not to compromise + the security of the UNIX host Samba is running on, and + still obeys all the file permission rules that a Samba + administrator can set.</para> + + <note> + <para> + All access to Unix/Linux system file via Samba is controlled at + the operating system file access control level. When trying to + figure out file access problems it is vitally important to identify + the identity of the Windows user as it is presented by Samba at + the point of file access. This can best be determined from the + Samba log files. + </para> + </note> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>How to view file security on a Samba share</title> + + <para>From an NT4/2000/XP client, single-click with the right + mouse button on any file or directory in a Samba mounted + drive letter or UNC path. When the menu pops-up, click + on the <emphasis>Properties</emphasis> entry at the bottom of + the menu. This brings up the file properties dialog + box. Click on the tab <emphasis>Security</emphasis> and you + will see three buttons, <emphasis>Permissions</emphasis>, + <emphasis>Auditing</emphasis>, and <emphasis>Ownership</emphasis>. + The <emphasis>Auditing</emphasis> button will cause either + an error message <errorname>A requested privilege is not held + by the client</errorname> to appear if the user is not the + NT Administrator, or a dialog which is intended to allow an + Administrator to add auditing requirements to a file if the + user is logged on as the NT Administrator. This dialog is + non-functional with a Samba share at this time, as the only + useful button, the <command>Add</command> button will not currently + allow a list of users to be seen.</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Viewing file ownership</title> + + <para>Clicking on the <command>"Ownership"</command> button + brings up a dialog box telling you who owns the given file. The + owner name will be of the form :</para> + + <para><command>"SERVER\user (Long name)"</command></para> + + <para>Where <replaceable>SERVER</replaceable> is the NetBIOS name of + the Samba server, <replaceable>user</replaceable> is the user name of + the UNIX user who owns the file, and <replaceable>(Long name)</replaceable> + is the descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the + GECOS field of the UNIX password database). Click on the <command>Close + </command> button to remove this dialog.</para> + + <para>If the parameter <parameter>nt acl support</parameter> + is set to <constant>false</constant> then the file owner will + be shown as the NT user <command>"Everyone"</command>.</para> + + <para>The <command>Take Ownership</command> button will not allow + you to change the ownership of this file to yourself (clicking on + it will display a dialog box complaining that the user you are + currently logged onto the NT client cannot be found). The reason + for this is that changing the ownership of a file is a privileged + operation in UNIX, available only to the <emphasis>root</emphasis> + user. As clicking on this button causes NT to attempt to change + the ownership of a file to the current user logged into the NT + client this will not work with Samba at this time.</para> + + <para>There is an NT chown command that will work with Samba + and allow a user with Administrator privilege connected + to a Samba server as root to change the ownership of + files on both a local NTFS filesystem or remote mounted NTFS + or Samba drive. This is available as part of the <emphasis>Seclib + </emphasis> NT security library written by Jeremy Allison of + the Samba Team, available from the main Samba ftp site.</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Viewing file or directory permissions</title> + + <para>The third button is the <command>"Permissions"</command> + button. Clicking on this brings up a dialog box that shows both + the permissions and the UNIX owner of the file or directory. + The owner is displayed in the form :</para> + + <para><command>"SERVER\user (Long name)"</command></para> + + <para>Where <replaceable>SERVER</replaceable> is the NetBIOS name of + the Samba server, <replaceable>user</replaceable> is the user name of + the UNIX user who owns the file, and <replaceable>(Long name)</replaceable> + is the descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the + GECOS field of the UNIX password database).</para> + + <para>If the parameter <parameter>nt acl support</parameter> + is set to <constant>false</constant> then the file owner will + be shown as the NT user <command>"Everyone"</command> and the + permissions will be shown as NT "Full Control".</para> + + + <para>The permissions field is displayed differently for files + and directories, so I'll describe the way file permissions + are displayed first.</para> + + <sect2> + <title>File Permissions</title> + + <para>The standard UNIX user/group/world triple and + the corresponding "read", "write", "execute" permissions + triples are mapped by Samba into a three element NT ACL + with the 'r', 'w', and 'x' bits mapped into the corresponding + NT permissions. The UNIX world permissions are mapped into + the global NT group <command>Everyone</command>, followed + by the list of permissions allowed for UNIX world. The UNIX + owner and group permissions are displayed as an NT + <command>user</command> icon and an NT <command>local + group</command> icon respectively followed by the list + of permissions allowed for the UNIX user and group.</para> + + <para>As many UNIX permission sets don't map into common + NT names such as <command>"read"</command>, <command> + "change"</command> or <command>"full control"</command> then + usually the permissions will be prefixed by the words <command> + "Special Access"</command> in the NT display list.</para> + + <para>But what happens if the file has no permissions allowed + for a particular UNIX user group or world component ? In order + to allow "no permissions" to be seen and modified then Samba + overloads the NT <command>"Take Ownership"</command> ACL attribute + (which has no meaning in UNIX) and reports a component with + no permissions as having the NT <command>"O"</command> bit set. + This was chosen of course to make it look like a zero, meaning + zero permissions. More details on the decision behind this will + be given below.</para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Directory Permissions</title> + + <para>Directories on an NT NTFS file system have two + different sets of permissions. The first set of permissions + is the ACL set on the directory itself, this is usually displayed + in the first set of parentheses in the normal <command>"RW"</command> + NT style. This first set of permissions is created by Samba in + exactly the same way as normal file permissions are, described + above, and is displayed in the same way.</para> + + <para>The second set of directory permissions has no real meaning + in the UNIX permissions world and represents the <command> + "inherited"</command> permissions that any file created within + this directory would inherit.</para> + + <para>Samba synthesises these inherited permissions for NT by + returning as an NT ACL the UNIX permission mode that a new file + created by Samba on this share would receive.</para> + </sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Modifying file or directory permissions</title> + + <para>Modifying file and directory permissions is as simple + as changing the displayed permissions in the dialog box, and + clicking the <command>OK</command> button. However, there are + limitations that a user needs to be aware of, and also interactions + with the standard Samba permission masks and mapping of DOS + attributes that need to also be taken into account.</para> + + <para>If the parameter <parameter>nt acl support</parameter> + is set to <constant>false</constant> then any attempt to set + security permissions will fail with an <command>"Access Denied" + </command> message.</para> + + <para>The first thing to note is that the <command>"Add"</command> + button will not return a list of users in Samba (it will give + an error message of <command>"The remote procedure call failed + and did not execute"</command>). This means that you can only + manipulate the current user/group/world permissions listed in + the dialog box. This actually works quite well as these are the + only permissions that UNIX actually has.</para> + + <para>If a permission triple (either user, group, or world) + is removed from the list of permissions in the NT dialog box, + then when the <command>"OK"</command> button is pressed it will + be applied as "no permissions" on the UNIX side. If you then + view the permissions again the "no permissions" entry will appear + as the NT <command>"O"</command> flag, as described above. This + allows you to add permissions back to a file or directory once + you have removed them from a triple component.</para> + + <para>As UNIX supports only the "r", "w" and "x" bits of + an NT ACL then if other NT security attributes such as "Delete + access" are selected then they will be ignored when applied on + the Samba server.</para> + + <para>When setting permissions on a directory the second + set of permissions (in the second set of parentheses) is + by default applied to all files within that directory. If this + is not what you want you must uncheck the <command>"Replace + permissions on existing files"</command> checkbox in the NT + dialog before clicking <command>"OK"</command>.</para> + + <para>If you wish to remove all permissions from a + user/group/world component then you may either highlight the + component and click the <command>"Remove"</command> button, + or set the component to only have the special <command>"Take + Ownership"</command> permission (displayed as <command>"O" + </command>) highlighted.</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</title> + + <para>There are four parameters + to control interaction with the standard Samba create mask parameters. + These are :</para> + + <para><parameter>security mask</parameter></para> + <para><parameter>force security mode</parameter></para> + <para><parameter>directory security mask</parameter></para> + <para><parameter>force directory security mode</parameter></para> + + <para>Once a user clicks <command>"OK"</command> to apply the + permissions Samba maps the given permissions into a user/group/world + r/w/x triple set, and then will check the changed permissions for a + file against the bits set in the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYMASK"> + <parameter>security mask</parameter></ulink> parameter. Any bits that + were changed that are not set to '1' in this parameter are left alone + in the file permissions.</para> + + <para>Essentially, zero bits in the <parameter>security mask</parameter> + mask may be treated as a set of bits the user is <emphasis>not</emphasis> + allowed to change, and one bits are those the user is allowed to change. + </para> + + <para>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as + the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK"><parameter>create mask + </parameter></ulink> parameter. To allow a user to modify all the + user/group/world permissions on a file, set this parameter + to 0777.</para> + + <para>Next Samba checks the changed permissions for a file against + the bits set in the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#FORCESECURITYMODE"> + <parameter>force security mode</parameter></ulink> parameter. Any bits + that were changed that correspond to bits set to '1' in this parameter + are forced to be set.</para> + + <para>Essentially, bits set in the <parameter>force security mode + </parameter> parameter may be treated as a set of bits that, when + modifying security on a file, the user has always set to be 'on'.</para> + + <para>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value + as the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#FORCECREATEMODE"><parameter>force + create mode</parameter></ulink> parameter. + To allow a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file + with no restrictions set this parameter to 000.</para> + + <para>The <parameter>security mask</parameter> and <parameter>force + security mode</parameter> parameters are applied to the change + request in that order.</para> + + <para>For a directory Samba will perform the same operations as + described above for a file except using the parameter <parameter> + directory security mask</parameter> instead of <parameter>security + mask</parameter>, and <parameter>force directory security mode + </parameter> parameter instead of <parameter>force security mode + </parameter>.</para> + + <para>The <parameter>directory security mask</parameter> parameter + by default is set to the same value as the <parameter>directory mask + </parameter> parameter and the <parameter>force directory security + mode</parameter> parameter by default is set to the same value as + the <parameter>force directory mode</parameter> parameter. </para> + + <para>In this way Samba enforces the permission restrictions that + an administrator can set on a Samba share, whilst still allowing users + to modify the permission bits within that restriction.</para> + + <para>If you want to set up a share that allows users full control + in modifying the permission bits on their files and directories and + doesn't force any particular bits to be set 'on', then set the following + parameters in the &smb.conf; file in that share specific section :</para> + + <para><parameter>security mask = 0777</parameter></para> + <para><parameter>force security mode = 0</parameter></para> + <para><parameter>directory security mask = 0777</parameter></para> + <para><parameter>force directory security mode = 0</parameter></para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute + mapping</title> + + <para>Samba maps some of the DOS attribute bits (such as "read + only") into the UNIX permissions of a file. This means there can + be a conflict between the permission bits set via the security + dialog and the permission bits set by the file attribute mapping. + </para> + + <para>One way this can show up is if a file has no UNIX read access + for the owner it will show up as "read only" in the standard + file attributes tabbed dialog. Unfortunately this dialog is + the same one that contains the security info in another tab.</para> + + <para>What this can mean is that if the owner changes the permissions + to allow themselves read access using the security dialog, clicks + <command>"OK"</command> to get back to the standard attributes tab + dialog, and then clicks <command>"OK"</command> on that dialog, then + NT will set the file permissions back to read-only (as that is what + the attributes still say in the dialog). This means that after setting + permissions and clicking <command>"OK"</command> to get back to the + attributes dialog you should always hit <command>"Cancel"</command> + rather than <command>"OK"</command> to ensure that your changes + are not overridden.</para> +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/NetworkBrowsing.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/NetworkBrowsing.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..29768ea42ae --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/NetworkBrowsing.xml @@ -0,0 +1,1288 @@ +<chapter id="NetworkBrowsing"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + <pubdate>July 5, 1998</pubdate> + <pubdate>Updated: April 21, 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</title> + +<para> +This document contains detailed information as well as a fast track guide to +implementing browsing across subnets and / or across workgroups (or domains). +WINS is the best tool for resolution of NetBIOS names to IP addesses. WINS is +NOT involved in browse list handling except by way of name to address resolution. +</para> + +<note><para> +MS Windows 2000 and later can be configured to operate with NO NetBIOS +over TCP/IP. Samba-3 and later also supports this mode of operation. +When the use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP has been disabled then the primary +means for resolution of MS Windows machine names is via DNS and Active Directory. +The following information assumes that your site is running NetBIOS over TCP/IP. +</para></note> + +<sect1> +<title>What is Browsing?</title> + +<para> +To most people browsing means that they can see the MS Windows and Samba servers +in the Network Neighborhood, and when the computer icon for a particular server is +clicked, it opens up and shows the shares and printers available on the target server. +</para> + +<para> +What seems so simple is in fact a very complex interaction of different technologies. +The technologies (or methods) employed in making all of this work includes: +</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>MS Windows machines register their presence to the network</member> + <member>Machines announce themselves to other machines on the network</member> + <member>One or more machine on the network collates the local announcements</member> + <member>The client machine finds the machine that has the collated list of machines</member> + <member>The client machine is able to resolve the machine names to IP addresses</member> + <member>The client machine is able to connect to a target machine</member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +The samba application that controls/manages browse list management and name resolution is +called <filename>nmbd</filename>. The configuration parameters involved in nmbd's operation are: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + Browsing options: + ----------------- + * os level + lm announce + lm interval + * preferred master + * local master + * domain master + browse list + enhanced browsing + + Name Resolution Method: + ----------------------- + * name resolve order + + WINS options: + ------------- + dns proxy + wins proxy + * wins server + * wins support + wins hook +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +WINS Server and WINS Support are mutually exclusive options. Those marked with an '*' are +the only options that commonly MAY need to be modified. Even if not one of these parameters +is set nmbd will still do it's job. +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Discussion</title> + +<para> +Firstly, all MS Windows networking is based on SMB (Server Message +Block) based messaging. SMB messaging may be implemented using NetBIOS or +without NetBIOS. Samba implements NetBIOS by encapsulating it over TCP/IP. +MS Windows products can do likewise. NetBIOS based networking uses broadcast +messaging to affect browse list management. When running NetBIOS over +TCP/IP this uses UDP based messaging. UDP messages can be broadcast or unicast. +</para> + +<para> +Normally, only unicast UDP messaging can be forwarded by routers. The +<command>remote announce</command> +parameter to smb.conf helps to project browse announcements +to remote network segments via unicast UDP. Similarly, the +<command>remote browse sync</command> parameter of <filename>smb.conf</filename> +implements browse list collation using unicast UDP. +</para> + +<para> +Secondly, in those networks where Samba is the only SMB server technology +wherever possible <filename>nmbd</filename> should be configured on one (1) machine as the WINS +server. This makes it easy to manage the browsing environment. If each network +segment is configured with it's own Samba WINS server, then the only way to +get cross segment browsing to work is by using the +<command>remote announce</command> and the <command>remote browse sync</command> +parameters to your <filename>smb.conf</filename> file. +</para> + +<para> +If only one WINS server is used for an entire multi-segment network then +the use of the <command>remote announce</command> and the +<command>remote browse sync</command> parameters should NOT be necessary. +</para> + +<para> +As of Samba 3 WINS replication is being worked on. The bulk of the code has +been committed, but it still needs maturation. +</para> + +<para> +Right now samba WINS does not support MS-WINS replication. This means that +when setting up Samba as a WINS server there must only be one <filename>nmbd</filename> configured +as a WINS server on the network. Some sites have used multiple Samba WINS +servers for redundancy (one server per subnet) and then used +<command>remote browse sync</command> and <command>remote announce</command> +to affect browse list collation across all +segments. Note that this means clients will only resolve local names, +and must be configured to use DNS to resolve names on other subnets in +order to resolve the IP addresses of the servers they can see on other +subnets. This setup is not recommended, but is mentioned as a practical +consideration (ie: an 'if all else fails' scenario). +</para> + +<para> +Lastly, take note that browse lists are a collection of unreliable broadcast +messages that are repeated at intervals of not more than 15 minutes. This means +that it will take time to establish a browse list and it can take up to 45 +minutes to stabilise, particularly across network segments. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>How Browsing Functions</title> + +<para> +As stated above, MS Windows machines register their NetBIOS names +(ie: the machine name for each service type in operation) on start +up. Also, as stated above, the exact method by which this name registration +takes place is determined by whether or not the MS Windows client/server +has been given a WINS server address, whether or not LMHOSTS lookup +is enabled, or if DNS for NetBIOS name resolution is enabled, etc. +</para> + +<para> +In the case where there is no WINS server all name registrations as +well as name lookups are done by UDP broadcast. This isolates name +resolution to the local subnet, unless LMHOSTS is used to list all +names and IP addresses. In such situations Samba provides a means by +which the samba server name may be forcibly injected into the browse +list of a remote MS Windows network (using the +<command>remote announce</command> parameter). +</para> + +<para> +Where a WINS server is used, the MS Windows client will use UDP +unicast to register with the WINS server. Such packets can be routed +and thus WINS allows name resolution to function across routed networks. +</para> + +<para> +During the startup process an election will take place to create a +local master browser if one does not already exist. On each NetBIOS network +one machine will be elected to function as the domain master browser. This +domain browsing has nothing to do with MS security domain control. +Instead, the domain master browser serves the role of contacting each local +master browser (found by asking WINS or from LMHOSTS) and exchanging browse +list contents. This way every master browser will eventually obtain a complete +list of all machines that are on the network. Every 11-15 minutes an election +is held to determine which machine will be the master browser. By the nature of +the election criteria used, the machine with the highest uptime, or the +most senior protocol version, or other criteria, will win the election +as domain master browser. +</para> + +<para> +Clients wishing to browse the network make use of this list, but also depend +on the availability of correct name resolution to the respective IP +address/addresses. +</para> + +<para> +Any configuration that breaks name resolution and/or browsing intrinsics +will annoy users because they will have to put up with protracted +inability to use the network services. +</para> + +<para> +Samba supports a feature that allows forced synchonisation +of browse lists across routed networks using the <command>remote +browse sync</command> parameter in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file. +This causes Samba to contact the local master browser on a remote network and +to request browse list synchronisation. This effectively bridges +two networks that are separated by routers. The two remote +networks may use either broadcast based name resolution or WINS +based name resolution, but it should be noted that the <command>remote +browse sync</command> parameter provides browse list synchronisation - and +that is distinct from name to address resolution, in other +words, for cross subnet browsing to function correctly it is +essential that a name to address resolution mechanism be provided. +This mechanism could be via DNS, <filename>/etc/hosts</filename>, +and so on. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</title> + +<para> +To set up cross subnet browsing on a network containing machines +in up to be in a WORKGROUP, not an NT Domain you need to set up one +Samba server to be the Domain Master Browser (note that this is *NOT* +the same as a Primary Domain Controller, although in an NT Domain the +same machine plays both roles). The role of a Domain master browser is +to collate the browse lists from local master browsers on all the +subnets that have a machine participating in the workgroup. Without +one machine configured as a domain master browser each subnet would +be an isolated workgroup, unable to see any machines on any other +subnet. It is the presense of a domain master browser that makes +cross subnet browsing possible for a workgroup. +</para> + +<para> +In an WORKGROUP environment the domain master browser must be a +Samba server, and there must only be one domain master browser per +workgroup name. To set up a Samba server as a domain master browser, +set the following option in the [global] section of the &smb.conf; file : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + domain master = yes +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +The domain master browser should also preferrably be the local master +browser for its own subnet. In order to achieve this set the following +options in the [global] section of the &smb.conf; file : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + domain master = yes + local master = yes + preferred master = yes + os level = 65 +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +The domain master browser may be the same machine as the WINS +server, if you require. +</para> + +<para> +Next, you should ensure that each of the subnets contains a +machine that can act as a local master browser for the +workgroup. Any MS Windows NT/2K/XP/2003 machine should be +able to do this, as will Windows 9x machines (although these +tend to get rebooted more often, so it's not such a good idea +to use these). To make a Samba server a local master browser +set the following options in the [global] section of the +&smb.conf; file : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + domain master = no + local master = yes + preferred master = yes + os level = 65 +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +Do not do this for more than one Samba server on each subnet, +or they will war with each other over which is to be the local +master browser. +</para> + +<para> +The <command>local master</command> parameter allows Samba to act as a +local master browser. The <command>preferred master</command> causes nmbd +to force a browser election on startup and the <command>os level</command> +parameter sets Samba high enough so that it should win any browser elections. +</para> + +<para> +If you have an NT machine on the subnet that you wish to +be the local master browser then you can disable Samba from +becoming a local master browser by setting the following +options in the <command>[global]</command> section of the +&smb.conf; file : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + domain master = no + local master = no + preferred master = no + os level = 0 +</programlisting> +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</title> + +<para> +If you are adding Samba servers to a Windows NT Domain then +you must not set up a Samba server as a domain master browser. +By default, a Windows NT Primary Domain Controller for a Domain +name is also the Domain master browser for that name, and many +things will break if a Samba server registers the Domain master +browser NetBIOS name (<replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable><1B>) +with WINS instead of the PDC. +</para> + +<para> +For subnets other than the one containing the Windows NT PDC +you may set up Samba servers as local master browsers as +described. To make a Samba server a local master browser set +the following options in the <command>[global]</command> section +of the &smb.conf; file : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + domain master = no + local master = yes + preferred master = yes + os level = 65 +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +If you wish to have a Samba server fight the election with machines +on the same subnet you may set the <command>os level</command> parameter +to lower levels. By doing this you can tune the order of machines that +will become local master browsers if they are running. For +more details on this see the section <link linkend="browse-force-master"> +Forcing samba to be the master browser</link> +below. +</para> + +<para> +If you have Windows NT machines that are members of the domain +on all subnets, and you are sure they will always be running then +you can disable Samba from taking part in browser elections and +ever becoming a local master browser by setting following options +in the <command>[global]</command> section of the &smb.conf; +file : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + domain master = no + local master = no + preferred master = no + os level = 0 +</programlisting> +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2 id="browse-force-master"> +<title>Forcing samba to be the master</title> + +<para> +Who becomes the <command>master browser</command> is determined by an election +process using broadcasts. Each election packet contains a number of parameters +which determine what precedence (bias) a host should have in the +election. By default Samba uses a very low precedence and thus loses +elections to just about anyone else. +</para> + +<para> +If you want Samba to win elections then just set the <command>os level</command> global +option in &smb.conf; to a higher number. It defaults to 0. Using 34 +would make it win all elections over every other system (except other +samba systems!) +</para> + +<para> +A <command>os level</command> of 2 would make it beat WfWg and Win95, but not MS Windows +NT/2K Server. A MS Windows NT/2K Server domain controller uses level 32. +</para> + +<para>The maximum os level is 255</para> + +<para> +If you want samba to force an election on startup, then set the +<command>preferred master</command> global option in &smb.conf; to "yes". Samba will +then have a slight advantage over other potential master browsers +that are not preferred master browsers. Use this parameter with +care, as if you have two hosts (whether they are windows 95 or NT or +samba) on the same local subnet both set with <command>preferred master</command> to +"yes", then periodically and continually they will force an election +in order to become the local master browser. +</para> + +<para> +If you want samba to be a <command>domain master browser</command>, then it is +recommended that you also set <command>preferred master</command> to "yes", because +samba will not become a domain master browser for the whole of your +LAN or WAN if it is not also a local master browser on its own +broadcast isolated subnet. +</para> + +<para> +It is possible to configure two samba servers to attempt to become +the domain master browser for a domain. The first server that comes +up will be the domain master browser. All other samba servers will +attempt to become the domain master browser every 5 minutes. They +will find that another samba server is already the domain master +browser and will fail. This provides automatic redundancy, should +the current domain master browser fail. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Making samba the domain master</title> + +<para> +The domain master is responsible for collating the browse lists of +multiple subnets so that browsing can occur between subnets. You can +make samba act as the domain master by setting <command>domain master = yes</command> +in &smb.conf;. By default it will not be a domain master. +</para> + +<para> +Note that you should NOT set Samba to be the domain master for a +workgroup that has the same name as an NT Domain. +</para> + +<para> +When samba is the domain master and the master browser it will listen +for master announcements (made roughly every twelve minutes) from local +master browsers on other subnets and then contact them to synchronise +browse lists. +</para> + +<para> +If you want samba to be the domain master then I suggest you also set +the <command>os level</command> high enough to make sure it wins elections, and set +<command>preferred master</command> to "yes", to get samba to force an election on +startup. +</para> + +<para> +Note that all your servers (including samba) and clients should be +using a WINS server to resolve NetBIOS names. If your clients are only +using broadcasting to resolve NetBIOS names, then two things will occur: +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem> + <para> + your local master browsers will be unable to find a domain master + browser, as it will only be looking on the local subnet. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + if a client happens to get hold of a domain-wide browse list, and + a user attempts to access a host in that list, it will be unable to + resolve the NetBIOS name of that host. + </para> +</listitem> +</orderedlist> + +<para> +If, however, both samba and your clients are using a WINS server, then: +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem> + <para> + your local master browsers will contact the WINS server and, as long as + samba has registered that it is a domain master browser with the WINS + server, your local master browser will receive samba's ip address + as its domain master browser. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + when a client receives a domain-wide browse list, and a user attempts + to access a host in that list, it will contact the WINS server to + resolve the NetBIOS name of that host. as long as that host has + registered its NetBIOS name with the same WINS server, the user will + be able to see that host. + </para> +</listitem> +</orderedlist> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Note about broadcast addresses</title> + +<para> +If your network uses a "0" based broadcast address (for example if it +ends in a 0) then you will strike problems. Windows for Workgroups +does not seem to support a 0's broadcast and you will probably find +that browsing and name lookups won't work. +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Multiple interfaces</title> + +<para> +Samba now supports machines with multiple network interfaces. If you +have multiple interfaces then you will need to use the <command>interfaces</command> +option in &smb.conf; to configure them. +</para> +</sect2> +<sect2> +<title>Use of the <command>Remote Announce</command> parameter</title> +<para> +The <command>remote announce</command> parameter of +<filename>smb.conf</filename> can be used to forcibly ensure +that all the NetBIOS names on a network get announced to a remote network. +The syntax of the <command>remote announce</command> parameter is: +<programlisting> + remote announce = a.b.c.d [e.f.g.h] ... +</programlisting> +_or_ +<programlisting> + remote announce = a.b.c.d/WORKGROUP [e.f.g.h/WORKGROUP] ... +</programlisting> + +where: +<variablelist> +<varlistentry><term><replaceable>a.b.c.d</replaceable> and +<replaceable>e.f.g.h</replaceable></term> +<listitem><para>is either the LMB (Local Master Browser) IP address +or the broadcst address of the remote network. +ie: the LMB is at 192.168.1.10, or the address +could be given as 192.168.1.255 where the netmask +is assumed to be 24 bits (255.255.255.0). +When the remote announcement is made to the broadcast +address of the remote network every host will receive +our announcements. This is noisy and therefore +undesirable but may be necessary if we do NOT know +the IP address of the remote LMB.</para></listitem> +</varlistentry> + +<varlistentry> +<term><replaceable>WORKGROUP</replaceable></term> +<listitem><para>is optional and can be either our own workgroup +or that of the remote network. If you use the +workgroup name of the remote network then our +NetBIOS machine names will end up looking like +they belong to that workgroup, this may cause +name resolution problems and should be avoided. +</para></listitem> +</varlistentry> +</variablelist> +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Use of the <command>Remote Browse Sync</command> parameter</title> + +<para> +The <command>remote browse sync</command> parameter of +<filename>smb.conf</filename> is used to announce to +another LMB that it must synchronise it's NetBIOS name list with our +Samba LMB. It works ONLY if the Samba server that has this option is +simultaneously the LMB on it's network segment. +</para> + +<para> +The syntax of the <command>remote browse sync</command> parameter is: + +<programlisting> +remote browse sync = <replaceable>a.b.c.d</replaceable> +</programlisting> + +where <replaceable>a.b.c.d</replaceable> is either the IP address of the +remote LMB or else is the network broadcast address of the remote segment. +</para> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</title> + +<para> +Use of WINS (either Samba WINS _or_ MS Windows NT Server WINS) is highly +recommended. Every NetBIOS machine registers it's name together with a +name_type value for each of of several types of service it has available. +eg: It registers it's name directly as a unique (the type 0x03) name. +It also registers it's name if it is running the lanmanager compatible +server service (used to make shares and printers available to other users) +by registering the server (the type 0x20) name. +</para> + +<para> +All NetBIOS names are up to 15 characters in length. The name_type variable +is added to the end of the name - thus creating a 16 character name. Any +name that is shorter than 15 characters is padded with spaces to the 15th +character. ie: All NetBIOS names are 16 characters long (including the +name_type information). +</para> + +<para> +WINS can store these 16 character names as they get registered. A client +that wants to log onto the network can ask the WINS server for a list +of all names that have registered the NetLogon service name_type. This saves +broadcast traffic and greatly expedites logon processing. Since broadcast +name resolution can not be used across network segments this type of +information can only be provided via WINS _or_ via statically configured +<filename>lmhosts</filename> files that must reside on all clients in the +absence of WINS. +</para> + +<para> +WINS also serves the purpose of forcing browse list synchronisation by all +LMB's. LMB's must synchronise their browse list with the DMB (domain master +browser) and WINS helps the LMB to identify it's DMB. By definition this +will work only within a single workgroup. Note that the domain master browser +has NOTHING to do with what is referred to as an MS Windows NT Domain. The +later is a reference to a security environment while the DMB refers to the +master controller for browse list information only. +</para> + +<para> +Use of WINS will work correctly only if EVERY client TCP/IP protocol stack +has been configured to use the WINS server/s. Any client that has not been +configured to use the WINS server will continue to use only broadcast based +name registration so that WINS may NEVER get to know about it. In any case, +machines that have not registered with a WINS server will fail name to address +lookup attempts by other clients and will therefore cause workstation access +errors. +</para> + +<para> +To configure Samba as a WINS server just add +<command>wins support = yes</command> to the <filename>smb.conf</filename> +file [globals] section. +</para> + +<para> +To configure Samba to register with a WINS server just add +"wins server = a.b.c.d" to your smb.conf file [globals] section. +</para> + +<important><para> +Never use both <command>wins support = yes</command> together +with <command>wins server = a.b.c.d</command> +particularly not using it's own IP address. +Specifying both will cause &nmbd; to refuse to start! +</para></important> + +<sect2> +<title>Setting up a WINS server</title> + +<para> +Either a Samba machine or a Windows NT Server machine may be set up +as a WINS server. To set a Samba machine to be a WINS server you must +add the following option to the &smb.conf; file on the selected machine : +in the [globals] section add the line +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + wins support = yes +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +Versions of Samba prior to 1.9.17 had this parameter default to +yes. If you have any older versions of Samba on your network it is +strongly suggested you upgrade to a recent version, or at the very +least set the parameter to 'no' on all these machines. +</para> + +<para> +Machines with <command>wins support = yes</command> will keep a list of +all NetBIOS names registered with them, acting as a DNS for NetBIOS names. +</para> + +<para> +You should set up only ONE wins server. Do NOT set the +<command>wins support = yes</command> option on more than one Samba +server. +</para> + +<para> +To set up a Windows NT Server as a WINS server you need to set up +the WINS service - see your NT documentation for details. Note that +Windows NT WINS Servers can replicate to each other, allowing more +than one to be set up in a complex subnet environment. As Microsoft +refuse to document these replication protocols Samba cannot currently +participate in these replications. It is possible in the future that +a Samba->Samba WINS replication protocol may be defined, in which +case more than one Samba machine could be set up as a WINS server +but currently only one Samba server should have the +<command>wins support = yes</command> parameter set. +</para> + +<para> +After the WINS server has been configured you must ensure that all +machines participating on the network are configured with the address +of this WINS server. If your WINS server is a Samba machine, fill in +the Samba machine IP address in the "Primary WINS Server" field of +the "Control Panel->Network->Protocols->TCP->WINS Server" dialogs +in Windows 95 or Windows NT. To tell a Samba server the IP address +of the WINS server add the following line to the [global] section of +all &smb.conf; files : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + wins server = <name or IP address> +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +where <name or IP address> is either the DNS name of the WINS server +machine or its IP address. +</para> + +<para> +Note that this line MUST NOT BE SET in the &smb.conf; file of the Samba +server acting as the WINS server itself. If you set both the +<command>wins support = yes</command> option and the +<command>wins server = <name></command> option then +nmbd will fail to start. +</para> + +<para> +There are two possible scenarios for setting up cross subnet browsing. +The first details setting up cross subnet browsing on a network containing +Windows 95, Samba and Windows NT machines that are not configured as +part of a Windows NT Domain. The second details setting up cross subnet +browsing on networks that contain NT Domains. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>WINS Replication</title> + +<para> +Samba-3 permits WINS replication through the use of the <filename>wrepld</filename> utility. +This tool is not currently capable of being used as it is still in active development. +As soon as this tool becomes moderately functional we will prepare man pages and enhance this +section of the documentation to provide usage and technical details. +</para> + +</sect2> +<sect2> +<title>Static WINS Entries</title> + +<para> +New to Samba-3 is a tool called <filename>winsedit</filename> that may be used to add +static WINS entries to the WINS database. This tool can be used also to modify entries +existing in the WINS database. +</para> + +<para> +The development of the winsedit tool was made necessary due to the migration +of the older style wins.dat file into a new tdb binary backend data store. +</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Helpful Hints</title> + +<para> +The following hints should be carefully considered as they are stumbling points +for many new network administrators. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Windows Networking Protocols</title> + +<warning><para> +Do NOT use more than one (1) protocol on MS Windows machines +</para></warning> + +<para> +A very common cause of browsing problems results from installing more than +one protocol on an MS Windows machine. +</para> + +<para> +Every NetBIOS machine takes part in a process of electing the LMB (and DMB) +every 15 minutes. A set of election criteria is used to determine the order +of precidence for winning this election process. A machine running Samba or +Windows NT will be biased so that the most suitable machine will predictably +win and thus retain it's role. +</para> + +<para> +The election process is "fought out" so to speak over every NetBIOS network +interface. In the case of a Windows 9x machine that has both TCP/IP and IPX +installed and has NetBIOS enabled over both protocols the election will be +decided over both protocols. As often happens, if the Windows 9x machine is +the only one with both protocols then the LMB may be won on the NetBIOS +interface over the IPX protocol. Samba will then lose the LMB role as Windows +9x will insist it knows who the LMB is. Samba will then cease to function +as an LMB and thus browse list operation on all TCP/IP only machines will +fail. +</para> + +<para><emphasis> +Windows 95, 98, 98se, Me are referred to generically as Windows 9x. +The Windows NT4, 2000, XP and 2003 use common protocols. These are roughly +referred to as the WinNT family, but it should be recognised that 2000 and +XP/2003 introduce new protocol extensions that cause them to behave +differently from MS Windows NT4. Generally, where a server does NOT support +the newer or extended protocol, these will fall back to the NT4 protocols. +</emphasis></para> + +<para> +The safest rule of all to follow it this - USE ONLY ONE PROTOCOL! +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Name Resolution Order</title> + +<para> +Resolution of NetBIOS names to IP addresses can take place using a number +of methods. The only ones that can provide NetBIOS name_type information +are:</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>WINS: the best tool!</member> + <member>LMHOSTS: is static and hard to maintain.</member> + <member>Broadcast: uses UDP and can not resolve names across remote segments.</member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +Alternative means of name resolution includes:</para> +<simplelist> +<member>/etc/hosts: is static, hard to maintain, and lacks name_type info</member> +<member>DNS: is a good choice but lacks essential name_type info.</member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +Many sites want to restrict DNS lookups and want to avoid broadcast name +resolution traffic. The "name resolve order" parameter is of great help here. +The syntax of the "name resolve order" parameter is: +<programlisting> +name resolve order = wins lmhosts bcast host +</programlisting> +_or_ +<programlisting> +name resolve order = wins lmhosts (eliminates bcast and host) +</programlisting> +The default is: +<programlisting> +name resolve order = host lmhost wins bcast +</programlisting> +where "host" refers the the native methods used by the Unix system +to implement the gethostbyname() function call. This is normally +controlled by <filename>/etc/host.conf</filename>, <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> and <filename>/etc/resolv.conf</filename>. +</para> +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Technical Overview of browsing</title> + +<para> +SMB networking provides a mechanism by which clients can access a list +of machines in a network, a so-called <command>browse list</command>. This list +contains machines that are ready to offer file and/or print services +to other machines within the network. Thus it does not include +machines which aren't currently able to do server tasks. The browse +list is heavily used by all SMB clients. Configuration of SMB +browsing has been problematic for some Samba users, hence this +document. +</para> + +<para> +MS Windows 2000 and later, as with Samba 3 and later, can be +configured to not use NetBIOS over TCP/IP. When configured this way +it is imperative that name resolution (using DNS/LDAP/ADS) be correctly +configured and operative. Browsing will NOT work if name resolution +from SMB machine names to IP addresses does not function correctly. +</para> + +<para> +Where NetBIOS over TCP/IP is enabled use of a WINS server is highly +recommended to aid the resolution of NetBIOS (SMB) names to IP addresses. +WINS allows remote segment clients to obtain NetBIOS name_type information +that can NOT be provided by any other means of name resolution. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Browsing support in samba</title> + +<para> +Samba facilitates browsing. The browsing is supported by &nmbd; +and is also controlled by options in the &smb.conf; file. +Samba can act as a local browse master for a workgroup and the ability +to support domain logons and scripts is now available. +</para> + +<para> +Samba can also act as a domain master browser for a workgroup. This +means that it will collate lists from local browse masters into a +wide area network server list. In order for browse clients to +resolve the names they may find in this list, it is recommended that +both samba and your clients use a WINS server. +</para> + +<para> +Note that you should NOT set Samba to be the domain master for a +workgroup that has the same name as an NT Domain: on each wide area +network, you must only ever have one domain master browser per workgroup, +regardless of whether it is NT, Samba or any other type of domain master +that is providing this service. +</para> + +<note><para> +Nmbd can be configured as a WINS server, but it is not +necessary to specifically use samba as your WINS server. MS Windows +NT4, Server or Advanced Server 2000 or 2003 can be configured as +your WINS server. In a mixed NT/2000/2003 server and samba environment on +a Wide Area Network, it is recommended that you use the Microsoft +WINS server capabilities. In a samba-only environment, it is +recommended that you use one and only one Samba server as your WINS server. +</para></note> + +<para> +To get browsing to work you need to run nmbd as usual, but will need +to use the <command>workgroup</command> option in &smb.conf; +to control what workgroup Samba becomes a part of. +</para> + +<para> +Samba also has a useful option for a Samba server to offer itself for +browsing on another subnet. It is recommended that this option is only +used for 'unusual' purposes: announcements over the internet, for +example. See <command>remote announce</command> in the +&smb.conf; man page. +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Problem resolution</title> + +<para> +If something doesn't work then hopefully the log.nmb file will help +you track down the problem. Try a debug level of 2 or 3 for finding +problems. Also note that the current browse list usually gets stored +in text form in a file called <filename>browse.dat</filename>. +</para> + +<para> +Note that if it doesn't work for you, then you should still be able to +type the server name as <filename>\\SERVER</filename> in filemanager then +hit enter and filemanager should display the list of available shares. +</para> + +<para> +Some people find browsing fails because they don't have the global +<command>guest account</command> set to a valid account. Remember that the +IPC$ connection that lists the shares is done as guest, and thus you must +have a valid guest account. +</para> + +<para><emphasis> +MS Windows 2000 and upwards (as with Samba) can be configured to disallow +anonymous (ie: Guest account) access to the IPC$ share. In that case, the +MS Windows 2000/XP/2003 machine acting as an SMB/CIFS client will use the +name of the currently logged in user to query the IPC$ share. MS Windows +9X clients are not able to do this and thus will NOT be able to browse +server resources. +</emphasis></para> + +<para> +The other big problem people have is that their broadcast address, +netmask or IP address is wrong (specified with the "interfaces" option +in &smb.conf;) +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Browsing across subnets</title> +<para> +Since the release of Samba 1.9.17(alpha1) Samba has been +updated to enable it to support the replication of browse lists +across subnet boundaries. New code and options have been added to +achieve this. This section describes how to set this feature up +in different settings. +</para> + +<para> +To see browse lists that span TCP/IP subnets (ie. networks separated +by routers that don't pass broadcast traffic) you must set up at least +one WINS server. The WINS server acts as a DNS for NetBIOS names, allowing +NetBIOS name to IP address translation to be done by doing a direct +query of the WINS server. This is done via a directed UDP packet on +port 137 to the WINS server machine. The reason for a WINS server is +that by default, all NetBIOS name to IP address translation is done +by broadcasts from the querying machine. This means that machines +on one subnet will not be able to resolve the names of machines on +another subnet without using a WINS server. +</para> + +<para> +Remember, for browsing across subnets to work correctly, all machines, +be they Windows 95, Windows NT, or Samba servers must have the IP address +of a WINS server given to them by a DHCP server, or by manual configuration +(for Win95 and WinNT, this is in the TCP/IP Properties, under Network +settings) for Samba this is in the &smb.conf; file. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>How does cross subnet browsing work ?</title> + +<para> +Cross subnet browsing is a complicated dance, containing multiple +moving parts. It has taken Microsoft several years to get the code +that achieves this correct, and Samba lags behind in some areas. +Samba is capable of cross subnet browsing when configured correctly. +</para> + +<para> +Consider a network set up as follows : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + (DMB) + N1_A N1_B N1_C N1_D N1_E + | | | | | + ------------------------------------------------------- + | subnet 1 | + +---+ +---+ + |R1 | Router 1 Router 2 |R2 | + +---+ +---+ + | | + | subnet 2 subnet 3 | + -------------------------- ------------------------------------ + | | | | | | | | + N2_A N2_B N2_C N2_D N3_A N3_B N3_C N3_D + (WINS) +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +Consisting of 3 subnets (1, 2, 3) connected by two routers +(R1, R2) - these do not pass broadcasts. Subnet 1 has 5 machines +on it, subnet 2 has 4 machines, subnet 3 has 4 machines. Assume +for the moment that all these machines are configured to be in the +same workgroup (for simplicities sake). Machine N1_C on subnet 1 +is configured as Domain Master Browser (ie. it will collate the +browse lists for the workgroup). Machine N2_D is configured as +WINS server and all the other machines are configured to register +their NetBIOS names with it. +</para> + +<para> +As all these machines are booted up, elections for master browsers +will take place on each of the three subnets. Assume that machine +N1_C wins on subnet 1, N2_B wins on subnet 2, and N3_D wins on +subnet 3 - these machines are known as local master browsers for +their particular subnet. N1_C has an advantage in winning as the +local master browser on subnet 1 as it is set up as Domain Master +Browser. +</para> + +<para> +On each of the three networks, machines that are configured to +offer sharing services will broadcast that they are offering +these services. The local master browser on each subnet will +receive these broadcasts and keep a record of the fact that +the machine is offering a service. This list of records is +the basis of the browse list. For this case, assume that +all the machines are configured to offer services so all machines +will be on the browse list. +</para> + +<para> +For each network, the local master browser on that network is +considered 'authoritative' for all the names it receives via +local broadcast. This is because a machine seen by the local +master browser via a local broadcast must be on the same +network as the local master browser and thus is a 'trusted' +and 'verifiable' resource. Machines on other networks that +the local master browsers learn about when collating their +browse lists have not been directly seen - these records are +called 'non-authoritative'. +</para> + +<para> +At this point the browse lists look as follows (these are +the machines you would see in your network neighborhood if +you looked in it on a particular network right now). +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> +Subnet Browse Master List +------ ------------- ---- +Subnet1 N1_C N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E + +Subnet2 N2_B N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D + +Subnet3 N3_D N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +Note that at this point all the subnets are separate, no +machine is seen across any of the subnets. +</para> + +<para> +Now examine subnet 2. As soon as N2_B has become the local +master browser it looks for a Domain master browser to synchronize +its browse list with. It does this by querying the WINS server +(N2_D) for the IP address associated with the NetBIOS name +WORKGROUP<1B>. This name was registerd by the Domain master +browser (N1_C) with the WINS server as soon as it was booted. +</para> + +<para> +Once N2_B knows the address of the Domain master browser it +tells it that is the local master browser for subnet 2 by +sending a MasterAnnouncement packet as a UDP port 138 packet. +It then synchronizes with it by doing a NetServerEnum2 call. This +tells the Domain Master Browser to send it all the server +names it knows about. Once the domain master browser receives +the MasterAnnouncement packet it schedules a synchronization +request to the sender of that packet. After both synchronizations +are done the browse lists look like : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> +Subnet Browse Master List +------ ------------- ---- +Subnet1 N1_C N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, + N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*) + +Subnet2 N2_B N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D + N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*) + +Subnet3 N3_D N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D + +Servers with a (*) after them are non-authoritative names. +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +At this point users looking in their network neighborhood on +subnets 1 or 2 will see all the servers on both, users on +subnet 3 will still only see the servers on their own subnet. +</para> + +<para> +The same sequence of events that occured for N2_B now occurs +for the local master browser on subnet 3 (N3_D). When it +synchronizes browse lists with the domain master browser (N1_A) +it gets both the server entries on subnet 1, and those on +subnet 2. After N3_D has synchronized with N1_C and vica-versa +the browse lists look like. +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> +Subnet Browse Master List +------ ------------- ---- +Subnet1 N1_C N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, + N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), + N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*) + +Subnet2 N2_B N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D + N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*) + +Subnet3 N3_D N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D + N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), + N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*) + +Servers with a (*) after them are non-authoritative names. +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +At this point users looking in their network neighborhood on +subnets 1 or 3 will see all the servers on all sunbets, users on +subnet 2 will still only see the servers on subnets 1 and 2, but not 3. +</para> + +<para> +Finally, the local master browser for subnet 2 (N2_B) will sync again +with the domain master browser (N1_C) and will recieve the missing +server entries. Finally - and as a steady state (if no machines +are removed or shut off) the browse lists will look like : +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> +Subnet Browse Master List +------ ------------- ---- +Subnet1 N1_C N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, + N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), + N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*) + +Subnet2 N2_B N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D + N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*) + N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*) + +Subnet3 N3_D N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D + N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), + N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*) + +Servers with a (*) after them are non-authoritative names. +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +Synchronizations between the domain master browser and local +master browsers will continue to occur, but this should be a +steady state situation. +</para> + +<para> +If either router R1 or R2 fails the following will occur: +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem> + <para> + Names of computers on each side of the inaccessible network fragments + will be maintained for as long as 36 minutes, in the network neighbourhood + lists. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + Attempts to connect to these inaccessible computers will fail, but the + names will not be removed from the network neighbourhood lists. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + If one of the fragments is cut off from the WINS server, it will only + be able to access servers on its local subnet, by using subnet-isolated + broadcast NetBIOS name resolution. The effects are similar to that of + losing access to a DNS server. + </para> +</listitem> +</orderedlist> +</sect3> +</sect2> + +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Other-Clients.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Other-Clients.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..068b9c0b326 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Other-Clients.xml @@ -0,0 +1,373 @@ +<chapter id="Other-Clients"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jmcd; + &author.jelmer; + + <pubdate>5 Mar 2001</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Samba and other CIFS clients</title> + +<para>This chapter contains client-specific information.</para> + +<sect1> +<title>Macintosh clients?</title> + +<para> +Yes. <ulink url="http://www.thursby.com/">Thursby</ulink> now have a CIFS Client / Server called <ulink url="http://www.thursby.com/products/dave.html">DAVE</ulink> +</para> + +<para> +They test it against Windows 95, Windows NT and samba for +compatibility issues. At the time of writing, DAVE was at version +1.0.1. The 1.0.0 to 1.0.1 update is available as a free download from +the Thursby web site (the speed of finder copies has been greatly +enhanced, and there are bug-fixes included). +</para> + +<para> +Alternatives - There are two free implementations of AppleTalk for +several kinds of UNIX machnes, and several more commercial ones. +These products allow you to run file services and print services +natively to Macintosh users, with no additional support required on +the Macintosh. The two free omplementations are +<ulink url="http://www.umich.edu/~rsug/netatalk/">Netatalk</ulink>, and +<ulink url="http://www.cs.mu.oz.au/appletalk/atalk.html">CAP</ulink>. +What Samba offers MS +Windows users, these packages offer to Macs. For more info on these +packages, Samba, and Linux (and other UNIX-based systems) see +<ulink url="http://www.eats.com/linux_mac_win.html">http://www.eats.com/linux_mac_win.html</ulink> +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>OS2 Client</title> + + <sect2> + <title>How can I configure OS/2 Warp Connect or + OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba?</title> + + <para>A more complete answer to this question can be + found on <ulink url="http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/samba/warp.html"> + http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/samba/warp.html</ulink>.</para> + + <para>Basically, you need three components:</para> + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>The File and Print Client ('IBM Peer') + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para>TCP/IP ('Internet support') + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para>The "NetBIOS over TCP/IP" driver ('TCPBEUI') + </para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + <para>Installing the first two together with the base operating + system on a blank system is explained in the Warp manual. If Warp + has already been installed, but you now want to install the + networking support, use the "Selective Install for Networking" + object in the "System Setup" folder.</para> + + <para>Adding the "NetBIOS over TCP/IP" driver is not described + in the manual and just barely in the online documentation. Start + MPTS.EXE, click on OK, click on "Configure LAPS" and click + on "IBM OS/2 NETBIOS OVER TCP/IP" in 'Protocols'. This line + is then moved to 'Current Configuration'. Select that line, + click on "Change number" and increase it from 0 to 1. Save this + configuration.</para> + + <para>If the Samba server(s) is not on your local subnet, you + can optionally add IP names and addresses of these servers + to the "Names List", or specify a WINS server ('NetBIOS + Nameserver' in IBM and RFC terminology). For Warp Connect you + may need to download an update for 'IBM Peer' to bring it on + the same level as Warp 4. See the webpage mentioned above.</para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>How can I configure OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), + OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba?</title> + + <para>You can use the free Microsoft LAN Manager 2.2c Client + for OS/2 from + <ulink url="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/BusSys/Clients/LANMAN.OS2/"> + ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/BusSys/Clients/LANMAN.OS2/</ulink>. + See <ulink url="http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/lanman.html"> + http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/lanman.html</ulink> for + more information on how to install and use this client. In + a nutshell, edit the file \OS2VER in the root directory of + the OS/2 boot partition and add the lines:</para> + + <para><programlisting> + 20=setup.exe + 20=netwksta.sys + 20=netvdd.sys + </programlisting></para> + + <para>before you install the client. Also, don't use the + included NE2000 driver because it is buggy. Try the NE2000 + or NS2000 driver from + <ulink url="ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/pub/os2/network/ndis/"> + ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/pub/os2/network/ndis/</ulink> instead. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Are there any other issues when OS/2 (any version) + is used as a client?</title> + + <para>When you do a NET VIEW or use the "File and Print + Client Resource Browser", no Samba servers show up. This can + be fixed by a patch from <ulink + url="http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/samba/fix.html"> + http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/samba/fix.html</ulink>. + The patch will be included in a later version of Samba. It also + fixes a couple of other problems, such as preserving long + filenames when objects are dragged from the Workplace Shell + to the Samba server. </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>How do I get printer driver download working + for OS/2 clients?</title> + + <para>First, create a share called [PRINTDRV] that is + world-readable. Copy your OS/2 driver files there. Note + that the .EA_ files must still be separate, so you will need + to use the original install files, and not copy an installed + driver from an OS/2 system.</para> + + <para>Install the NT driver first for that printer. Then, + add to your smb.conf a parameter, os2 driver map = + <replaceable>filename</replaceable>". Then, in the file + specified by <replaceable>filename</replaceable>, map the + name of the NT driver name to the OS/2 driver name as + follows:</para> + + <para><command>nt driver name = os2 "driver + name"."device name"</command>, e.g.: + HP LaserJet 5L = LASERJET.HP LaserJet 5L</para> + + <para>You can have multiple drivers mapped in this file.</para> + + <para>If you only specify the OS/2 driver name, and not the + device name, the first attempt to download the driver will + actually download the files, but the OS/2 client will tell + you the driver is not available. On the second attempt, it + will work. This is fixed simply by adding the device name + to the mapping, after which it will work on the first attempt. + </para> + </sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Windows for Workgroups</title> + +<sect2> +<title>Use latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</title> + +<para>Use the latest TCP/IP stack from microsoft if you use Windows +for workgroups. +</para> + +<para>The early TCP/IP stacks had lots of bugs.</para> + +<para> +Microsoft has released an incremental upgrade to their TCP/IP 32-Bit +VxD drivers. The latest release can be found on their ftp site at +ftp.microsoft.com, located in /peropsys/windows/public/tcpip/wfwt32.exe. +There is an update.txt file there that describes the problems that were +fixed. New files include WINSOCK.DLL, TELNET.EXE, WSOCK.386, VNBT.386, +WSTCP.386, TRACERT.EXE, NETSTAT.EXE, and NBTSTAT.EXE. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Delete .pwl files after password change</title> + +<para> +WfWg does a lousy job with passwords. I find that if I change my +password on either the unix box or the PC the safest thing to do is to +delete the .pwl files in the windows directory. The PC will complain about not finding the files, but will soon get over it, allowing you to enter the new password. +</para> + +<para> +If you don't do this you may find that WfWg remembers and uses the old +password, even if you told it a new one. +</para> + +<para> +Often WfWg will totally ignore a password you give it in a dialog box. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Configure WfW password handling</title> + +<para> +There is a program call admincfg.exe +on the last disk (disk 8) of the WFW 3.11 disk set. To install it +type EXPAND A:\ADMINCFG.EX_ C:\WINDOWS\ADMINCFG.EXE Then add an icon +for it via the "Progam Manager" "New" Menu. This program allows you +to control how WFW handles passwords. ie disable Password Caching etc +for use with <command>security = user</command> +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Case handling of passwords</title> + +<para>Windows for Workgroups uppercases the password before sending it to the server. Unix passwords can be case-sensitive though. Check the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink> information on <command>password level</command> to specify what characters samba should try to uppercase when checking.</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Use TCP/IP as default protocol</title> + +<para>To support print queue reporting you may find +that you have to use TCP/IP as the default protocol under +WfWg. For some reason if you leave Netbeui as the default +it may break the print queue reporting on some systems. +It is presumably a WfWg bug.</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Speed improvement</title> + +<para> +Note that some people have found that setting DefaultRcvWindow in +the [MSTCP] section of the SYSTEM.INI file under WfWg to 3072 gives a +big improvement. I don't know why. +</para> + +<para> +My own experience wth DefaultRcvWindow is that I get much better +performance with a large value (16384 or larger). Other people have +reported that anything over 3072 slows things down enourmously. One +person even reported a speed drop of a factor of 30 when he went from +3072 to 8192. I don't know why. +</para> +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Windows '95/'98</title> + +<para> +When using Windows 95 OEM SR2 the following updates are recommended where Samba +is being used. Please NOTE that the above change will affect you once these +updates have been installed. +</para> + +<para> +There are more updates than the ones mentioned here. You are referred to the +Microsoft Web site for all currently available updates to your specific version +of Windows 95. +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem><para>Kernel Update: KRNLUPD.EXE</para></listitem> +<listitem><para>Ping Fix: PINGUPD.EXE</para></listitem> +<listitem><para>RPC Update: RPCRTUPD.EXE</para></listitem> +<listitem><para>TCP/IP Update: VIPUPD.EXE</para></listitem> +<listitem><para>Redirector Update: VRDRUPD.EXE</para></listitem> +</orderedlist> + +<para> +Also, if using MS OutLook it is desirable to install the OLEUPD.EXE fix. This +fix may stop your machine from hanging for an extended period when exiting +OutLook and you may also notice a significant speedup when accessing network +neighborhood services. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Speed improvement</title> + +<para> +Configure the win95 TCPIP registry settings to give better +performance. I use a program called MTUSPEED.exe which I got off the +net. There are various other utilities of this type freely available. +</para> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</title> + +<para> +There are several annoyances with Windows 2000 SP2. One of which +only appears when using a Samba server to host user profiles +to Windows 2000 SP2 clients in a Windows domain. This assumes +that Samba is a member of the domain, but the problem will +likely occur if it is not. +</para> + +<para> +In order to server profiles successfully to Windows 2000 SP2 +clients (when not operating as a PDC), Samba must have +<command>nt acl support = no</command> +added to the file share which houses the roaming profiles. +If this is not done, then the Windows 2000 SP2 client will +complain about not being able to access the profile (Access +Denied) and create multiple copies of it on disk (DOMAIN.user.001, +DOMAIN.user.002, etc...). See the +<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink> man page +for more details on this option. Also note that the +<command>nt acl support</command> parameter was formally a global parameter in +releases prior to Samba 2.2.2. +</para> + +<para> +The following is a minimal profile share: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + [profile] + path = /export/profile + create mask = 0600 + directory mask = 0700 + nt acl support = no + read only = no +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The reason for this bug is that the Win2k SP2 client copies +the security descriptor for the profile which contains +the Samba server's SID, and not the domain SID. The client +compares the SID for SAMBA\user and realizes it is +different that the one assigned to DOMAIN\user. Hence the reason +for the "access denied" message. +</para> + +<para> +By disabling the <command>nt acl support</command> parameter, Samba will send +the Win2k client a response to the QuerySecurityDescriptor +trans2 call which causes the client to set a default ACL +for the profile. This default ACL includes +</para> + +<para><command>DOMAIN\user "Full Control"</command></para> + +<note><para>This bug does not occur when using winbind to +create accounts on the Samba host for Domain users.</para></note> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Windows NT 3.1</title> + +<para>If you have problems communicating across routers with Windows +NT 3.1 workstations, read <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;[LN];Q103765">this Microsoft Knowledge Base article</ulink>. + +</para> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/PAM-Authentication-And-Samba.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/PAM-Authentication-And-Samba.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..4b5179acc7c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/PAM-Authentication-And-Samba.xml @@ -0,0 +1,389 @@ +<chapter id="pam"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + <pubdate> (Jun 21 2001) </pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>PAM Configuration for Centrally Managed Authentication</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Samba and PAM</title> + +<para> +A number of Unix systems (eg: Sun Solaris), as well as the +xxxxBSD family and Linux, now utilize the Pluggable Authentication +Modules (PAM) facility to provide all authentication, +authorization and resource control services. Prior to the +introduction of PAM, a decision to use an alternative to +the system password database (<filename>/etc/passwd</filename>) +would require the provision of alternatives for all programs that provide +security services. Such a choice would involve provision of +alternatives to such programs as: <command>login</command>, +<command>passwd</command>, <command>chown</command>, etc. +</para> + +<para> +PAM provides a mechanism that disconnects these security programs +from the underlying authentication/authorization infrastructure. +PAM is configured either through one file <filename>/etc/pam.conf</filename> (Solaris), +or by editing individual files that are located in <filename>/etc/pam.d</filename>. +</para> + +<note> + <para> + If the PAM authentication module (loadable link library file) is located in the + default location then it is not necessary to specify the path. In the case of + Linux, the default location is <filename>/lib/security</filename>. If the module + is located outside the default then the path must be specified as: + + <programlisting> + auth required /other_path/pam_strange_module.so + </programlisting> + </para> +</note> + +<para> +The following is an example <filename>/etc/pam.d/login</filename> configuration file. +This example had all options been uncommented is probably not usable +as it stacks many conditions before allowing successful completion +of the login process. Essentially all conditions can be disabled +by commenting them out except the calls to <filename>pam_pwdb.so</filename>. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + #%PAM-1.0 + # The PAM configuration file for the `login' service + # + auth required pam_securetty.so + auth required pam_nologin.so + # auth required pam_dialup.so + # auth optional pam_mail.so + auth required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5 + # account requisite pam_time.so + account required pam_pwdb.so + session required pam_pwdb.so + # session optional pam_lastlog.so + # password required pam_cracklib.so retry=3 + password required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5 +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +PAM allows use of replacable modules. Those available on a +sample system include: +</para> + +<para><prompt>$</prompt><userinput>/bin/ls /lib/security</userinput> +<programlisting> + pam_access.so pam_ftp.so pam_limits.so + pam_ncp_auth.so pam_rhosts_auth.so pam_stress.so + pam_cracklib.so pam_group.so pam_listfile.so + pam_nologin.so pam_rootok.so pam_tally.so + pam_deny.so pam_issue.so pam_mail.so + pam_permit.so pam_securetty.so pam_time.so + pam_dialup.so pam_lastlog.so pam_mkhomedir.so + pam_pwdb.so pam_shells.so pam_unix.so + pam_env.so pam_ldap.so pam_motd.so + pam_radius.so pam_smbpass.so pam_unix_acct.so + pam_wheel.so pam_unix_auth.so pam_unix_passwd.so + pam_userdb.so pam_warn.so pam_unix_session.so +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The following example for the login program replaces the use of +the <filename>pam_pwdb.so</filename> module which uses the system +password database (<filename>/etc/passwd</filename>, +<filename>/etc/shadow</filename>, <filename>/etc/group</filename>) with +the module <filename>pam_smbpass.so</filename> which uses the Samba +database which contains the Microsoft MD4 encrypted password +hashes. This database is stored in either +<filename>/usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</filename>, +<filename>/etc/samba/smbpasswd</filename>, or in +<filename>/etc/samba.d/smbpasswd</filename>, depending on the +Samba implementation for your Unix/Linux system. The +<filename>pam_smbpass.so</filename> module is provided by +Samba version 2.2.1 or later. It can be compiled by specifying the +<command>--with-pam_smbpass</command> options when running Samba's +<filename>configure</filename> script. For more information +on the <filename>pam_smbpass</filename> module, see the documentation +in the <filename>source/pam_smbpass</filename> directory of the Samba +source distribution. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + #%PAM-1.0 + # The PAM configuration file for the `login' service + # + auth required pam_smbpass.so nodelay + account required pam_smbpass.so nodelay + session required pam_smbpass.so nodelay + password required pam_smbpass.so nodelay +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The following is the PAM configuration file for a particular +Linux system. The default condition uses <filename>pam_pwdb.so</filename>. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + #%PAM-1.0 + # The PAM configuration file for the `samba' service + # + auth required pam_pwdb.so nullok nodelay shadow audit + account required pam_pwdb.so audit nodelay + session required pam_pwdb.so nodelay + password required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5 +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +In the following example the decision has been made to use the +smbpasswd database even for basic samba authentication. Such a +decision could also be made for the passwd program and would +thus allow the smbpasswd passwords to be changed using the passwd +program. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + #%PAM-1.0 + # The PAM configuration file for the `samba' service + # + auth required pam_smbpass.so nodelay + account required pam_pwdb.so audit nodelay + session required pam_pwdb.so nodelay + password required pam_smbpass.so nodelay smbconf=/etc/samba.d/smb.conf +</programlisting></para> + +<note><para>PAM allows stacking of authentication mechanisms. It is +also possible to pass information obtained within one PAM module through +to the next module in the PAM stack. Please refer to the documentation for +your particular system implementation for details regarding the specific +capabilities of PAM in this environment. Some Linux implmentations also +provide the <filename>pam_stack.so</filename> module that allows all +authentication to be configured in a single central file. The +<filename>pam_stack.so</filename> method has some very devoted followers +on the basis that it allows for easier administration. As with all issues in +life though, every decision makes trade-offs, so you may want examine the +PAM documentation for further helpful information. +</para></note> + +<sect2> +<title>PAM Configuration in smb.conf</title> + +<para> +There is an option in smb.conf called <ulink +url="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS">obey pam restrictions</ulink>. +The following is from the on-line help for this option in SWAT; +</para> + +<para> +When Samba is configured to enable PAM support (i.e. +<constant>--with-pam</constant>), this parameter will +control whether or not Samba should obey PAM's account +and session management directives. The default behavior +is to use PAM for clear text authentication only and to +ignore any account or session management. Note that Samba always +ignores PAM for authentication in the case of +<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">encrypt passwords = yes</ulink>. +The reason is that PAM modules cannot support the challenge/response +authentication mechanism needed in the presence of SMB +password encryption. +</para> + +<para>Default: <command>obey pam restrictions = no</command></para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Password Synchronisation using pam_smbpass.so</title> + +<para> +pam_smbpass is a PAM module which can be used on conforming systems to +keep the smbpasswd (Samba password) database in sync with the unix +password file. PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) is an API supported +under some Unices, such as Solaris, HPUX and Linux, that provides a +generic interface to authentication mechanisms. +</para> + +<para> +For more information on PAM, see http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/ +</para> + +<para> +This module authenticates a local smbpasswd user database. If you require +support for authenticating against a remote SMB server, or if you're +concerned about the presence of suid root binaries on your system, it is +recommended that you use pam_winbind instead. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +Options recognized by this module are as follows: + + debug - log more debugging info + audit - like debug, but also logs unknown usernames + use_first_pass - don't prompt the user for passwords; + take them from PAM_ items instead + try_first_pass - try to get the password from a previous + PAM module, fall back to prompting the user + use_authtok - like try_first_pass, but *fail* if the new + PAM_AUTHTOK has not been previously set. + (intended for stacking password modules only) + not_set_pass - don't make passwords used by this module + available to other modules. + nodelay - don't insert ~1 second delays on authentication + failure. + nullok - null passwords are allowed. + nonull - null passwords are not allowed. Used to + override the Samba configuration. + migrate - only meaningful in an "auth" context; + used to update smbpasswd file with a + password used for successful authentication. + smbconf=< file > - specify an alternate path to the smb.conf + file. +</programlisting></para> + +<para><programlisting> +Thanks go to the following people: + + * Andrew Morgan < morgan@transmeta.com >, for providing the Linux-PAM + framework, without which none of this would have happened + + * Christian Gafton < gafton@redhat.com > and Andrew Morgan again, for the + pam_pwdb module upon which pam_smbpass was originally based + + * Luke Leighton < lkcl@switchboard.net > for being receptive to the idea, + and for the occasional good-natured complaint about the project's status + that keep me working on it :) + + * and of course, all the other members of the Samba team + <http://www.samba.org/samba/team.html>, for creating a great product + and for giving this project a purpose + + --------------------- + Stephen Langasek < vorlon@netexpress.net > +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The following are examples of the use of pam_smbpass.so in the format of Linux +<filename>/etc/pam.d/</filename> files structure. Those wishing to implement this +tool on other platforms will need to adapt this appropriately. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>Password Synchonisation Configuration</title> + +<para> +A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of pam_smbpass to make +sure private/smbpasswd is kept in sync when /etc/passwd (/etc/shadow) +is changed. Useful when an expired password might be changed by an +application (such as ssh). +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + #%PAM-1.0 + # password-sync + # + auth requisite pam_nologin.so + auth required pam_unix.so + account required pam_unix.so + password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 + password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass + password required pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass + session required pam_unix.so +</programlisting></para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Password Migration Configuration</title> + +<para> +A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of pam_smbpass to migrate +from plaintext to encrypted passwords for Samba. Unlike other methods, +this can be used for users who have never connected to Samba shares: +password migration takes place when users ftp in, login using ssh, pop +their mail, etc. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + #%PAM-1.0 + # password-migration + # + auth requisite pam_nologin.so + # pam_smbpass is called IFF pam_unix succeeds. + auth requisite pam_unix.so + auth optional pam_smbpass.so migrate + account required pam_unix.so + password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 + password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass + password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass + session required pam_unix.so +</programlisting></para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Mature Password Configuration</title> + +<para> +A sample PAM configuration for a 'mature' smbpasswd installation. +private/smbpasswd is fully populated, and we consider it an error if +the smbpasswd doesn't exist or doesn't match the Unix password. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + #%PAM-1.0 + # password-mature + # + auth requisite pam_nologin.so + auth required pam_unix.so + account required pam_unix.so + password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 + password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass + password required pam_smbpass.so use_authtok use_first_pass + session required pam_unix.so +</programlisting></para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Kerberos Password Integration Configuration</title> + +<para> +A sample PAM configuration that shows pam_smbpass used together with +pam_krb5. This could be useful on a Samba PDC that is also a member of +a Kerberos realm. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + #%PAM-1.0 + # kdc-pdc + # + auth requisite pam_nologin.so + auth requisite pam_krb5.so + auth optional pam_smbpass.so migrate + account required pam_krb5.so + password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 + password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass + password required pam_krb5.so use_authtok try_first_pass + session required pam_krb5.so +</programlisting></para> +</sect3> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Distributed Authentication</title> + +<para> +The astute administrator will realize from this that the +combination of <filename>pam_smbpass.so</filename>, +<command>winbindd</command>, and a distributed +passdb backend, such as ldap, will allow the establishment of a +centrally managed, distributed +user/password database that can also be used by all +PAM (eg: Linux) aware programs and applications. This arrangement +can have particularly potent advantages compared with the +use of Microsoft Active Directory Service (ADS) in so far as +reduction of wide area network authentication traffic. +</para> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/PolicyMgmt.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/PolicyMgmt.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..2ae3fa5ea77 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/PolicyMgmt.xml @@ -0,0 +1,384 @@ +<chapter id="PolicyMgmt"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + <pubdate>April 3 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> +<title>System and Account Policies</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Creating and Managing System Policies</title> + +<para> +Under MS Windows platforms, particularly those following the release of MS Windows +NT4 and MS Windows 95) it is possible to create a type of file that would be placed +in the NETLOGON share of a domain controller. As the client logs onto the network +this file is read and the contents initiate changes to the registry of the client +machine. This file allows changes to be made to those parts of the registry that +affect users, groups of users, or machines. +</para> + +<para> +For MS Windows 9x/Me this file must be called <filename>Config.POL</filename> and may +be generated using a tool called <filename>poledit.exe</filename>, better known as the +Policy Editor. The policy editor was provided on the Windows 98 installation CD, but +dissappeared again with the introduction of MS Windows Me (Millenium Edition). From +comments from MS Windows network administrators it would appear that this tool became +a part of the MS Windows Me Resource Kit. +</para> + +<para> +MS Windows NT4 Server products include the <emphasis>System Policy Editor</emphasis> +under the <filename>Start -> Programs -> Administrative Tools</filename> menu item. +For MS Windows NT4 and later clients this file must be called <filename>NTConfig.POL</filename>. +</para> + +<para> +New with the introduction of MS Windows 2000 was the Microsoft Management Console +or MMC. This tool is the new wave in the ever changing landscape of Microsoft +methods for management of network access and security. Every new Microsoft product +or technology seems to obsolete the old rules and to introduce newer and more +complex tools and methods. To Microsoft's credit though, the MMC does appear to +be a step forward, but improved functionality comes at a great price. +</para> + +<para> +Before embarking on the configuration of network and system policies it is highly +advisable to read the documentation available from Microsoft's web site regarding +<ulink url="http://www.microsoft.com/ntserver/management/deployment/planguide/prof_policies.asp"> +Implementing Profiles and Policies in Windows NT 4.0 from http://www.microsoft.com/ntserver/management/deployment/planguide/prof_policies.asp</ulink> available from Microsoft. +There are a large number of documents in addition to this old one that should also +be read and understood. Try searching on the Microsoft web site for "Group Policies". +</para> + +<para> +What follows is a very brief discussion with some helpful notes. The information provided +here is incomplete - you are warned. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Windows 9x/Me Policies</title> + +<para> +You need the Win98 Group Policy Editor to set Group Profiles up under Windows 9x/Me. +It can be found on the Original full product Win98 installation CD under +<filename>tools/reskit/netadmin/poledit</filename>. Install this using the +Add/Remove Programs facility and then click on the 'Have Disk' tab. +</para> + +<para> +Use the Group Policy Editor to create a policy file that specifies the location of +user profiles and/or the <filename>My Documents</filename> etc. stuff. Then +save these settings in a file called <filename>Config.POL</filename> that needs to +be placed in the root of the [NETLOGON] share. If Win98 is configured to log onto +the Samba Domain, it will automatically read this file and update the Win9x/Me registry +of the machine as it logs on. +</para> + +<para> +Further details are covered in the Win98 Resource Kit documentation. +</para> + +<para> +If you do not take the right steps, then every so often Win9x/Me will check the +integrity of the registry and will restore it's settings from the back-up +copy of the registry it stores on each Win9x/Me machine. Hence, you will +occasionally notice things changing back to the original settings. +</para> + +<para> +Install the group policy handler for Win9x to pick up group policies. Look on the +Win98 CD in <filename>\tools\reskit\netadmin\poledit</filename>. +Install group policies on a Win9x client by double-clicking +<filename>grouppol.inf</filename>. Log off and on again a couple of times and see +if Win98 picks up group policies. Unfortunately this needs to be done on every +Win9x/Me machine that uses group policies. +</para> + +</sect2> +<sect2> +<title>Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</title> + +<para> +To create or edit <filename>ntconfig.pol</filename> you must use the NT Server +Policy Editor, <command>poledit.exe</command> which is included with NT4 Server +but <emphasis>not NT Workstation</emphasis>. There is a Policy Editor on a NT4 +Workstation but it is not suitable for creating <emphasis>Domain Policies</emphasis>. +Further, although the Windows 95 Policy Editor can be installed on an NT4 +Workstation/Server, it will not work with NT clients. However, the files from +the NT Server will run happily enough on an NT4 Workstation. +</para> + +<para> +You need <filename>poledit.exe, common.adm</filename> and <filename>winnt.adm</filename>. +It is convenient to put the two *.adm files in the <filename>c:\winnt\inf</filename> +directory which is where the binary will look for them unless told otherwise. Note also that that +directory is normally 'hidden'. +</para> + +<para> +The Windows NT policy editor is also included with the Service Pack 3 (and +later) for Windows NT 4.0. Extract the files using <command>servicepackname /x</command>, +i.e. that's <command>Nt4sp6ai.exe /x</command> for service pack 6a. The policy editor, +<command>poledit.exe</command> and the associated template files (*.adm) should +be extracted as well. It is also possible to downloaded the policy template +files for Office97 and get a copy of the policy editor. Another possible +location is with the Zero Administration Kit available for download from Microsoft. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>Registry Tattoos</title> + + <para> + With NT4 style registry based policy changes, a large number of settings are not + automatically reversed as the user logs off. Since the settings that were in the + NTConfig.POL file were applied to the client machine registry and that apply to the + hive key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE are permanent until explicitly reversed. This is known + as tattooing. It can have serious consequences down-stream and the administrator must + be extremely careful not to lock out the ability to manage the machine at a later date. + </para> + + +</sect3> +</sect2> +<sect2> +<title>MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</title> + +<para> +Windows NT4 System policies allows setting of registry parameters specific to +users, groups and computers (client workstations) that are members of the NT4 +style domain. Such policy file will work with MS Windows 2000 / XP clients also. +</para> + +<para> +New to MS Windows 2000 Microsoft introduced a new style of group policy that confers +a superset of capabilities compared with NT4 style policies. Obviously, the tool used +to create them is different, and the mechanism for implementing them is much changed. +</para> + +<para> +The older NT4 style registry based policies are known as <emphasis>Administrative Templates</emphasis> +in MS Windows 2000/XP Group Policy Objects (GPOs). The later includes ability to set various security +configurations, enforce Internet Explorer browser settings, change and redirect aspects of the +users' desktop (including: the location of <emphasis>My Documents</emphasis> files (directory), as +well as intrinsics of where menu items will appear in the Start menu). An additional new +feature is the ability to make available particular software Windows applications to particular +users and/or groups. +</para> + +<para> +Remember: NT4 policy files are named <filename>NTConfig.POL</filename> and are stored in the root +of the NETLOGON share on the domain controllers. A Windows NT4 user enters a username, a password +and selects the domain name to which the logon will attempt to take place. During the logon +process the client machine reads the NTConfig.POL file from the NETLOGON share on the authenticating +server, modifies the local registry values according to the settings in this file. +</para> + +<para> +Windows 2K GPOs are very feature rich. They are NOT stored in the NETLOGON share, rather part of +a Windows 200x policy file is stored in the Active Directory itself and the other part is stored +in a shared (and replicated) volume called the SYSVOL folder. This folder is present on all Active +Directory domain controllers. The part that is stored in the Active Directory itself is called the +group policy container (GPC), and the part that is stored in the replicated share called SYSVOL is +known as the group policy template (GPT). +</para> + +<para> +With NT4 clients the policy file is read and executed upon only as each user logs onto the network. +MS Windows 200x policies are much more complex - GPOs are processed and applied at client machine +startup (machine specific part) and when the user logs onto the network the user specific part +is applied. In MS Windows 200x style policy management each machine and/or user may be subject +to any number of concurently applicable (and applied) policy sets (GPOs). Active Directory allows +the administrator to also set filters over the policy settings. No such equivalent capability +exists with NT4 style policy files. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>Administration of Win2K / XP Policies</title> + +<title>Instructions</title> +<para> +Instead of using the tool called "The System Policy Editor", commonly called Poledit (from the +executable name poledit.exe), GPOs are created and managed using a Microsoft Management Console +(MMC) snap-in as follows:</para> +<procedure> +<step> +<para> +Go to the Windows 200x / XP menu <filename>Start->Programs->Administrative Tools</filename> + and select the MMC snap-in called "Active Directory Users and Computers" +</para> +</step> + +<step><para> +Select the domain or organizational unit (OU) that you wish to manage, then right click +to open the context menu for that object, select the properties item. +</para></step> + +<step><para> +Now left click on the Group Policy tab, then left click on the New tab. Type a name +for the new policy you will create. +</para></step> + +<step><para> +Now left click on the Edit tab to commence the steps needed to create the GPO. +</para></step> +</procedure> + +<para> +All policy configuration options are controlled through the use of policy administrative +templates. These files have a .adm extension, both in NT4 as well as in Windows 200x / XP. +Beware however, since the .adm files are NOT interchangible across NT4 and Windows 200x. +The later introduces many new features as well as extended definition capabilities. It is +well beyond the scope of this documentation to explain how to program .adm files, for that +the adminsitrator is referred to the Microsoft Windows Resource Kit for your particular +version of MS Windows. +</para> + +<note> +<para> +The MS Windows 2000 Resource Kit contains a tool called gpolmig.exe. This tool can be used +to migrate an NT4 NTConfig.POL file into a Windows 200x style GPO. Be VERY careful how you +use this powerful tool. Please refer to the resource kit manuals for specific usage information. +</para> +</note> + +</sect3> +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Managing Account/User Policies</title> + +<para> +Policies can define a specific user's settings or the settings for a group of users. The resulting +policy file contains the registry settings for all users, groups, and computers that will be using +the policy file. Separate policy files for each user, group, or computer are not not necessary. +</para> + +<para> +If you create a policy that will be automatically downloaded from validating domain controllers, +you should name the file NTconfig.POL. As system administrator, you have the option of renaming the +policy file and, by modifying the Windows NT-based workstation, directing the computer to update +the policy from a manual path. You can do this by either manually changing the registry or by using +the System Policy Editor. This path can even be a local path such that each machine has its own policy file, +but if a change is necessary to all machines, this change must be made individually to each workstation. +</para> + +<para> +When a Windows NT4/200x/XP machine logs onto the network the NETLOGON share on the authenticating domain +controller for the presence of the NTConfig.POL file. If one exists it is downloaded, parsed and then +applied to the user's part of the registry. +</para> + +<para> +MS Windows 200x/XP clients that log onto an MS Windows Active Directory security domain may additionally, +acquire policy settings through Group Policy Objects (GPOs) that are defined and stored in Active Directory +itself. The key benefit of using AS GPOs is that they impose no registry <emphasis>tatooing</emphasis> effect. +This has considerable advanage compared with the use of NTConfig.POL (NT4) style policy updates. +</para> + +<para> +In addition to user access controls that may be imposed or applied via system and/or group policies +in a manner that works in conjunction with user profiles, the user management environment under +MS Windows NT4/200x/XP allows per domain as well as per user account restrictions to be applied. +Common restrictions that are frequently used includes: +</para> + +<para> +<simplelist> + <member>Logon Hours</member> + <member>Password Aging</member> + <member>Permitted Logon from certain machines only</member> + <member>Account type (Local or Global)</member> + <member>User Rights</member> +</simplelist> +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>With Windows NT4/200x</title> + +<para> +The tools that may be used to configure these types of controls from the MS Windows environment are: +The NT4 User Manager for domains, the NT4 System and Group Policy Editor, the registry editor (regedt32.exe). +Under MS Windows 200x/XP this is done using the Microsoft Managment Console (MMC) with approapriate +"snap-ins", the registry editor, and potentially also the NT4 System and Group Policy Editor. +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>With a Samba PDC</title> + +<para> +With a Samba Domain Controller, the new tools for managing of user account and policy information includes: +<filename>smbpasswd, pdbedit, net, rpcclient.</filename>. The administrator should read the +man pages for these tools and become familiar with their use. +</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</title> + +<para> +The following attempts to document the order of processing of system and user policies following a system +reboot and as part of the user logon: +</para> + +<orderedlist> + <listitem><para> + Network starts, then Remote Procedure Call System Service (RPCSS) and Multiple Universal Naming + Convention Provider (MUP) start + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Where Active Directory is involved, an ordered list of Group Policy Objects (GPOs) is downloaded + and applied. The list may include GPOs that: +<simplelist> + <member>Apply to the location of machines in a Directory</member> + <member>Apply only when settings have changed</member> + <member>Depend on configuration of scope of applicability: local, site, domain, organizational unit, etc.</member> +</simplelist> + No desktop user interface is presented until the above have been processed. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Execution of start-up scripts (hidden and synchronous by defaut). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + A keyboard action to affect start of logon (Ctrl-Alt-Del). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + User credentials are validated, User profile is loaded (depends on policy settings). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + An ordered list of User GPOs is obtained. The list contents depends on what is configured in respsect of: + +<simplelist> + <member>Is user a domain member, thus subject to particular policies</member> + <member>Loopback enablement, and the state of the loopback policy (Merge or Replace)</member> + <member>Location of the Active Directory itself</member> + <member>Has the list of GPOs changed. No processing is needed if not changed.</member> +</simplelist> + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + User Policies are applied from Active Directory. Note: There are several types. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Logon scripts are run. New to Win2K and Active Directory, logon scripts may be obtained based on Group + Policy objects (hidden and executed synchronously). NT4 style logon scripts are then run in a normal + window. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + The User Interface as determined from the GPOs is presented. Note: In a Samba domain (like and NT4 + Domain) machine (system) policies are applied at start-up, User policies are applied at logon. + </para></listitem> +</orderedlist> + +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Portability.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Portability.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..72c3d205471 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Portability.xml @@ -0,0 +1,235 @@ +<chapter id="Portability"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jelmer; +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Portability</title> + +<para>Samba works on a wide range of platforms but the interface all the +platforms provide is not always compatible. This chapter contains +platform-specific information about compiling and using samba.</para> + +<sect1> +<title>HPUX</title> + +<para> +HP's implementation of supplementary groups is, er, non-standard (for +hysterical reasons). There are two group files, /etc/group and +/etc/logingroup; the system maps UIDs to numbers using the former, but +initgroups() reads the latter. Most system admins who know the ropes +symlink /etc/group to /etc/logingroup (hard link doesn't work for reasons +too stupid to go into here). initgroups() will complain if one of the +groups you're in in /etc/logingroup has what it considers to be an invalid +ID, which means outside the range [0..UID_MAX], where UID_MAX is (I think) +60000 currently on HP-UX. This precludes -2 and 65534, the usual 'nobody' +GIDs. +</para> + +<para> +If you encounter this problem, make sure that the programs that are failing +to initgroups() be run as users not in any groups with GIDs outside the +allowed range. +</para> + +<para>This is documented in the HP manual pages under setgroups(2) and passwd(4). +</para> + +<para> +On HPUX you must use gcc or the HP Ansi compiler. The free compiler +that comes with HP-UX is not Ansi compliant and cannot compile +Samba. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>SCO Unix</title> + +<para> +If you run an old version of SCO Unix then you may need to get important +TCP/IP patches for Samba to work correctly. Without the patch, you may +encounter corrupt data transfers using samba. +</para> + +<para> +The patch you need is UOD385 Connection Drivers SLS. It is available from +SCO (ftp.sco.com, directory SLS, files uod385a.Z and uod385a.ltr.Z). +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>DNIX</title> + +<para> +DNIX has a problem with seteuid() and setegid(). These routines are +needed for Samba to work correctly, but they were left out of the DNIX +C library for some reason. +</para> + +<para> +For this reason Samba by default defines the macro NO_EID in the DNIX +section of includes.h. This works around the problem in a limited way, +but it is far from ideal, some things still won't work right. +</para> + +<para> +To fix the problem properly you need to assemble the following two +functions and then either add them to your C library or link them into +Samba. +</para> + +<para> +put this in the file <filename>setegid.s</filename>: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + .globl _setegid +_setegid: + moveq #47,d0 + movl #100,a0 + moveq #1,d1 + movl 4(sp),a1 + trap #9 + bccs 1$ + jmp cerror +1$: + clrl d0 + rts +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +put this in the file <filename>seteuid.s</filename>: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + .globl _seteuid +_seteuid: + moveq #47,d0 + movl #100,a0 + moveq #0,d1 + movl 4(sp),a1 + trap #9 + bccs 1$ + jmp cerror +1$: + clrl d0 + rts +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +after creating the above files you then assemble them using +</para> + +<para><command>as seteuid.s</command></para> +<para><command>as setegid.s</command></para> + +<para> +that should produce the files <filename>seteuid.o</filename> and +<filename>setegid.o</filename> +</para> + +<para> +then you need to add these to the LIBSM line in the DNIX section of +the Samba Makefile. Your LIBSM line will then look something like this: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +LIBSM = setegid.o seteuid.o -ln +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +You should then remove the line: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +#define NO_EID +</programlisting></para> + +<para>from the DNIX section of <filename>includes.h</filename></para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</title> + +<para> +By default RedHat Rembrandt-II during installation adds an +entry to /etc/hosts as follows: +<programlisting> + 127.0.0.1 loopback "hostname"."domainname" +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +This causes Samba to loop back onto the loopback interface. +The result is that Samba fails to communicate correctly with +the world and therefor may fail to correctly negotiate who +is the master browse list holder and who is the master browser. +</para> + +<para> +Corrective Action: Delete the entry after the word loopback + in the line starting 127.0.0.1 +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>AIX</title> +<sect2> +<title>Sequential Read Ahead</title> +<!-- From an email by William Jojo <jojowil@hvcc.edu> --> +<para> +Disabling Sequential Read Ahead using <userinput>vmtune -r 0</userinput> improves +samba performance significally. +</para> +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Solaris</title> + +<sect2> +<title>Locking improvements</title> + +<para>Some people have been experiencing problems with F_SETLKW64/fcntl +when running samba on solaris. The built in file locking mechanism was +not scalable. Performance would degrade to the point where processes would +get into loops of trying to lock a file. It woul try a lock, then fail, +then try again. The lock attempt was failing before the grant was +occurring. So the visible manifestation of this would be a handful of +processes stealing all of the CPU, and when they were trussed they would +be stuck if F_SETLKW64 loops. +</para> + +<para> +Sun released patches for Solaris 2.6, 8, and 9. The patch for Solaris 7 +has not been released yet. +</para> + +<para> +The patch revision for 2.6 is 105181-34 +for 8 is 108528-19 +and for 9 is 112233-04 +</para> + +<para> +After the install of these patches it is recommended to reconfigure +and rebuild samba. +</para> + +<para>Thanks to Joe Meslovich for reporting</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2 id="winbind-solaris9"> +<title>Winbind on Solaris 9</title> +<para> +Nsswitch on Solaris 9 refuses to use the winbind nss module. This behavior +is fixed by Sun in patch 113476-05 which as of March 2003 is not in any +roll-up packages. +</para> +</sect2> +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Problems.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Problems.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..eb43b63b636 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Problems.xml @@ -0,0 +1,276 @@ +<chapter id="problems"> + +<chapterinfo> + &author.jerry; + &author.jelmer; + <author> + <firstname>David</firstname><surname>Bannon</surname> + <affiliation> + <orgname>Samba Team</orgname> + <address><email>dbannon@samba.org</email></address> + </affiliation> + </author> + <pubdate>8 Apr 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Analysing and solving samba problems</title> + +<para> +There are many sources of information available in the form +of mailing lists, RFC's and documentation. The docs that come +with the samba distribution contain very good explanations of +general SMB topics such as browsing.</para> + +<sect1> +<title>Diagnostics tools</title> + + <para> +One of the best diagnostic tools for debugging problems is Samba itself. +You can use the -d option for both smbd and nmbd to specify what +'debug level' at which to run. See the man pages on smbd, nmbd and +smb.conf for more information on debugging options. The debug +level can range from 1 (the default) to 10 (100 for debugging passwords). +</para> + +<para> +Another helpful method of debugging is to compile samba using the +<command>gcc -g </command> flag. This will include debug +information in the binaries and allow you to attach gdb to the +running smbd / nmbd process. In order to attach gdb to an smbd +process for an NT workstation, first get the workstation to make the +connection. Pressing ctrl-alt-delete and going down to the domain box +is sufficient (at least, on the first time you join the domain) to +generate a 'LsaEnumTrustedDomains'. Thereafter, the workstation +maintains an open connection, and therefore there will be an smbd +process running (assuming that you haven't set a really short smbd +idle timeout) So, in between pressing ctrl alt delete, and actually +typing in your password, you can attach gdb and continue. +</para> + +<para> +Some useful samba commands worth investigating: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>testparam | more</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>smbclient -L //{netbios name of server}</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +An SMB enabled version of tcpdump is available from +<ulink url="http://www.tcpdump.org/">http://www.tcpdup.org/</ulink>. +Ethereal, another good packet sniffer for Unix and Win32 +hosts, can be downloaded from <ulink +url="http://www.ethereal.com/">http://www.ethereal.com</ulink>. +</para> + +<para> +For tracing things on the Microsoft Windows NT, Network Monitor +(aka. netmon) is available on the Microsoft Developer Network CD's, +the Windows NT Server install CD and the SMS CD's. The version of +netmon that ships with SMS allows for dumping packets between any two +computers (i.e. placing the network interface in promiscuous mode). +The version on the NT Server install CD will only allow monitoring +of network traffic directed to the local NT box and broadcasts on the +local subnet. Be aware that Ethereal can read and write netmon +formatted files. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation or a Windows 9x box</title> + +<para> +Installing netmon on an NT workstation requires a couple +of steps. The following are for installing Netmon V4.00.349, which comes +with Microsoft Windows NT Server 4.0, on Microsoft Windows NT +Workstation 4.0. The process should be similar for other versions of +Windows NT / Netmon. You will need both the Microsoft Windows +NT Server 4.0 Install CD and the Workstation 4.0 Install CD. +</para> + +<para> +Initially you will need to install 'Network Monitor Tools and Agent' +on the NT Server. To do this +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Goto Start - Settings - Control Panel - + Network - Services - Add </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Select the 'Network Monitor Tools and Agent' and + click on 'OK'.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Click 'OK' on the Network Control Panel. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Insert the Windows NT Server 4.0 install CD + when prompted.</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +At this point the Netmon files should exist in +<filename>%SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon\*.*</filename>. +Two subdirectories exist as well, <filename>parsers\</filename> +which contains the necessary DLL's for parsing the netmon packet +dump, and <filename>captures\</filename>. +</para> + +<para> +In order to install the Netmon tools on an NT Workstation, you will +first need to install the 'Network Monitor Agent' from the Workstation +install CD. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Goto Start - Settings - Control Panel - + Network - Services - Add</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Select the 'Network Monitor Agent' and click + on 'OK'.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Click 'OK' on the Network Control Panel. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Insert the Windows NT Workstation 4.0 install + CD when prompted.</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Now copy the files from the NT Server in %SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon\*.* +to %SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon\*.* on the Workstation and set +permissions as you deem appropriate for your site. You will need +administrative rights on the NT box to run netmon. +</para> + +<para> +To install Netmon on a Windows 9x box install the network monitor agent +from the Windows 9x CD (\admin\nettools\netmon). There is a readme +file located with the netmon driver files on the CD if you need +information on how to do this. Copy the files from a working +Netmon installation. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Useful URL's</title> +<itemizedlist> + +<listitem><para>Home of Samba site <ulink url="http://samba.org"> + http://samba.org</ulink>. We have a mirror near you !</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> The <emphasis>Development</emphasis> document +on the Samba mirrors might mention your problem. If so, +it might mean that the developers are working on it.</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>See how Scott Merrill simulates a BDC behavior at + <ulink url="http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html"> + http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html</ulink>. </para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>Although 2.0.7 has almost had its day as a PDC, David Bannon will + keep the 2.0.7 PDC pages at <ulink url="http://bioserve.latrobe.edu.au/samba"> + http://bioserve.latrobe.edu.au/samba</ulink> going for a while yet.</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>Misc links to CIFS information + <ulink url="http://samba.org/cifs/">http://samba.org/cifs/</ulink></para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>NT Domains for Unix <ulink url="http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/ntdom/"> + http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/ntdom/</ulink></para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>FTP site for older SMB specs: + <ulink url="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/"> + ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/</ulink></para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Getting help from the mailing lists</title> + +<para> +There are a number of Samba related mailing lists. Go to <ulink +url="http://samba.org">http://samba.org</ulink>, click on your nearest mirror +and then click on <command>Support</command> and then click on <command> +Samba related mailing lists</command>. +</para> + +<para> +For questions relating to Samba TNG go to +<ulink url="http://www.samba-tng.org/">http://www.samba-tng.org/</ulink> +It has been requested that you don't post questions about Samba-TNG to the +main stream Samba lists.</para> + +<para> +If you post a message to one of the lists please observe the following guide lines : +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + +<listitem><para> Always remember that the developers are volunteers, they are +not paid and they never guarantee to produce a particular feature at +a particular time. Any time lines are 'best guess' and nothing more. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> Always mention what version of samba you are using and what +operating system its running under. You should probably list the +relevant sections of your &smb.conf; file, at least the options +in [global] that affect PDC support.</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>In addition to the version, if you obtained Samba via +CVS mention the date when you last checked it out.</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> Try and make your question clear and brief, lots of long, +convoluted questions get deleted before they are completely read ! +Don't post html encoded messages (if you can select colour or font +size its html).</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> If you run one of those nifty 'I'm on holidays' things when +you are away, make sure its configured to not answer mailing lists. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> Don't cross post. Work out which is the best list to post to +and see what happens, i.e. don't post to both samba-ntdom and samba-technical. +Many people active on the lists subscribe to more +than one list and get annoyed to see the same message two or more times. +Often someone will see a message and thinking it would be better dealt +with on another, will forward it on for you.</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>You might include <emphasis>partial</emphasis> +log files written at a debug level set to as much as 20. +Please don't send the entire log but enough to give the context of the +error messages.</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>(Possibly) If you have a complete netmon trace ( from the opening of +the pipe to the error ) you can send the *.CAP file as well.</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>Please think carefully before attaching a document to an email. +Consider pasting the relevant parts into the body of the message. The samba +mailing lists go to a huge number of people, do they all need a copy of your +smb.conf in their attach directory?</para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>How to get off the mailinglists</title> + +<para>To have your name removed from a samba mailing list, go to the +same place you went to to get on it. Go to <ulink +url="http://lists.samba.org/">http://lists.samba.org</ulink>, +click on your nearest mirror and then click on <command>Support</command> and +then click on <command> Samba related mailing lists</command>. Or perhaps see +<ulink url="http://lists.samba.org/mailman/roster/samba-ntdom">here</ulink> +</para> + +<para> +Please don't post messages to the list asking to be removed, you will just +be referred to the above address (unless that process failed in some way...) +</para> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/ProfileMgmt.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/ProfileMgmt.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..82897808b2c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/ProfileMgmt.xml @@ -0,0 +1,1126 @@ +<chapter id="ProfileMgmt"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + <pubdate>April 3 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Desktop Profile Management</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Roaming Profiles</title> + +<warning> +<para> +Roaming profiles support is different for Win9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x. +</para> +</warning> + +<para> +Before discussing how to configure roaming profiles, it is useful to see how +Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x clients implement these features. +</para> + +<para> +Windows 9x / Me clients send a NetUserGetInfo request to the server to get the user's +profiles location. However, the response does not have room for a separate +profiles location field, only the user's home share. This means that Win9X/Me +profiles are restricted to being stored in the user's home directory. +</para> + + +<para> +Windows NT4/200x clients send a NetSAMLogon RPC request, which contains many fields, +including a separate field for the location of the user's profiles. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</title> + +<para> +This section documents how to configure Samba for MS Windows client profile support. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>NT4/200x User Profiles</title> + +<para> +To support Windowns NT4/200x clients, in the [global] section of smb.conf set the +following (for example): +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + logon path = \\profileserver\profileshare\profilepath\%U\moreprofilepath +</programlisting> + + This is typically implemented like: + +<programlisting> + logon path = \\%L\Profiles\%u +</programlisting> +where %L translates to the name of the Samba server and %u translates to the user name +</para> + +<para> +The default for this option is \\%N\%U\profile, namely \\sambaserver\username\profile. +The \\N%\%U service is created automatically by the [homes] service. If you are using +a samba server for the profiles, you _must_ make the share specified in the logon path +browseable. Please refer to the man page for smb.conf in respect of the different +symantics of %L and %N, as well as %U and %u. +</para> + +<note> +<para> +MS Windows NT/2K clients at times do not disconnect a connection to a server +between logons. It is recommended to NOT use the <command>homes</command> +meta-service name as part of the profile share path. +</para> +</note> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Windows 9x / Me User Profiles</title> + +<para> +To support Windows 9x / Me clients, you must use the "logon home" parameter. Samba has +now been fixed so that <userinput>net use /home</userinput> now works as well, and it, too, relies +on the <command>logon home</command> parameter. +</para> + +<para> +By using the logon home parameter, you are restricted to putting Win9x / Me +profiles in the user's home directory. But wait! There is a trick you +can use. If you set the following in the <command>[global]</command> section of your &smb.conf; file: +</para> +<para><programlisting> + logon home = \\%L\%U\.profiles +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +then your Windows 9x / Me clients will dutifully put their clients in a subdirectory +of your home directory called <filename>.profiles</filename> (thus making them hidden). +</para> + +<para> +Not only that, but <userinput>net use /home</userinput> will also work, because of a feature in +Windows 9x / Me. It removes any directory stuff off the end of the home directory area +and only uses the server and share portion. That is, it looks like you +specified \\%L\%U for <command>logon home</command>. +</para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Mixed Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</title> + +<para> +You can support profiles for both Win9X and WinNT clients by setting both the +<command>logon home</command> and <command>logon path</command> parameters. For example: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + logon home = \\%L\%u\.profiles + logon path = \\%L\profiles\%u +</programlisting></para> + +</sect3> +<sect3> +<title>Disabling Roaming Profile Support</title> + +<para> +A question often asked is "How may I enforce use of local profiles?" or +"How do I disable Roaming Profiles?" +</para> + +<para> +There are three ways of doing this: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + <command>In smb.conf:</command> affect the following settings and ALL clients + will be forced to use a local profile: + <programlisting> + logon home = + logon path = + </programlisting></para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <command>MS Windows Registry:</command> by using the Microsoft Management Console + gpedit.msc to instruct your MS Windows XP machine to use only a local profile. This + of course modifies registry settings. The full path to the option is: + <programlisting> + Local Computer Policy\ + Computer Configuration\ + Administrative Templates\ + System\ + User Profiles\ + + Disable: Only Allow Local User Profiles + Disable: Prevent Roaming Profile Change from Propogating to the Server + </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <command>Change of Profile Type:</command> From the start menu right click on the + MY Computer icon, select <emphasis>Properties</emphasis>, click on the "<emphasis>User Profiles</emphasis> + tab, select the profile you wish to change from Roaming type to Local, click <emphasis>Change Type</emphasis>. + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Consult the MS Windows registry guide for your particular MS Windows version for more +information about which registry keys to change to enforce use of only local user +profiles. +</para> + +<note><para> +The specifics of how to convert a local profile to a roaming profile, or a roaming profile +to a local one vary according to the version of MS Windows you are running. Consult the +Microsoft MS Windows Resource Kit for your version of Windows for specific information. +</para></note> + +</sect3> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</title> + +<sect3> +<title>Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</title> + +<para> +When a user first logs in on Windows 9X, the file user.DAT is created, +as are folders "Start Menu", "Desktop", "Programs" and "Nethood". +These directories and their contents will be merged with the local +versions stored in c:\windows\profiles\username on subsequent logins, +taking the most recent from each. You will need to use the [global] +options "preserve case = yes", "short preserve case = yes" and +"case sensitive = no" in order to maintain capital letters in shortcuts +in any of the profile folders. +</para> + +<para> +The user.DAT file contains all the user's preferences. If you wish to +enforce a set of preferences, rename their user.DAT file to user.MAN, +and deny them write access to this file. +</para> + +<orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + On the Windows 9x / Me machine, go to Control Panel -> Passwords and + select the User Profiles tab. Select the required level of + roaming preferences. Press OK, but do _not_ allow the computer + to reboot. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + On the Windows 9x / Me machine, go to Control Panel -> Network -> + Client for Microsoft Networks -> Preferences. Select 'Log on to + NT Domain'. Then, ensure that the Primary Logon is 'Client for + Microsoft Networks'. Press OK, and this time allow the computer + to reboot. + </para> + </listitem> +</orderedlist> + +<para> +Under Windows 9x / Me Profiles are downloaded from the Primary Logon. +If you have the Primary Logon as 'Client for Novell Networks', then +the profiles and logon script will be downloaded from your Novell +Server. If you have the Primary Logon as 'Windows Logon', then the +profiles will be loaded from the local machine - a bit against the +concept of roaming profiles, it would seem! +</para> + +<para> +You will now find that the Microsoft Networks Login box contains +[user, password, domain] instead of just [user, password]. Type in +the samba server's domain name (or any other domain known to exist, +but bear in mind that the user will be authenticated against this +domain and profiles downloaded from it, if that domain logon server +supports it), user name and user's password. +</para> + +<para> +Once the user has been successfully validated, the Windows 9x / Me machine +will inform you that 'The user has not logged on before' and asks you +if you wish to save the user's preferences? Select 'yes'. +</para> + +<para> +Once the Windows 9x / Me client comes up with the desktop, you should be able +to examine the contents of the directory specified in the "logon path" +on the samba server and verify that the "Desktop", "Start Menu", +"Programs" and "Nethood" folders have been created. +</para> + +<para> +These folders will be cached locally on the client, and updated when +the user logs off (if you haven't made them read-only by then). +You will find that if the user creates further folders or short-cuts, +that the client will merge the profile contents downloaded with the +contents of the profile directory already on the local client, taking +the newest folders and short-cuts from each set. +</para> + +<para> +If you have made the folders / files read-only on the samba server, +then you will get errors from the Windows 9x / Me machine on logon and logout, as +it attempts to merge the local and the remote profile. Basically, if +you have any errors reported by the Windows 9x / Me machine, check the Unix file +permissions and ownership rights on the profile directory contents, +on the samba server. +</para> + +<para> +If you have problems creating user profiles, you can reset the user's +local desktop cache, as shown below. When this user then next logs in, +they will be told that they are logging in "for the first time". +</para> + +<orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + instead of logging in under the [user, password, domain] dialog, + press escape. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + run the regedit.exe program, and look in: + </para> + + <para> + HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Windows\CurrentVersion\ProfileList + </para> + + <para> + you will find an entry, for each user, of ProfilePath. Note the + contents of this key (likely to be c:\windows\profiles\username), + then delete the key ProfilePath for the required user. + + [Exit the registry editor]. + + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + <emphasis>WARNING</emphasis> - before deleting the contents of the + directory listed in the ProfilePath (this is likely to be + <filename>c:\windows\profiles\username)</filename>, ask them if they + have any important files stored on their desktop or in their start menu. + Delete the contents of the directory ProfilePath (making a backup if any + of the files are needed). + </para> + + <para> + This will have the effect of removing the local (read-only hidden + system file) user.DAT in their profile directory, as well as the + local "desktop", "nethood", "start menu" and "programs" folders. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + search for the user's .PWL password-caching file in the c:\windows + directory, and delete it. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + log off the windows 9x / Me client. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + check the contents of the profile path (see "logon path" described + above), and delete the user.DAT or user.MAN file for the user, + making a backup if required. + </para> + </listitem> + +</orderedlist> + +<para> +If all else fails, increase samba's debug log levels to between 3 and 10, +and / or run a packet trace program such as ethereal or netmon.exe, and +look for error messages. +</para> + +<para> +If you have access to an Windows NT4/200x server, then first set up roaming profiles +and / or netlogons on the Windows NT4/200x server. Make a packet trace, or examine +the example packet traces provided with Windows NT4/200x server, and see what the +differences are with the equivalent samba trace. +</para> + +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Windows NT4 Workstation</title> + +<para> +When a user first logs in to a Windows NT Workstation, the profile +NTuser.DAT is created. The profile location can be now specified +through the "logon path" parameter. +</para> + +<para> +There is a parameter that is now available for use with NT Profiles: +"logon drive". This should be set to <filename>H:</filename> or any other drive, and +should be used in conjunction with the new "logon home" parameter. +</para> + +<para> +The entry for the NT4 profile is a _directory_ not a file. The NT +help on profiles mentions that a directory is also created with a .PDS +extension. The user, while logging in, must have write permission to +create the full profile path (and the folder with the .PDS extension +for those situations where it might be created.) +</para> + +<para> +In the profile directory, Windows NT4 creates more folders than Windows 9x / Me. +It creates "Application Data" and others, as well as "Desktop", "Nethood", +"Start Menu" and "Programs". The profile itself is stored in a file +NTuser.DAT. Nothing appears to be stored in the .PDS directory, and +its purpose is currently unknown. +</para> + +<para> +You can use the System Control Panel to copy a local profile onto +a samba server (see NT Help on profiles: it is also capable of firing +up the correct location in the System Control Panel for you). The +NT Help file also mentions that renaming NTuser.DAT to NTuser.MAN +turns a profile into a mandatory one. +</para> + +<para> +The case of the profile is significant. The file must be called +NTuser.DAT or, for a mandatory profile, NTuser.MAN. +</para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Windows 2000/XP Professional</title> + +<para> +You must first convert the profile from a local profile to a domain +profile on the MS Windows workstation as follows: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + Log on as the LOCAL workstation administrator. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Right click on the 'My Computer' Icon, select 'Properties' + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Click on the 'User Profiles' tab + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Select the profile you wish to convert (click on it once) + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Click on the button 'Copy To' + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + In the "Permitted to use" box, click on the 'Change' button. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Click on the 'Look in" area that lists the machine name, when you click + here it will open up a selection box. Click on the domain to which the + profile must be accessible. + </para> + + <note><para>You will need to log on if a logon box opens up. Eg: In the connect + as: MIDEARTH\root, password: mypassword.</para></note> + </listitem> + + <listitem><para> + To make the profile capable of being used by anyone select 'Everyone' + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Click OK. The Selection box will close. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Now click on the 'Ok' button to create the profile in the path you + nominated. + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Done. You now have a profile that can be editted using the samba-3.0.0 +<filename>profiles</filename> tool. +</para> + +<note> +<para> +Under NT/2K the use of mandotory profiles forces the use of MS Exchange +storage of mail data. That keeps desktop profiles usable. +</para> +</note> + +<note> +<itemizedlist> +<listitem><para> +This is a security check new to Windows XP (or maybe only +Windows XP service pack 1). It can be disabled via a group policy in +Active Directory. The policy is:</para> + +<para>"Computer Configuration\Administrative Templates\System\User +Profiles\Do not check for user ownership of Roaming Profile Folders"</para> + +<para>...and it should be set to "Enabled". +Does the new version of samba have an Active Directory analogue? If so, +then you may be able to set the policy through this. +</para> + +<para> +If you cannot set group policies in samba, then you may be able to set +the policy locally on each machine. If you want to try this, then do +the following (N.B. I don't know for sure that this will work in the +same way as a domain group policy): +</para> + +</listitem> + +<listitem><para> +On the XP workstation log in with an Administrator account. +</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Click: "Start", "Run"</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Type: "mmc"</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Click: "OK"</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>A Microsoft Management Console should appear.</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Click: File, "Add/Remove Snap-in...", "Add"</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Double-Click: "Group Policy"</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Click: "Finish", "Close"</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Click: "OK"</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>In the "Console Root" window:</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Expand: "Local Computer Policy", "Computer Configuration",</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>"Administrative Templates", "System", "User Profiles"</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Double-Click: "Do not check for user ownership of Roaming Profile</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Folders"</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Select: "Enabled"</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Click: OK"</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Close the whole console. You do not need to save the settings (this + refers to the console settings rather than the policies you have + changed).</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Reboot</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> +</note> +</sect3> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</title> + +<para> +Sharing of desktop profiles between Windows versions is NOT recommended. +Desktop profiles are an evolving phenomenon and profiles for later versions +of MS Windows clients add features that may interfere with earlier versions +of MS Windows clients. Probably the more salient reason to NOT mix profiles +is that when logging off an earlier version of MS Windows the older format +of profile contents may overwrite information that belongs to the newer +version resulting in loss of profile information content when that user logs +on again with the newer version of MS Windows. +</para> + +<para> +If you then want to share the same Start Menu / Desktop with W9x/Me, you will +need to specify a common location for the profiles. The smb.conf parameters +that need to be common are <emphasis>logon path</emphasis> and +<emphasis>logon home</emphasis>. +</para> + +<para> +If you have this set up correctly, you will find separate user.DAT and +NTuser.DAT files in the same profile directory. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</title> + +<para> +There is nothing to stop you specifying any path that you like for the +location of users' profiles. Therefore, you could specify that the +profile be stored on a samba server, or any other SMB server, as long as +that SMB server supports encrypted passwords. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>Windows NT4 Profile Management Tools</title> + +<para> +Unfortunately, the Resource Kit information is specific to the version of MS Windows +NT4/200x. The correct resource kit is required for each platform. +</para> + +<para> +Here is a quick guide: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + +<listitem><para> +On your NT4 Domain Controller, right click on 'My Computer', then +select the tab labelled 'User Profiles'. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> +Select a user profile you want to migrate and click on it. +</para> + +<note><para>I am using the term "migrate" lossely. You can copy a profile to +create a group profile. You can give the user 'Everyone' rights to the +profile you copy this to. That is what you need to do, since your samba +domain is not a member of a trust relationship with your NT4 PDC.</para></note> +</listitem> + + <listitem><para>Click the 'Copy To' button.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>In the box labelled 'Copy Profile to' add your new path, eg: + <filename>c:\temp\foobar</filename></para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Click on the button labelled 'Change' in the "Permitted to use" box.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Click on the group 'Everyone' and then click OK. This closes the + 'chose user' box.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Now click OK.</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Follow the above for every profile you need to migrate. +</para> + +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Side bar Notes</title> + +<para> +You should obtain the SID of your NT4 domain. You can use smbpasswd to do +this. Read the man page.</para> + +<para> +With Samba-3.0.0 alpha code you can import all you NT4 domain accounts +using the net samsync method. This way you can retain your profile +settings as well as all your users. +</para> + +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>moveuser.exe</title> + +<para> +The W2K professional resource kit has moveuser.exe. moveuser.exe changes +the security of a profile from one user to another. This allows the account +domain to change, and/or the user name to change. +</para> + +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Get SID</title> + +<para> +You can identify the SID by using GetSID.exe from the Windows NT Server 4.0 +Resource Kit. +</para> + +<para> +Windows NT 4.0 stores the local profile information in the registry under +the following key: +HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\ProfileList +</para> + +<para> +Under the ProfileList key, there will be subkeys named with the SIDs of the +users who have logged on to this computer. (To find the profile information +for the user whose locally cached profile you want to move, find the SID for +the user with the GetSID.exe utility.) Inside of the appropriate user's +subkey, you will see a string value named ProfileImagePath. +</para> + +</sect3> +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Mandatory profiles</title> + +<para> +A Mandatory Profile is a profile that the user does NOT have the ability to overwrite. +During the user's session it may be possible to change the desktop environment, but +as the user logs out all changes made will be lost. If it is desired to NOT allow the +user any ability to change the desktop environment then this must be done through +policy settings. See previous chapter. +</para> + +<note> +<para> +Under NO circumstances should the profile directory (or it's contents) be made read-only +as this may render the profile un-usable. +</para> +</note> + +<para> +For MS Windows NT4/200x/XP the above method can be used to create mandatory profiles +also. To convert a group profile into a mandatory profile simply locate the NTUser.DAT +file in the copied profile and rename it to NTUser.MAN. +</para> + +<para> +For MS Windows 9x / Me it is the User.DAT file that must be renamed to User.MAN to +affect a mandatory profile. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Creating/Managing Group Profiles</title> + +<para> +Most organisations are arranged into departments. There is a nice benenfit in +this fact since usually most users in a department will require the same desktop +applications and the same desktop layout. MS Windows NT4/200x/XP will allow the +use of Group Profiles. A Group Profile is a profile that is created firstly using +a template (example) user. Then using the profile migration tool (see above) the +profile is assigned access rights for the user group that needs to be given access +to the group profile. +</para> + +<para> +The next step is rather important. PLEASE NOTE: Instead of assigning a group profile +to users (ie: Using User Manager) on a "per user" basis, the group itself is assigned +the now modified profile. +</para> + +<note> + <para> + Be careful with group profiles, if the user who is a member of a group also + has a personal profile, then the result will be a fusion (merge) of the two. + </para> +</note> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Default Profile for Windows Users</title> + +<para> +MS Windows 9x / Me and NT4/200x/XP will use a default profile for any user for whom +a profile does not already exist. Armed with a knowledge of where the default profile +is located on the Windows workstation, and knowing which registry keys affect the path +from which the default profile is created, it is possible to modify the default profile +to one that has been optimised for the site. This has significant administrative +advantages. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>MS Windows 9x/Me</title> + +<para> +To enable default per use profiles in Windows 9x / Me you can either use the Windows 98 System +Policy Editor or change the registry directly. +</para> + +<para> +To enable default per user profiles in Windows 9x / Me, launch the System Policy Editor, then +select File -> Open Registry, then click on the Local Computer icon, click on Windows 98 System, +select User Profiles, click on the enable box. Do not forget to save the registry changes. +</para> + +<para> +To modify the registry directly, launch the Registry Editor (regedit.exe), select the hive +<filename>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Network\Logon</filename>. Now add a DWORD type key with the name +"User Profiles", to enable user profiles set the value to 1, to disable user profiles set it to 0. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>How User Profiles Are Handled in Windows 9x / Me?</title> + +<para> +When a user logs on to a Windows 9x / Me machine, the local profile path, +<filename>HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Software\Microsoft\Windows\CurrentVersion\ProfileList</filename>, is checked +for an existing entry for that user: +</para> + +<para> +If the user has an entry in this registry location, Windows 9x / Me checks for a locally cached +version of the user profile. Windows 9x / Me also checks the user's home directory (or other +specified directory if the location has been modified) on the server for the User Profile. +If a profile exists in both locations, the newer of the two is used. If the User Profile exists +on the server, but does not exist on the local machine, the profile on the server is downloaded +and used. If the User Profile only exists on the local machine, that copy is used. +</para> + +<para> +If a User Profile is not found in either location, the Default User Profile from the Windows 9x / Me +machine is used and is copied to a newly created folder for the logged on user. At log off, any +changes that the user made are written to the user's local profile. If the user has a roaming +profile, the changes are written to the user's profile on the server. +</para> + +</sect3> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>MS Windows NT4 Workstation</title> + +<para> +On MS Windows NT4 the default user profile is obtained from the location +<filename>%SystemRoot%\Profiles</filename> which in a default installation will translate to +<filename>C:\WinNT\Profiles</filename>. Under this directory on a clean install there will be +three (3) directories: <filename>Administrator, All Users, Default User</filename>. +</para> + +<para> +The <filename>All Users</filename> directory contains menu settings that are common across all +system users. The <filename>Default User</filename> directory contains menu entries that are +customisable per user depending on the profile settings chosen/created. +</para> + +<para> +When a new user first logs onto an MS Windows NT4 machine a new profile is created from: +</para> + +<simplelist> + <member>All Users settings</member> + <member>Default User settings (contains the default NTUser.DAT file)</member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +When a user logs onto an MS Windows NT4 machine that is a member of a Microsoft security domain +the following steps are followed in respect of profile handling: +</para> + +<orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + The users' account information which is obtained during the logon process contains + the location of the users' desktop profile. The profile path may be local to the + machine or it may be located on a network share. If there exists a profile at the location + of the path from the user account, then this profile is copied to the location + <filename>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</filename>. This profile then inherits the + settings in the <filename>All Users</filename> profile in the <filename>%SystemRoot%\Profiles</filename> + location. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If the user account has a profile path, but at it's location a profile does not exist, + then a new profile is created in the <filename>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</filename> + directory from reading the <filename>Default User</filename> profile. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If the NETLOGON share on the authenticating server (logon server) contains a policy file + (<filename>NTConfig.POL</filename>) then it's contents are applied to the <filename>NTUser.DAT</filename> + which is applied to the <filename>HKEY_CURRENT_USER</filename> part of the registry. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When the user logs out, if the profile is set to be a roaming profile it will be written + out to the location of the profile. The <filename>NTuser.DAT</filename> file is then + re-created from the contents of the <filename>HKEY_CURRENT_USER</filename> contents. + Thus, should there not exist in the NETLOGON share an <filename>NTConfig.POL</filename> at the + next logon, the effect of the provious <filename>NTConfig.POL</filename> will still be held + in the profile. The effect of this is known as <emphasis>tatooing</emphasis>. + </para> + </listitem> +</orderedlist> + +<para> +MS Windows NT4 profiles may be <emphasis>Local</emphasis> or <emphasis>Roaming</emphasis>. A Local profile +will stored in the <filename>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</filename> location. A roaming profile will +also remain stored in the same way, unless the following registry key is created: +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\winlogon\ + "DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001 +</programlisting> + +In which case, the local copy (in <filename>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</filename>) will be +deleted on logout. +</para> + +<para> +Under MS Windows NT4 default locations for common resources (like <filename>My Documents</filename> +may be redirected to a network share by modifying the following registry keys. These changes may be affected +via use of the System Policy Editor (to do so may require that you create your owns template extension +for the policy editor to allow this to be done through the GUI. Another way to do this is by way of first +creating a default user profile, then while logged in as that user, run regedt32 to edit the key settings. +</para> + +<para> +The Registry Hive key that affects the behaviour of folders that are part of the default user profile +are controlled by entries on Windows NT4 is: +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + HKEY_CURRENT_USER + \Software + \Microsoft + \Windows + \CurrentVersion + \Explorer + \User Shell Folders\ +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +The above hive key contains a list of automatically managed folders. The default entries are: +</para> + + <para> + <programlisting> + Name Default Value + -------------- ----------------------------------------- + AppData %USERPROFILE%\Application Data + Desktop %USERPROFILE%\Desktop + Favorites %USERPROFILE%\Favorites + NetHood %USERPROFILE%\NetHood + PrintHood %USERPROFILE%\PrintHood + Programs %USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs + Recent %USERPROFILE%\Recent + SendTo %USERPROFILE%\SendTo + Start Menu %USERPROFILE%\Start Menu + Startup %USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup + </programlisting> + </para> + +<para> +The registry key that contains the location of the default profile settings is: + +<programlisting> + HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE + \SOFTWARE + \Microsoft + \Windows + \CurrentVersion + \Explorer + \User Shell Folders +</programlisting> + +The default entries are: + +<programlisting> + Common Desktop %SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Desktop + Common Programs %SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Programs + Common Start Menu %SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu + Common Startup %SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu\Progams\Startup +</programlisting> +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>MS Windows 200x/XP</title> + + <note> + <para> + MS Windows XP Home Edition does use default per user profiles, but can not participate + in domain security, can not log onto an NT/ADS style domain, and thus can obtain the profile + only from itself. While there are benefits in doing this the beauty of those MS Windows + clients that CAN participate in domain logon processes allows the administrator to create + a global default profile and to enforce it through the use of Group Policy Objects (GPOs). + </para> + </note> + +<para> +When a new user first logs onto MS Windows 200x/XP machine the default profile is obtained from +<filename>C:\Documents and Settings\Default User</filename>. The administrator can modify (or change +the contents of this location and MS Windows 200x/XP will gladly use it. This is far from the optimum +arrangement since it will involve copying a new default profile to every MS Windows 200x/XP client +workstation. +</para> + +<para> +When MS Windows 200x/XP participate in a domain security context, and if the default user +profile is not found, then the client will search for a default profile in the NETLOGON share +of the authenticating server. ie: In MS Windows parlance: +<filename>%LOGONSERVER%\NETLOGON\Default User</filename> and if one exits there it will copy this +to the workstation to the <filename>C:\Documents and Settings\</filename> under the Windows +login name of the user. +</para> + + <note> + <para> + This path translates, in Samba parlance, to the smb.conf [NETLOGON] share. The directory + should be created at the root of this share and must be called <filename>Default Profile</filename>. + </para> + </note> + +<para> +If a default profile does not exist in this location then MS Windows 200x/XP will use the local +default profile. +</para> + +<para> +On loging out, the users' desktop profile will be stored to the location specified in the registry +settings that pertain to the user. If no specific policies have been created, or passed to the client +during the login process (as Samba does automatically), then the user's profile will be written to +the local machine only under the path <filename>C:\Documents and Settings\%USERNAME%</filename>. +</para> + +<para> +Those wishing to modify the default behaviour can do so through three methods: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Modify the registry keys on the local machine manually and place the new default profile in the + NETLOGON share root - NOT recommended as it is maintenance intensive. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Create an NT4 style NTConfig.POL file that specified this behaviour and locate this file + in the root of the NETLOGON share along with the new default profile. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Create a GPO that enforces this through Active Directory, and place the new default profile + in the NETLOGON share. + </para> + </listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +The Registry Hive key that affects the behaviour of folders that are part of the default user profile +are controlled by entries on Windows 200x/XP is: +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + HKEY_CURRENT_USER + \Software + \Microsoft + \Windows + \CurrentVersion + \Explorer + \User Shell Folders\ +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +The above hive key contains a list of automatically managed folders. The default entries are: +</para> + + <para> + <programlisting> + Name Default Value + -------------- ----------------------------------------- + AppData %USERPROFILE%\Application Data + Cache %USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Temporary Internet Files + Cookies %USERPROFILE%\Cookies + Desktop %USERPROFILE%\Desktop + Favorites %USERPROFILE%\Favorites + History %USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\History + Local AppData %USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Application Data + Local Settings %USERPROFILE%\Local Settings + My Pictures %USERPROFILE%\My Documents\My Pictures + NetHood %USERPROFILE%\NetHood + Personal %USERPROFILE%\My Documents + PrintHood %USERPROFILE%\PrintHood + Programs %USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs + Recent %USERPROFILE%\Recent + SendTo %USERPROFILE%\SendTo + Start Menu %USERPROFILE%\Start Menu + Startup %USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup + Templates %USERPROFILE%\Templates + </programlisting> + </para> + +<para> +There is also an entry called "Default" that has no value set. The default entry is of type REG_SZ, all +the others are of type REG_EXPAND_SZ. +</para> + +<para> +It makes a huge difference to the speed of handling roaming user profiles if all the folders are +stored on a dedicated location on a network server. This means that it will NOT be necessary to +write the Outlook PST file over the network for every login and logout. +</para> + +<para> +To set this to a network location you could use the following examples: + +<programlisting> + %LOGONSERVER%\%USERNAME%\Default Folders +</programlisting> + +This would store the folders in the user's home directory under a directory called "Default Folders" + +You could also use: + +<programlisting> + \\SambaServer\FolderShare\%USERNAME% +</programlisting> + +in which case the default folders will be stored in the server named <emphasis>SambaServer</emphasis> +in the share called <emphasis>FolderShare</emphasis> under a directory that has the name of the MS Windows +user as seen by the Linux/Unix file system. +</para> + +<para> +Please note that once you have created a default profile share, you MUST migrate a user's profile +(default or custom) to it. +</para> + +<para> +MS Windows 200x/XP profiles may be <emphasis>Local</emphasis> or <emphasis>Roaming</emphasis>. +A roaming profile will be cached locally unless the following registry key is created: +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\winlogon\ + "DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001 +</programlisting> + +In which case, the local cache copy will be deleted on logout. +</para> +</sect2> +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/SWAT.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/SWAT.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..f238e8e1b0c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/SWAT.xml @@ -0,0 +1,351 @@ +<chapter id="SWAT"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; + <pubdate>April 21, 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>SWAT - The Samba Web Admininistration Tool</title> + +<para> +There are many and varied opinions regarding the usefulness or otherwise of SWAT. +No matter how hard one tries to produce the perfect configuration tool it remains +an object of personal taste. SWAT is a tool that will allow web based configuration +of samba. It has a wizard that may help to get samba configured quickly, it has context +sensitive help on each smb.conf parameter, it provides for monitoring of current state +of connection information, and it allows network wide MS Windows network password +management. +</para> + +<sect1> +<title>SWAT Features and Benefits</title> + +<para> +There are network administrators who believe that it is a good idea to write systems +documentation inside configuration files, for them SWAT will aways be a nasty tool. SWAT +does not store the configuration file in any intermediate form, rather, it stores only the +parameter settings, so when SWAT writes the smb.conf file to disk it will write only +those parameters that are at other than the default settings. The result is that all comments +will be lost from the smb.conf file. Additionally, the parameters will be written back in +internal ordering. +</para> + +<note><para> +So before using SWAT please be warned - SWAT will completely replace your smb.conf with +a fully optimised file that has been stripped of all comments you might have placed there +and only non-default settings will be written to the file. +</para></note> + +<sect2> +<title>Enabling SWAT for use</title> + +<para> +SWAT should be installed to run via the network super daemon. Depending on which system +your Unix/Linux system has you will have either an <filename>inetd</filename> or +<filename>xinetd</filename> based system. +</para> + +<para> +The nature and location of the network super-daemon varies with the operating system +implementation. The control file (or files) can be located in the file +<filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename> or in the directory <filename>/etc/[x]inet.d</filename> +or similar. +</para> + +<para> +The control entry for the older style file might be: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + # swat is the Samba Web Administration Tool + swat stream tcp nowait.400 root /usr/sbin/swat swat +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +A control file for the newer style xinetd could be: +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + # default: off + # description: SWAT is the Samba Web Admin Tool. Use swat \ + # to configure your Samba server. To use SWAT, \ + # connect to port 901 with your favorite web browser. + service swat + { + port = 901 + socket_type = stream + wait = no + only_from = localhost + user = root + server = /usr/sbin/swat + log_on_failure += USERID + disable = yes + } +</programlisting> + +</para> + +<para> +Both the above examples assume that the <filename>swat</filename> binary has been +located in the <filename>/usr/sbin</filename> directory. In addition to the above +SWAT will use a directory access point from which it will load it's help files +as well as other control information. The default location for this on most Linux +systems is in the directory <filename>/usr/share/samba/swat</filename>. The default +location using samba defaults will be <filename>/usr/local/samba/swat</filename>. +</para> + +<para> +Access to SWAT will prompt for a logon. If you log onto SWAT as any non-root user +the only permission allowed is to view certain aspects of configuration as well as +access to the password change facility. The buttons that will be exposed to the non-root +user are: <emphasis>HOME, STATUS, VIEW, PASSWORD</emphasis>. The only page that allows +change capability in this case is <emphasis>PASSWORD</emphasis>. +</para> + +<para> +So long as you log onto SWAT as the user <command>root</command> you should obtain +full change and commit ability. The buttons that will be exposed includes: +<emphasis>HOME, GLOBALS, SHARES, PRINTERS, WIZARD, STATUS, VIEW, PASSWORD</emphasis>. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Securing SWAT through SSL</title> + +<para> +Lots of people have asked about how to setup SWAT with SSL to allow for secure remote +administration of Samba. Here is a method that works, courtesy of Markus Krieger +</para> + +<para> +Modifications to the swat setup are as following: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + install OpenSSL + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + generate certificate and private key + + <programlisting> + root# /usr/bin/openssl req -new -x509 -days 365 -nodes -config \ + /usr/share/doc/packages/stunnel/stunnel.cnf \ + -out /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem -keyout /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem + </programlisting></para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + remove swat-entry from [x]inetd + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + start stunnel + + <programlisting> + root# stunnel -p /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem -d 901 \ + -l /usr/local/samba/bin/swat swat + </programlisting></para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +afterwards simply contact to swat by using the URL "https://myhost:901", accept the certificate +and the SSL connection is up. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>The SWAT Home Page</title> + +<para> +The SWAT title page provides access to the latest Samba documentation. The manual page for +each samba component is accessible from this page as are the Samba-HOWTO-Collection (this +document) as well as the O'Reilly book "Using Samba". +</para> + +<para> +Administrators who wish to validate their samba configuration may obtain useful information +from the man pages for the diganostic utilities. These are available from the SWAT home page +also. One diagnostic tool that is NOT mentioned on this page, but that is particularly +useful is <command>ethereal</command>, available from <ulink url="http://www.ethereal.com"> +http://www.ethereal.com</ulink>. +</para> + +<note><para> +SWAT can be configured to run in <emphasis>demo</emphasis> mode. This is NOT recommended +as it runs SWAT without authentication and with full administrative ability. ie: Allows +changes to smb.conf as well as general operation with root privilidges. The option that +creates this ability is the <command>-a</command> flag to swat. DO NOT USE THIS IN ANY +PRODUCTION ENVIRONMENT - you have been warned! +</para></note> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Global Settings</title> + +<para> +The Globals button will expose a page that allows configuration of the global parameters +in smb.conf. There are three levels of exposure of the parameters: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + <command>Basic</command> - exposes common configuration options. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <command>Advanced</command> - exposes configuration options needed in more + complex environments. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <command>Developer</command> - exposes configuration options that only the brave + will want to tamper with. + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +To switch to other than <emphasis>Basic</emphasis> editing ability click on either the +<emphasis>Advanced</emphasis> or the <emphasis>Developer</emphasis> dial, then click the +<emphasis>Commit Changes</emphasis> button. +</para> + +<para> +After making any changes to configuration parameters make sure that you click on the +<emphasis>Commit Changes</emphasis> button before moving to another area otherwise +your changes will be immediately lost. +</para> + +<note><para> +SWAT has context sensitive help. To find out what each parameter is for simply click the +<command>Help</command> link to the left of the configurartion parameter. +</para></note> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Share Settings</title> + +<para> +To affect a currenly configured share, simply click on the pull down button between the +<emphasis>Choose Share</emphasis> and the <emphasis>Delete Share</emphasis> buttons, +select the share you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on the +<emphasis>Choose Share</emphasis> button, to delete the share simply press the +<emphasis>Delete Share</emphasis> button. +</para> + +<para> +To create a new share, next to the button labelled <emphasis>Create Share</emphasis> enter +into the text field the name of the share to be created, then click on the +<emphasis>Create Share</emphasis> button. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Printers Settings</title> + +<para> +To affect a currenly configured printer, simply click on the pull down button between the +<emphasis>Choose Printer</emphasis> and the <emphasis>Delete Printer</emphasis> buttons, +select the printer you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on the +<emphasis>Choose Printer</emphasis> button, to delete the share simply press the +<emphasis>Delete Printer</emphasis> button. +</para> + +<para> +To create a new printer, next to the button labelled <emphasis>Create Printer</emphasis> enter +into the text field the name of the share to be created, then click on the +<emphasis>Create Printer</emphasis> button. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>The SWAT Wizard</title> + +<para> +The purpose if the SWAT Wizard is to help the Microsoft knowledgable network administrator +to configure Samba with a minimum of effort. +</para> + +<para> +The Wizard page provides a tool for rewiting the smb.conf file in fully optimised format. +This will also happen if you press the commit button. The two differ in the the rewrite button +ignores any changes that may have been made, while the Commit button causes all changes to be +affected. +</para> + +<para> +The <emphasis>Edit</emphasis> button permits the editing (setting) of the minimal set of +options that may be necessary to create a working samba server. +</para> + +<para> +Finally, there are a limited set of options that will determine what type of server samba +will be configured for, whether it will be a WINS server, participate as a WINS client, or +operate with no WINS support. By clicking on one button you can elect to epose (or not) user +home directories. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>The Status Page</title> + +<para> +The status page serves a limited purpose. Firstly, it allows control of the samba daemons. +The key daemons that create the samba server environment are: <command> smbd, nmbd, winbindd</command>. +</para> + +<para> +The daemons may be controlled individually or as a total group. Additionally, you may set +an automatic screen refresh timing. As MS Windows clients interact with Samba new smbd processes +will be continually spawned. The auto-refresh facility will allow you to track the changing +conditions with minimal effort. +</para> + +<para> +Lastly, the Status page may be used to terminate specific smbd client connections in order to +free files that may be locked. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>The View Page</title> + +<para> +This page allows the administrator to view the optimised smb.conf file and if you are +particularly massochistic will permit you also to see all possible global configuration +parameters and their settings. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>The Password Change Page</title> + +<para> +The Password Change page is a popular tool. This tool allows the creation, deletion, deactivation +and reactivation of MS Windows networking users on the local machine. Alternatively, you can use +this tool to change a local password for a user account. +</para> + +<para> +When logged in as a non-root account the user will have to provide the old password as well as +the new password (twice). When logged in as <command>root</command> only the new password is +required. +</para> + +<para> +One popular use for this tool is to change user passwords across a range of remote MS Windows +servers. +</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Samba-BDC-HOWTO.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Samba-BDC-HOWTO.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..2f3b568471f --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Samba-BDC-HOWTO.xml @@ -0,0 +1,250 @@ +<chapter id="samba-bdc"> + +<chapterinfo> + &author.vl; + <pubdate> (26 Apr 2001) </pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title> +Samba Backup Domain Controller to Samba Domain Control +</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Prerequisite Reading</title> + +<para> +Before you continue reading in this chapter, please make sure +that you are comfortable with configuring a Samba PDC +as described in the <ulink url="Samba-PDC-HOWTO.html">Samba-PDC-HOWTO</ulink>. +</para> + + +</sect1> + +<sect1> + +<title>Background</title> + +<para> +What is a Domain Controller? It is a machine that is able to answer +logon requests from workstations in a Windows NT Domain. Whenever a +user logs into a Windows NT Workstation, the workstation connects to a +Domain Controller and asks him whether the username and password the +user typed in is correct. The Domain Controller replies with a lot of +information about the user, for example the place where the users +profile is stored, the users full name of the user. All this +information is stored in the NT user database, the so-called SAM. +</para> + +<para> +There are two kinds of Domain Controller in a NT 4 compatible Domain: +A Primary Domain Controller (PDC) and one or more Backup Domain +Controllers (BDC). The PDC contains the master copy of the +SAM. Whenever the SAM has to change, for example when a user changes +his password, this change has to be done on the PDC. A Backup Domain +Controller is a machine that maintains a read-only copy of the +SAM. This way it is able to reply to logon requests and authenticate +users in case the PDC is not available. During this time no changes to +the SAM are possible. Whenever changes to the SAM are done on the PDC, +all BDC receive the changes from the PDC. +</para> + +<para> +Since version 2.2 Samba officially supports domain logons for all +current Windows Clients, including Windows 2000 and XP. This text +assumes the domain to be named SAMBA. To be able to act as a PDC, some +parameters in the [global]-section of the smb.conf have to be set: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + workgroup = SAMBA + domain master = yes + domain logons = yes +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Several other things like a [homes] and a [netlogon] share also may be +set along with settings for the profile path, the users home drive and +others. This will not be covered in this document. +</para> + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</title> + +<para> +Every machine that is a Domain Controller for the domain SAMBA has to +register the NetBIOS group name SAMBA#1c with the WINS server and/or +by broadcast on the local network. The PDC also registers the unique +NetBIOS name SAMBA#1b with the WINS server. The name type #1b is +normally reserved for the domain master browser, a role that has +nothing to do with anything related to authentication, but the +Microsoft Domain implementation requires the domain master browser to +be on the same machine as the PDC. +</para> + + +<sect2> +<title>How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</title> + +<para> +A NT workstation in the domain SAMBA that wants a local user to be +authenticated has to find the domain controller for SAMBA. It does +this by doing a NetBIOS name query for the group name SAMBA#1c. It +assumes that each of the machines it gets back from the queries is a +domain controller and can answer logon requests. To not open security +holes both the workstation and the selected (TODO: How is the DC +chosen) domain controller authenticate each other. After that the +workstation sends the user's credentials (his name and password) to +the domain controller, asking for approval. +</para> + +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title>When is the PDC needed?</title> + +<para> +Whenever a user wants to change his password, this has to be done on +the PDC. To find the PDC, the workstation does a NetBIOS name query +for SAMBA#1b, assuming this machine maintains the master copy of the +SAM. The workstation contacts the PDC, both mutually authenticate and +the password change is done. +</para> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT PDC?</title> + +<para> +With version 2.2, no. The native NT SAM replication protocols have +not yet been fully implemented. The Samba Team is working on +understanding and implementing the protocols, but this work has not +been finished for version 2.2. +</para> + +<para> +With version 3.0, the work on both the replication protocols and a +suitable storage mechanism has progressed, and some form of NT4 BDC +support is expected soon. +</para> + +<para> +Can I get the benefits of a BDC with Samba? Yes. The main reason for +implementing a BDC is availability. If the PDC is a Samba machine, +a second Samba machine can be set up to +service logon requests whenever the PDC is down. +</para> + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>How do I set up a Samba BDC?</title> + +<para> +Several things have to be done: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + +<listitem><para> +The domain SID has to be the same on the PDC and the BDC. This used to +be stored in the file private/MACHINE.SID. This file is not created +anymore since Samba 2.2.5 or even earlier. Nowadays the domain SID is +stored in the file private/secrets.tdb. Simply copying the secrets.tdb +from the PDC to the BDC does not work, as the BDC would +generate a new SID for itself and override the domain SID with this +new BDC SID.</para> + +<para> +To retrieve the domain SID from the PDC or an existing BDC and store it in the +secrets.tdb, execute 'net rpc getsid' on the BDC. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> +The Unix user database has to be synchronized from the PDC to the +BDC. This means that both the /etc/passwd and /etc/group have to be +replicated from the PDC to the BDC. This can be done manually +whenever changes are made, or the PDC is set up as a NIS master +server and the BDC as a NIS slave server. To set up the BDC as a +mere NIS client would not be enough, as the BDC would not be able to +access its user database in case of a PDC failure. +</para> +</listitem> + +<listitem><para> +The Samba password database in the file private/smbpasswd has to be +replicated from the PDC to the BDC. This is a bit tricky, see the +next section. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> +Any netlogon share has to be replicated from the PDC to the +BDC. This can be done manually whenever login scripts are changed, +or it can be done automatically together with the smbpasswd +synchronization. +</para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Finally, the BDC has to be found by the workstations. This can be done +by setting +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + workgroup = samba + domain master = no + domain logons = yes +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +in the [global]-section of the smb.conf of the BDC. This makes the BDC +only register the name SAMBA#1c with the WINS server. This is no +problem as the name SAMBA#1c is a NetBIOS group name that is meant to +be registered by more than one machine. The parameter 'domain master = +no' forces the BDC not to register SAMBA#1b which as a unique NetBIOS +name is reserved for the Primary Domain Controller. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</title> + +<para> +Replication of the smbpasswd file is sensitive. It has to be done +whenever changes to the SAM are made. Every user's password change is +done in the smbpasswd file and has to be replicated to the BDC. So +replicating the smbpasswd file very often is necessary. +</para> + +<para> +As the smbpasswd file contains plain text password equivalents, it +must not be sent unencrypted over the wire. The best way to set up +smbpasswd replication from the PDC to the BDC is to use the utility +rsync. rsync can use ssh as a transport. ssh itself can be set up to +accept *only* rsync transfer without requiring the user to type a +password. +</para> + + +</sect2> +<sect2> +<title>Can I do this all with LDAP?</title> +<para>The simple answer is YES. Samba's pdb_ldap code supports +binding to a replica LDAP server, and will also follow referrals and +rebind to the master if it ever needs to make a modification to the +database. (Normally BDCs are read only, so this will not occur +often). +</para> +</sect2> + +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Samba-PDC-HOWTO.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Samba-PDC-HOWTO.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..0189b59f2e9 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Samba-PDC-HOWTO.xml @@ -0,0 +1,842 @@ +<chapter id="samba-pdc"> + + +<chapterinfo> + &author.jerry; + &author.jht; + <author> + <firstname>David</firstname><surname>Bannon</surname> + <affiliation> + <orgname>Samba Team</orgname> + <address><email>dbannon@samba.org</email></address> + </affiliation> + </author> + <pubdate> (26 Apr 2001) </pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title> +Samba as an NT4 or Win2k Primary Domain Controller +</title> + + +<sect1> +<title>Prerequisite Reading</title> + +<para> +Before you continue reading in this chapter, please make sure +that you are comfortable with configuring basic files services +in smb.conf and how to enable and administer password +encryption in Samba. Theses two topics are covered in the +&smb.conf; manpage. +</para> + + +</sect1> + + + +<sect1> +<title> +Background +</title> + +<para> +This article outlines the steps necessary for configuring Samba as a PDC. +It is necessary to have a working Samba server prior to implementing the +PDC functionality. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + Domain logons for Windows NT 4.0 / 200x / XP Professional clients. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Placing Windows 9x / Me clients in user level security + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Retrieving a list of users and groups from a Samba PDC to + Windows 9x / Me / NT / 200x / XP Professional clients + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Roaming Profiles + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Network/System Policies + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<note> +<para> +Roaming Profiles and System/Network policies are advanced network administration topics +that are covered separately in this document. +</para> +</note> + +<para> +The following functionalities are new to the Samba 3.0 release: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + Windows NT 4 domain trusts + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Adding users via the User Manager for Domains + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +The following functionalities are NOT provided by Samba 3.0: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + SAM replication with Windows NT 4.0 Domain Controllers + (i.e. a Samba PDC and a Windows NT BDC or vice versa) + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Acting as a Windows 2000 Domain Controller (i.e. Kerberos and + Active Directory) + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Please note that Windows 9x / Me / XP Home clients are not true members of a domain +for reasons outlined in this article. Therefore the protocol for +support of Windows 9x-style domain logons is completely different +from NT4 / Win2k type domain logons and has been officially supported for some +time. +</para> + +<para><emphasis> +MS Windows XP Home edition is NOT able to join a domain and does not permit +the use of domain logons.</emphasis> +</para> + + +<para> +Implementing a Samba PDC can basically be divided into 3 broad +steps. +</para> + +<orderedlist numeration="arabic"> + <listitem><para> + Configuring the Samba PDC + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Creating machine trust accounts and joining clients to the domain + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + Adding and managing domain user accounts + </para></listitem> +</orderedlist> + +<para> +There are other minor details such as user profiles, system +policies, etc... However, these are not necessarily specific +to a Samba PDC as much as they are related to Windows NT networking +concepts. +</para> + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>Configuring the Samba Domain Controller</title> + +<para> +The first step in creating a working Samba PDC is to +understand the parameters necessary in smb.conf. Here we +attempt to explain the parameters that are covered in +the &smb.conf; man page. +</para> + +<para> +Here is an example &smb.conf; for acting as a PDC: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +[global] + ; Basic server settings + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME">netbios name</ulink> = <replaceable>POGO</replaceable> + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP">workgroup</ulink> = <replaceable>NARNIA</replaceable> + + ; User and Machine Account Backends + ; Choices are: tdbsam, tdbsam_nua, smbpasswd, smbpasswd_nua, ldapsam, ldapsam_nua, ... + ; mysqlsam, xmlsam, guest + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#PASSDBBACKEND">passdb backend</ulink> = ldapsam, guest + + ; we should act as the domain and local master browser + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#OSLEVEL">os level</ulink> = 64 + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#PERFERREDMASTER">preferred master</ulink> = yes + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINMASTER">domain master</ulink> = yes + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER">local master</ulink> = yes + + ; security settings (must user security = user) + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYEQUALSUSER">security</ulink> = user + + ; encrypted passwords are a requirement for a PDC + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">encrypt passwords</ulink> = yes + + ; support domain logons + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINLOGONS">domain logons</ulink> = yes + + ; where to store user profiles? + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONPATH">logon path</ulink> = \\%N\profiles\%u + + ; where is a user's home directory and where should it be mounted at? + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONDRIVE">logon drive</ulink> = H: + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONHOME">logon home</ulink> = \\homeserver\%u + + ; specify a generic logon script for all users + ; this is a relative **DOS** path to the [netlogon] share + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONSCRIPT">logon script</ulink> = logon.cmd + +; necessary share for domain controller +[netlogon] + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path</ulink> = /usr/local/samba/lib/netlogon + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY">read only</ulink> = yes + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#WRITELIST">write list</ulink> = <replaceable>ntadmin</replaceable> + +; share for storing user profiles +[profiles] + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#PATH">path</ulink> = /export/smb/ntprofile + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY">read only</ulink> = no + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK">create mask</ulink> = 0600 + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#DIRECTORYMASK">directory mask</ulink> = 0700 +</programlisting></para> + +<note><para> +The above parameters make for a full set of parameters that may define the server's mode +of operation. The following parameters are the essentials alone: + +<programlisting> + workgroup = NARNIA + domain logons = Yes + security = User +</programlisting> + +The additional parameters shown in the longer listing above just makes for a +more complete environment. +</para></note> + +<para> +There are a couple of points to emphasize in the above configuration. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + Encrypted passwords must be enabled. For more details on how + to do this, refer to <link linkend="passdb">the User Database chapter</link>. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + The server must support domain logons and a + <filename>[netlogon]</filename> share + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + The server must be the domain master browser in order for Windows + client to locate the server as a DC. Please refer to the various + Network Browsing documentation included with this distribution for + details. + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Samba 3.0 offers a complete implementation of group mapping +between Windows NT groups and Unix groups (this is really quite +complicated to explain in a short space). +</para> + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>Creating Machine Trust Accounts and Joining Clients to the Domain</title> + +<para> +A machine trust account is a Samba account that is used to +authenticate a client machine (rather than a user) to the Samba +server. In Windows terminology, this is known as a "Computer +Account."</para> + +<para> +The password of a machine trust account acts as the shared secret for +secure communication with the Domain Controller. This is a security +feature to prevent an unauthorized machine with the same NetBIOS name +from joining the domain and gaining access to domain user/group +accounts. Windows NT, 200x, XP Professional clients use machine trust +accounts, but Windows 9x / Me / XP Home clients do not. Hence, a +Windows 9x / Me / XP Home client is never a true member of a domain +because it does not possess a machine trust account, and thus has no +shared secret with the domain controller. +</para> + +<para>A Windows PDC stores each machine trust account in the Windows +Registry. A Samba-3 PDC also has to store machine trust account information +in a suitable backend data store. With Samba-3 there can be multiple back-ends +for this including: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + <emphasis>smbpasswd</emphasis> - the plain ascii file stored used by + earlier versions of Samba. This file configuration option requires + a Unix/Linux system account for EVERY entry (ie: both for user and for + machine accounts). This file will be located in the <emphasis>private</emphasis> + directory (default is /usr/local/samba/lib/private or on linux /etc/samba). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <emphasis>smbpasswd_nua</emphasis> - This file is independant of the + system wide user accounts. The use of this back-end option requires + specification of the "non unix account range" option also. It is called + smbpasswd and will be located in the <filename>private</filename> directory. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <emphasis>tdbsam</emphasis> - a binary database backend that will be + stored in the <emphasis>private</emphasis> directory in a file called + <emphasis>passwd.tdb</emphasis>. The key benefit of this binary format + file is that it can store binary objects that can not be accomodated + in the traditional plain text smbpasswd file. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <emphasis>tdbsam_nua</emphasis> like the smbpasswd_nua option above, this + file allows the creation of arbitrary user and machine accounts without + requiring that account to be added to the system (/etc/passwd) file. It + too requires the specification of the "non unix account range" option + in the [globals] section of the &smb.conf; file. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <emphasis>ldapsam</emphasis> - An LDAP based back-end. Permits the + LDAP server to be specified. eg: ldap://localhost or ldap://frodo.murphy.com + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> + <emphasis>ldapsam_nua</emphasis> - LDAP based back-end with no unix + account requirement, like smbpasswd_nua and tdbsam_nua above. + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para>Read the chapter about the <link linkend="passdb">User Database</link> +for details.</para> + +<note><para> +The new tdbsam and ldapsam account backends store vastly more information than +smbpasswd is capable of. The new backend database includes capacity to specify +per user settings for many parameters, over-riding global settings given in the +<filename>smb.conf</filename> file. eg: logon drive, logon home, logon path, etc. +</para></note> + +<para> +A Samba PDC, however, stores each machine trust account in two parts, +as follows: + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>A Samba account, stored in the same location as user + LanMan and NT password hashes (currently + <filename>smbpasswd</filename>). The Samba account + possesses and uses only the NT password hash.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>A corresponding Unix account, typically stored in + <filename>/etc/passwd</filename>. (Future releases will alleviate the need to + create <filename>/etc/passwd</filename> entries.) </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> +</para> + +<para> +There are two ways to create machine trust accounts: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> Manual creation. Both the Samba and corresponding + Unix account are created by hand.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para> "On-the-fly" creation. The Samba machine trust + account is automatically created by Samba at the time the client + is joined to the domain. (For security, this is the + recommended method.) The corresponding Unix account may be + created automatically or manually. </para> + </listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +<sect2> +<title>Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</title> + +<para> +The first step in manually creating a machine trust account is to +manually create the corresponding Unix account in +<filename>/etc/passwd</filename>. This can be done using +<command>vipw</command> or other 'add user' command that is normally +used to create new Unix accounts. The following is an example for a +Linux based Samba server: +</para> + +<para> + <prompt>root# </prompt><command>/usr/sbin/useradd -g 100 -d /dev/null -c <replaceable>"machine +nickname"</replaceable> -s /bin/false <replaceable>machine_name</replaceable>$ </command> +</para> +<para> +<prompt>root# </prompt><command>passwd -l <replaceable>machine_name</replaceable>$</command> +</para> + +<para>On *BSD systems, this can be done using the 'chpass' utility:</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root# </prompt><command>chpass -a "<replaceable>machine_name</replaceable>$:*:101:100::0:0:Workstation <replaceable>machine_name</replaceable>:/dev/null:/sbin/nologin"</command> +</para> + +<para> +The <filename>/etc/passwd</filename> entry will list the machine name +with a "$" appended, won't have a password, will have a null shell and no +home directory. For example a machine named 'doppy' would have an +<filename>/etc/passwd</filename> entry like this: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +doppy$:x:505:501:<replaceable>machine_nickname</replaceable>:/dev/null:/bin/false +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Above, <replaceable>machine_nickname</replaceable> can be any +descriptive name for the client, i.e., BasementComputer. +<replaceable>machine_name</replaceable> absolutely must be the NetBIOS +name of the client to be joined to the domain. The "$" must be +appended to the NetBIOS name of the client or Samba will not recognize +this as a machine trust account. +</para> + + +<para> +Now that the corresponding Unix account has been created, the next step is to create +the Samba account for the client containing the well-known initial +machine trust account password. This can be done using the <ulink +url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink> command +as shown here: +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>smbpasswd -a -m <replaceable>machine_name</replaceable></userinput> +</para> + +<para> +where <replaceable>machine_name</replaceable> is the machine's NetBIOS +name. The RID of the new machine account is generated from the UID of +the corresponding Unix account. +</para> + +<warning> + <title>Join the client to the domain immediately</title> + + <para> + Manually creating a machine trust account using this method is the + equivalent of creating a machine trust account on a Windows NT PDC using + the "Server Manager". From the time at which the account is created + to the time which the client joins the domain and changes the password, + your domain is vulnerable to an intruder joining your domain using + a machine with the same NetBIOS name. A PDC inherently trusts + members of the domain and will serve out a large degree of user + information to such clients. You have been warned! + </para> +</warning> +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title>"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</title> + +<para> +The second (and recommended) way of creating machine trust accounts is +simply to allow the Samba server to create them as needed when the client +is joined to the domain. </para> + +<para>Since each Samba machine trust account requires a corresponding +Unix account, a method for automatically creating the +Unix account is usually supplied; this requires configuration of the +<ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#ADDMACHINESCRIPT">add machine script</ulink> +option in <filename>smb.conf</filename>. This +method is not required, however; corresponding Unix accounts may also +be created manually. +</para> + + +<para>Below is an example for a RedHat 6.2 Linux system. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +[global] + # <...remainder of parameters...> + add machine script = /usr/sbin/useradd -d /dev/null -g 100 -s /bin/false -M %u +</programlisting></para> + +</sect2> + + +<sect2><title>Joining the Client to the Domain</title> + +<para> +The procedure for joining a client to the domain varies with the +version of Windows. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> +<listitem><para><emphasis>Windows 2000</emphasis></para> + + <para> + When the user elects to join the client to a domain, Windows prompts for + an account and password that is privileged to join the domain. A Samba administrative + account (i.e., a Samba account that has root privileges on the Samba server) must be + entered here; the operation will fail if an ordinary user account is given. + The password for this account should be set to a different password than the associated + <filename>/etc/passwd</filename> entry, for security reasons. + </para> + + <para> + The session key of the Samba administrative account acts as an + encryption key for setting the password of the machine trust + account. The machine trust account will be created on-the-fly, or + updated if it already exists. + </para> + +</listitem> + +<listitem><para><emphasis>Windows NT</emphasis></para> + + <para> If the machine trust account was created manually, on the + Identification Changes menu enter the domain name, but do not + check the box "Create a Computer Account in the Domain." In this case, + the existing machine trust account is used to join the machine to + the domain.</para> + + <para> If the machine trust account is to be created + on-the-fly, on the Identification Changes menu enter the domain + name, and check the box "Create a Computer Account in the Domain." In + this case, joining the domain proceeds as above for Windows 2000 + (i.e., you must supply a Samba administrative account when + prompted).</para> +</listitem> + +<listitem><para><emphasis>Samba</emphasis></para> + <para>Joining a samba client to a domain is documented in + the <link linkend="domain-member">Domain Member</link> chapter. +</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Common Problems and Errors</title> + +<sect2> +<title>I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</title> +<para> +A 'machine name' in (typically) <filename>/etc/passwd</filename> +of the machine name with a '$' appended. FreeBSD (and other BSD +systems?) won't create a user with a '$' in their name. +</para> + +<para> +The problem is only in the program used to make the entry. Once made, it works perfectly. +Create a user without the '$' using <command>vipw</command> to edit the entry, adding +the '$'. Or create the whole entry with vipw if you like, make sure you use a unique User ID! +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." +or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an +existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</title> + +<para> +This happens if you try to create a machine trust account from the +machine itself and already have a connection (e.g. mapped drive) +to a share (or IPC$) on the Samba PDC. The following command +will remove all network drive connections: +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>C:\WINNT\></prompt> <command>net use * /d</command> +</para> + +<para> +Further, if the machine is already a 'member of a workgroup' that +is the same name as the domain you are joining (bad idea) you will +get this message. Change the workgroup name to something else, it +does not matter what, reboot, and try again. +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</title> + +<para>I joined the domain successfully but after upgrading +to a newer version of the Samba code I get the message, "The system +can not log you on (C000019B), Please try again or consult your +system administrator" when attempting to logon. +</para> + +<para> +This occurs when the domain SID stored in the secrets.tdb database +is changed. The most common cause of a change in domain SID is when +the domain name and/or the server name (netbios name) is changed. +The only way to correct the problem is to restore the original domain +SID or remove the domain client from the domain and rejoin. The domain +SID may be reset using either the net or rpcclient utilities. +</para> + +<para> +The reset or change the domain SID you can use the net command as follows: + +<programlisting> + net getlocalsid 'OLDNAME' + net setlocalsid 'SID' +</programlisting> +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>The machine trust account for this computer either does not +exist or is not accessible.</title> + +<para> +When I try to join the domain I get the message "The machine account +for this computer either does not exist or is not accessible". What's +wrong? +</para> + +<para> +This problem is caused by the PDC not having a suitable machine trust account. +If you are using the <parameter>add machine script</parameter> method to create +accounts then this would indicate that it has not worked. Ensure the domain +admin user system is working. +</para> + +<para> +Alternatively if you are creating account entries manually then they +have not been created correctly. Make sure that you have the entry +correct for the machine trust account in smbpasswd file on the Samba PDC. +If you added the account using an editor rather than using the smbpasswd +utility, make sure that the account name is the machine NetBIOS name +with a '$' appended to it ( i.e. computer_name$ ). There must be an entry +in both /etc/passwd and the smbpasswd file. Some people have reported +that inconsistent subnet masks between the Samba server and the NT +client have caused this problem. Make sure that these are consistent +for both client and server. +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, +I get a message about my account being disabled.</title> + +<para> +At first be ensure to enable the useraccounts with <command>smbpasswd -e +%user%</command>, this is normally done, when you create an account. +</para> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Domain Control for Windows 9x/ME</title> + +<para> +A domain and a workgroup are exactly the same thing in terms of network +browsing. The difference is that a distributable authentication +database is associated with a domain, for secure login access to a +network. Also, different access rights can be granted to users if they +successfully authenticate against a domain logon server. Samba-3 does this +now in the same way that MS Windows NT/2K. +</para> + +<para> +The SMB client logging on to a domain has an expectation that every other +server in the domain should accept the same authentication information. +Network browsing functionality of domains and workgroups is identical and +is explained in this documentation under the browsing discussions. +It should be noted, that browsing is totally orthogonal to logon support. +</para> + +<para> +Issues related to the single-logon network model are discussed in this +section. Samba supports domain logons, network logon scripts, and user +profiles for MS Windows for workgroups and MS Windows 9X/ME clients +which are the focus of this section. +</para> + + +<para> +When an SMB client in a domain wishes to logon it broadcast requests for a +logon server. The first one to reply gets the job, and validates its +password using whatever mechanism the Samba administrator has installed. +It is possible (but very stupid) to create a domain where the user +database is not shared between servers, i.e. they are effectively workgroup +servers advertising themselves as participating in a domain. This +demonstrates how authentication is quite different from but closely +involved with domains. +</para> + + +<para> +Using these features you can make your clients verify their logon via +the Samba server; make clients run a batch file when they logon to +the network and download their preferences, desktop and start menu. +</para> + +<para> +Before launching into the configuration instructions, it is +worthwhile to look at how a Windows 9x/ME client performs a logon: +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem> + <para> + The client broadcasts (to the IP broadcast address of the subnet it is in) + a NetLogon request. This is sent to the NetBIOS name DOMAIN<1c> at the + NetBIOS layer. The client chooses the first response it receives, which + contains the NetBIOS name of the logon server to use in the format of + \\SERVER. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + The client then connects to that server, logs on (does an SMBsessetupX) and + then connects to the IPC$ share (using an SMBtconX). + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + The client then does a NetWkstaUserLogon request, which retrieves the name + of the user's logon script. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + The client then connects to the NetLogon share and searches for this + and if it is found and can be read, is retrieved and executed by the client. + After this, the client disconnects from the NetLogon share. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + The client then sends a NetUserGetInfo request to the server, to retrieve + the user's home share, which is used to search for profiles. Since the + response to the NetUserGetInfo request does not contain much more then + the user's home share, profiles for Win9X clients MUST reside in the user + home directory. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + The client then connects to the user's home share and searches for the + user's profile. As it turns out, you can specify the user's home share as + a sharename and path. For example, \\server\fred\.profile. + If the profiles are found, they are implemented. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + The client then disconnects from the user's home share, and reconnects to + the NetLogon share and looks for CONFIG.POL, the policies file. If this is + found, it is read and implemented. + </para> +</listitem> +</orderedlist> + + +<sect2> +<title>Configuration Instructions: Network Logons</title> + +<para> +The main difference between a PDC and a Windows 9x logon +server configuration is that +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + +<listitem><para> +Password encryption is not required for a Windows 9x logon server. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> +Windows 9x/ME clients do not possess machine trust accounts. +</para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Therefore, a Samba PDC will also act as a Windows 9x logon +server. +</para> + + +<warning> +<title>security mode and master browsers</title> + +<para> +There are a few comments to make in order to tie up some +loose ends. There has been much debate over the issue of whether +or not it is ok to configure Samba as a Domain Controller in security +modes other than <constant>USER</constant>. The only security mode +which will not work due to technical reasons is <constant>SHARE</constant> +mode security. <constant>DOMAIN</constant> and <constant>SERVER</constant> +mode security is really just a variation on SMB user level security. +</para> + +<para> +Actually, this issue is also closely tied to the debate on whether +or not Samba must be the domain master browser for its workgroup +when operating as a DC. While it may technically be possible +to configure a server as such (after all, browsing and domain logons +are two distinctly different functions), it is not a good idea to do +so. You should remember that the DC must register the DOMAIN#1b NetBIOS +name. This is the name used by Windows clients to locate the DC. +Windows clients do not distinguish between the DC and the DMB. +For this reason, it is very wise to configure the Samba DC as the DMB. +</para> + +<para> +Now back to the issue of configuring a Samba DC to use a mode other +than "security = user". If a Samba host is configured to use +another SMB server or DC in order to validate user connection +requests, then it is a fact that some other machine on the network +(the "password server") knows more about the user than the Samba host. +99% of the time, this other host is a domain controller. Now +in order to operate in domain mode security, the "workgroup" parameter +must be set to the name of the Windows NT domain (which already +has a domain controller, right?) +</para> + +<para> +Therefore configuring a Samba box as a DC for a domain that +already by definition has a PDC is asking for trouble. +Therefore, you should always configure the Samba DC to be the DMB +for its domain. +</para> +</warning> + +</sect2> +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/ServerType.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/ServerType.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..7229a50201c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/ServerType.xml @@ -0,0 +1,143 @@ +<chapter id="ServerType"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jht; +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Nomenclature of Server Types</title> + +<para>Adminstrators of Microsoft networks often refer to there being three +different type of servers:</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Stand Alone Server</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Domain Member Server</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Domain Controller</para> + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Primary Domain Controller</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>Backup Domain Controller</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>ADS Domain Controller</para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para>A network administrator who is familiar with these terms and who +wishes to migrate to or use Samba will want to know what these terms mean +within a Samba context.</para> + +<sect1> +<title>Stand Alone Server</title> + +<para> +The term <emphasis>stand alone server</emphasis> means that the server +will provide local authentication and access control for all resources +that are available from it. In general this means that there will be a +local user database. In more technical terms, it means that resources +on the machine will either be made available in either SHARE mode or in +USER mode. SHARE mode and USER mode security are documented under +discussions regarding "security mode". The smb.conf configuration parameters +that control security mode are: "security = user" and "security = share". +</para> + +<para> +No special action is needed other than to create user accounts. Stand-alone +servers do NOT provide network logon services, meaning that machines that +use this server do NOT perform a domain logon but instead make use only of +the MS Windows logon which is local to the MS Windows workstation/server. +</para> + +<para> +Samba tends to blur the distinction a little in respect of what is +a stand alone server. This is because the authentication database may be +local or on a remote server, even if from the samba protocol perspective +the samba server is NOT a member of a domain security context. +</para> + +<para> +Through the use of PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) and nsswitch +(the name service switcher) the source of authentication may reside on +another server. We would be inclined to call this the authentication server. +This means that the samba server may use the local Unix/Linux system +password database (/etc/passwd or /etc/shadow), may use a local smbpasswd +file (/etc/samba/smbpasswd or /usr/local/samba/lib/private/smbpasswd), or +may use an LDAP back end, or even via PAM and Winbind another CIFS/SMB +server for authentication. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Domain Member Server</title> + +<para> +This mode of server operation involves the samba machine being made a member +of a domain security context. This means by definition that all user authentication +will be done from a centrally defined authentication regime. The authentication +regime may come from an NT3/4 style (old domain technology) server, or it may be +provided from an Active Directory server (ADS) running on MS Windows 2000 or later. +</para> + +<para><emphasis> +Of course it should be clear that the authentication back end itself could be from any +distributed directory architecture server that is supported by Samba. This can be +LDAP (from OpenLDAP), or Sun's iPlanet, of NetWare Directory Server, etc. +</emphasis></para> + +<para> +Please refer to the section on Howto configure Samba as a Primary Domain Controller +and for more information regarding how to create a domain machine account for a +domain member server as well as for information regarding how to enable the samba +domain member machine to join the domain and to be fully trusted by it. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Domain Controller</title> + +<para> +Over the years public perceptions of what Domain Control really is has taken on an +almost mystical nature. Before we branch into a brief overview of what Domain Control +is the following types of controller are known: +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Domain Controller Types</title> + +<simplelist> + <member>Primary Domain Controller</member> + <member>Backup Domain Controller</member> + <member>ADS Domain Controller</member> +</simplelist> + +<para> +The <emphasis>Primary Domain Controller</emphasis> or PDC plays an important role in the MS +Windows NT3 and NT4 Domain Control architecture, but not in the manner that so many +expect. The PDC seeds the Domain Control database (a part of the Windows registry) and +it plays a key part in synchronisation of the domain authentication database. +</para> + +<para> +New to Samba-3.0.0 is the ability to use a back-end file that holds the same type of data as +the NT4 style SAM (Security Account Manager) database (one of the registry files). +The samba-3.0.0 SAM can be specified via the smb.conf file parameter "passwd backend" and +valid options include <emphasis> smbpasswd tdbsam ldapsam nisplussam plugin unixsam</emphasis>. +The smbpasswd, tdbsam and ldapsam options can have a "_nua" suffix to indicate that No Unix +Accounts need to be created. In other words, the Samba SAM will be independant of Unix/Linux +system accounts, provided a uid range is defined from which SAM accounts can be created. +</para> + +<para> +The <emphasis>Backup Domain Controller</emphasis> or BDC plays a key role in servicing network +authentication requests. The BDC is biased to answer logon requests so that on a network segment +that has a BDC and a PDC the BDC will be most likely to service network logon requests. The PDC will +answer network logon requests when the BDC is too busy (high load). A BDC can be promoted to +a PDC. If the PDC is on line at the time that the BDC is promoted to PDC the previous PDC is +automatically demoted to a BDC. +</para> + +<para> +At this time Samba is NOT capable of acting as an <emphasis>ADS Domain Controller</emphasis>. +</para> +</sect2> +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/Speed.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Speed.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..2509883916c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/Speed.xml @@ -0,0 +1,211 @@ +<chapter id="speed"> + +<chapterinfo> + <author> + <firstname>Paul</firstname><surname>Cochrane</surname> + <affiliation> + <orgname>Dundee Limb Fitting Centre</orgname> + <address><email>paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</email></address> + </affiliation> + </author> + &author.jelmer; +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Samba performance issues</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Comparisons</title> + +<para> +The Samba server uses TCP to talk to the client. Thus if you are +trying to see if it performs well you should really compare it to +programs that use the same protocol. The most readily available +programs for file transfer that use TCP are ftp or another TCP based +SMB server. +</para> + +<para> +If you want to test against something like a NT or WfWg server then +you will have to disable all but TCP on either the client or +server. Otherwise you may well be using a totally different protocol +(such as Netbeui) and comparisons may not be valid. +</para> + +<para> +Generally you should find that Samba performs similarly to ftp at raw +transfer speed. It should perform quite a bit faster than NFS, +although this very much depends on your system. +</para> + +<para> +Several people have done comparisons between Samba and Novell, NFS or +WinNT. In some cases Samba performed the best, in others the worst. I +suspect the biggest factor is not Samba vs some other system but the +hardware and drivers used on the various systems. Given similar +hardware Samba should certainly be competitive in speed with other +systems. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Socket options</title> + +<para> +There are a number of socket options that can greatly affect the +performance of a TCP based server like Samba. +</para> + +<para> +The socket options that Samba uses are settable both on the command +line with the -O option, or in the smb.conf file. +</para> + +<para> +The <command>socket options</command> section of the &smb.conf; manual page describes how +to set these and gives recommendations. +</para> + +<para> +Getting the socket options right can make a big difference to your +performance, but getting them wrong can degrade it by just as +much. The correct settings are very dependent on your local network. +</para> + +<para> +The socket option TCP_NODELAY is the one that seems to make the +biggest single difference for most networks. Many people report that +adding <command>socket options = TCP_NODELAY</command> doubles the read +performance of a Samba drive. The best explanation I have seen for this is +that the Microsoft TCP/IP stack is slow in sending tcp ACKs. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Read size</title> + +<para> +The option <command>read size</command> affects the overlap of disk +reads/writes with network reads/writes. If the amount of data being +transferred in several of the SMB commands (currently SMBwrite, SMBwriteX and +SMBreadbraw) is larger than this value then the server begins writing +the data before it has received the whole packet from the network, or +in the case of SMBreadbraw, it begins writing to the network before +all the data has been read from disk. +</para> + +<para> +This overlapping works best when the speeds of disk and network access +are similar, having very little effect when the speed of one is much +greater than the other. +</para> + +<para> +The default value is 16384, but very little experimentation has been +done yet to determine the optimal value, and it is likely that the best +value will vary greatly between systems anyway. A value over 65536 is +pointless and will cause you to allocate memory unnecessarily. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Max xmit</title> + +<para> +At startup the client and server negotiate a <command>maximum transmit</command> size, +which limits the size of nearly all SMB commands. You can set the +maximum size that Samba will negotiate using the <command>max xmit = </command> option +in &smb.conf;. Note that this is the maximum size of SMB requests that +Samba will accept, but not the maximum size that the *client* will accept. +The client maximum receive size is sent to Samba by the client and Samba +honours this limit. +</para> + +<para> +It defaults to 65536 bytes (the maximum), but it is possible that some +clients may perform better with a smaller transmit unit. Trying values +of less than 2048 is likely to cause severe problems. +</para> + +<para> +In most cases the default is the best option. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Log level</title> + +<para> +If you set the log level (also known as <command>debug level</command>) higher than 2 +then you may suffer a large drop in performance. This is because the +server flushes the log file after each operation, which can be very +expensive. +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Read raw</title> + +<para> +The <command>read raw</command> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency +file read operation. A server may choose to not support it, +however. and Samba makes support for <command>read raw</command> optional, with it +being enabled by default. +</para> + +<para> +In some cases clients don't handle <command>read raw</command> very well and actually +get lower performance using it than they get using the conventional +read operations. +</para> + +<para> +So you might like to try <command>read raw = no</command> and see what happens on your +network. It might lower, raise or not affect your performance. Only +testing can really tell. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Write raw</title> + +<para> +The <command>write raw</command> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency +file write operation. A server may choose to not support it, +however. and Samba makes support for <command>write raw</command> optional, with it +being enabled by default. +</para> + +<para> +Some machines may find <command>write raw</command> slower than normal write, in which +case you may wish to change this option. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Slow Logins</title> + +<para> +Slow logins are almost always due to the password checking time. Using +the lowest practical <command>password level</command> will improve things. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Client tuning</title> + +<para> +Often a speed problem can be traced to the client. The client (for +example Windows for Workgroups) can often be tuned for better TCP +performance. Check the sections on the various clients in +<link linkend="Other-Clients">Samba and Other Clients</link>. +</para> + +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/UNIX_INSTALL.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/UNIX_INSTALL.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..3ad83c1f9df --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/UNIX_INSTALL.xml @@ -0,0 +1,176 @@ +<chapter id="install"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.tridge; + &author.jelmer; + <author><firstname>Karl</firstname><surname>Auer</surname></author> + <!-- Isn't some of this written by others as well? --> + +</chapterinfo> + +<title>How to Install and Test SAMBA</title> + +<sect1> + <title>Obtaining and installing samba</title> + + <para>Binary packages of samba are included in almost any Linux or + Unix distribution. There are also some packages available at + <ulink url="http://samba.org/">the samba homepage</ulink>. + </para> + + <para>If you need to compile samba from source, check the + <link linkend="compiling">appropriate appendix chapter</link>.</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Configuring samba</title> + + <para>Samba's configuration is stored in the smb.conf file, + that usually resides in <filename>/etc/samba/smb.conf</filename> + or <filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename>. You can either + edit this file yourself or do it using one of the many graphical + tools that are available, such as the web-based interface swat, that + is included with samba.</para> + +<sect2> + <title>Editing the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file</title> + + <para>There are sample configuration files in the examples + subdirectory in the distribution. I suggest you read them + carefully so you can see how the options go together in + practice. See the man page for all the options.</para> + + <para>The simplest useful configuration file would be + something like this:</para> + + <para><programlisting> +[global] + workgroup = MYGROUP + +[homes] + guest ok = no + read only = no + </programlisting></para> + + <para>which would allow connections by anyone with an + account on the server, using either their login name or + "<command>homes</command>" as the service name. (Note that I also set the + workgroup that Samba is part of. See BROWSING.txt for details)</para> + + <para>Make sure you put the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file in the same place + you specified in the<filename>Makefile</filename> (the default is to + look for it in <filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/</filename>).</para> + + <para>For more information about security settings for the + <command>[homes]</command> share please refer to the chapter + <link linkend="securing-samba">Securing Samba</link>.</para> + +<sect3> + <title>Test your config file with + <command>testparm</command></title> + + <para>It's important that you test the validity of your + <filename>smb.conf</filename> file using the <application>testparm</application> program. + If testparm runs OK then it will list the loaded services. If + not it will give an error message.</para> + + <para>Make sure it runs OK and that the services look + reasonable before proceeding. </para> + + <para>Always run testparm again when you change + <filename>smb.conf</filename>!</para> + +</sect3> +</sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>SWAT</title> + + <para> + SWAT is a web-based interface that helps you configure samba. + SWAT might not be available in the samba package on your platform, + but in a separate package. Please read the swat manpage + on compiling, installing and configuring swat from source. + </para> + + <para>To launch SWAT just run your favorite web browser and + point it at "http://localhost:901/". Replace <replaceable>localhost</replaceable> with the name of the computer you are running samba on if you + are running samba on a different computer than your browser.</para> + + <para>Note that you can attach to SWAT from any IP connected + machine but connecting from a remote machine leaves your + connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent + in the clear over the wire. </para> + </sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Try listing the shares available on your + server</title> + + <para><prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>smbclient -L + <replaceable>yourhostname</replaceable></userinput></para> + + <para>You should get back a list of shares available on + your server. If you don't then something is incorrectly setup. + Note that this method can also be used to see what shares + are available on other LanManager clients (such as WfWg).</para> + + <para>If you choose user level security then you may find + that Samba requests a password before it will list the shares. + See the <command>smbclient</command> man page for details. (you + can force it to list the shares without a password by + adding the option -U% to the command line. This will not work + with non-Samba servers)</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Try connecting with the unix client</title> + + <para><prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>smbclient <replaceable> + //yourhostname/aservice</replaceable></userinput></para> + + <para>Typically the <replaceable>yourhostname</replaceable> + would be the name of the host where you installed &smbd;. + The <replaceable>aservice</replaceable> is + any service you have defined in the &smb.conf; + file. Try your user name if you just have a <command>[homes]</command> + section + in &smb.conf;.</para> + + <para>For example if your unix host is <replaceable>bambi</replaceable> + and your login name is <replaceable>fred</replaceable> you would type:</para> + + <para><prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>smbclient //<replaceable>bambi</replaceable>/<replaceable>fred</replaceable> + </userinput></para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT, + Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</title> + + <para>Try mounting disks. eg:</para> + + <para><prompt>C:\WINDOWS\> </prompt><userinput>net use d: \\servername\service + </userinput></para> + + <para>Try printing. eg:</para> + + <para><prompt>C:\WINDOWS\> </prompt><userinput>net use lpt1: + \\servername\spoolservice</userinput></para> + + <para><prompt>C:\WINDOWS\> </prompt><userinput>print filename + </userinput></para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>What If Things Don't Work?</title> + + <para>Then you might read the file chapter + <link linkend="diagnosis">Diagnosis</link> and the + FAQ. If you are still stuck then try to follow + the <link linkend="problems">Analysing and Solving Problems chapter</link> + Samba has been successfully installed at thousands of sites worldwide, + so maybe someone else has hit your problem and has overcome it. </para> + +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/VFS.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/VFS.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..225411b4274 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/VFS.xml @@ -0,0 +1,230 @@ +<chapter id="VFS"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jelmer; + &author.jht; + <author><firstname>Alexander</firstname><surname>Bokovoy</surname></author> + <author><firstname>Tim</firstname><surname>Potter</surname></author> + <author><firstname>Simo</firstname><surname>Sorce</surname></author> +</chapterinfo> +<title>Stackable VFS modules</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Introduction and configuration</title> + +<para> +Since samba 3.0, samba supports stackable VFS(Virtual File System) modules. +Samba passes each request to access the unix file system thru the loaded VFS modules. +This chapter covers all the modules that come with the samba source and references to +some external modules. +</para> + +<para> +You may have problems to compile these modules, as shared libraries are +compiled and linked in different ways on different systems. +They currently have been tested against GNU/linux and IRIX. +</para> + +<para> +To use the VFS modules, create a share similar to the one below. The +important parameter is the <command>vfs object</command> parameter which must point to +the exact pathname of the shared library objects. For example, to log all access +to files and use a recycle bin: + +<programlisting> + [audit] + comment = Audited /data directory + path = /data + vfs object = /path/to/audit.so /path/to/recycle.so + writeable = yes + browseable = yes +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +The modules are used in the order they are specified. +</para> + +<para> +Further documentation on writing VFS modules for Samba can be found in +the Samba Developers Guide. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Included modules</title> + +<sect2> +<title>audit</title> +<para>A simple module to audit file access to the syslog +facility. The following operations are logged: +<simplelist> +<member>share</member> +<member>connect/disconnect</member> +<member>directory opens/create/remove</member> +<member>file open/close/rename/unlink/chmod</member> +</simplelist> +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>extd_audit</title> +<para> +This module is identical with the <emphasis>audit</emphasis> module above except +that it sends audit logs to both syslog as well as the smbd log file/s. The +loglevel for this module is set in the smb.conf file. +</para> + +<para> +The logging information that will be written to the smbd log file is controlled by +the <emphasis>log level</emphasis> parameter in <filename>smb.conf</filename>. The +following information will be recorded: +</para> + +<table frame="all"><title>Extended Auditing Log Information</title> +<tgroup cols="2" align="center"> + <thead> + <row><entry align="center">Log Level</entry><entry>Log Details - File and Directory Operations</entry></row> + </thead> + <tbody> + <row><entry align="center">0</entry><entry align="left">Creation / Deletion</entry></row> + <row><entry align="center">1</entry><entry align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Permission Changes</entry></row> + <row><entry align="center">2</entry><entry align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Perm Change / Open / Close</entry></row> + </tbody> +</tgroup> +</table> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>recycle</title> +<para> +A recycle-bin like module. When used any unlink call +will be intercepted and files moved to the recycle +directory instead of being deleted. +</para> + +<para>Supported options: +<variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>vfs_recycle_bin:repository</term> + <listitem><para>FIXME</para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>vfs_recycle_bin:keeptree</term> + <listitem><para>FIXME</para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>vfs_recycle_bin:versions</term> + <listitem><para>FIXME</para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>vfs_recycle_bin:touch</term> + <listitem><para>FIXME</para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>vfs_recycle_bin:maxsize</term> + <listitem><para>FIXME</para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>vfs_recycle_bin:exclude</term> + <listitem><para>FIXME</para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>vfs_recycle_bin:exclude_dir</term> + <listitem><para>FIXME</para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>vfs_recycle_bin:noversions</term> + <listitem><para>FIXME</para></listitem> + </varlistentry> +</variablelist> +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>netatalk</title> +<para> +A netatalk module, that will ease co-existence of samba and +netatalk file sharing services. +</para> + +<para>Advantages compared to the old netatalk module: +<simplelist> +<member>it doesn't care about creating of .AppleDouble forks, just keeps them in sync</member> +<member>if share in smb.conf doesn't contain .AppleDouble item in hide or veto list, it will be added automatically</member> +</simplelist> +</para> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>VFS modules available elsewhere</title> + +<para> +This section contains a listing of various other VFS modules that +have been posted but don't currently reside in the Samba CVS +tree for one reason or another (e.g. it is easy for the maintainer +to have his or her own CVS tree). +</para> + +<para> +No statemets about the stability or functionality of any module +should be implied due to its presence here. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>DatabaseFS</title> + +<para> +URL: <ulink url="http://www.css.tayloru.edu/~elorimer/databasefs/index.php">http://www.css.tayloru.edu/~elorimer/databasefs/index.php</ulink> +</para> + +<para>By <ulink url="mailto:elorimer@css.tayloru.edu">Eric Lorimer</ulink>.</para> + +<para> +I have created a VFS module which implements a fairly complete read-only +filesystem. It presents information from a database as a filesystem in +a modular and generic way to allow different databases to be used +(originally designed for organizing MP3s under directories such as +"Artists," "Song Keywords," etc... I have since applied it to a student +roster database very easily). The directory structure is stored in the +database itself and the module makes no assumptions about the database +structure beyond the table it requires to run. +</para> + +<para> +Any feedback would be appreciated: comments, suggestions, patches, +etc... If nothing else, hopefully it might prove useful for someone +else who wishes to create a virtual filesystem. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>vscan</title> +<para>URL: <ulink url="http://www.openantivirus.org/">http://www.openantivirus.org/</ulink></para> + +<para> +samba-vscan is a proof-of-concept module for Samba, which +uses the VFS (virtual file system) features of Samba 2.2.x/3.0 +alphaX. Of couse, Samba has to be compiled with VFS support. +samba-vscan supports various virus scanners and is maintained +by Rainer Link. +</para> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/locking.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/locking.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..adb4356497f --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/locking.xml @@ -0,0 +1,396 @@ +<chapter id="locking"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jeremy; + &author.jelmer; + &author.jht; +</chapterinfo> +<title>File and Record Locking</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Discussion</title> + +<para> +One area which sometimes causes trouble is locking. +</para> + +<para> +There are two types of locking which need to be performed by a SMB server. +The first is <emphasis>record locking</emphasis> which allows a client to lock +a range of bytes in a open file. The second is the <emphasis>deny modes</emphasis> +that are specified when a file is open. +</para> + +<para> +Record locking semantics under Unix is very different from record locking under +Windows. Versions of Samba before 2.2 have tried to use the native fcntl() unix +system call to implement proper record locking between different Samba clients. +This can not be fully correct due to several reasons. The simplest is the fact +that a Windows client is allowed to lock a byte range up to 2^32 or 2^64, +depending on the client OS. The unix locking only supports byte ranges up to 2^31. +So it is not possible to correctly satisfy a lock request above 2^31. There are +many more differences, too many to be listed here. +</para> + +<para> +Samba 2.2 and above implements record locking completely independent of the +underlying unix system. If a byte range lock that the client requests happens +to fall into the range 0-2^31, Samba hands this request down to the Unix system. +All other locks can not be seen by unix anyway. +</para> + +<para> +Strictly a SMB server should check for locks before every read and write call on +a file. Unfortunately with the way fcntl() works this can be slow and may overstress +the rpc.lockd. It is also almost always unnecessary as clients are supposed to +independently make locking calls before reads and writes anyway if locking is +important to them. By default Samba only makes locking calls when explicitly asked +to by a client, but if you set <emphasis>strict locking = yes</emphasis> then it +will make lock checking calls on every read and write. +</para> + +<para> +You can also disable by range locking completely using <emphasis>locking = no</emphasis>. +This is useful for those shares that don't support locking or don't need it +(such as cdroms). In this case Samba fakes the return codes of locking calls to +tell clients that everything is OK. +</para> + +<para> +The second class of locking is the <emphasis>deny modes</emphasis>. These +are set by an application when it opens a file to determine what types of +access should be allowed simultaneously with its open. A client may ask for +DENY_NONE, DENY_READ, DENY_WRITE or DENY_ALL. There are also special compatibility +modes called DENY_FCB and DENY_DOS. +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</title> + +<para> +Opportunistic locking essentially means that the client is allowed to download and cache +a file on their hard drive while making changes; if a second client wants to access the +file, the first client receives a break and must synchronise the file back to the server. +This can give significant performance gains in some cases; some programs insist on +synchronising the contents of the entire file back to the server for a single change. +</para> + +<para> +Level1 Oplocks (aka just plain "oplocks") is another term for opportunistic locking. +</para> + +<para> +Level2 Oplocks provids opportunistic locking for a file that will be treated as +<emphasis>read only</emphasis>. Typically this is used on files that are read-only or +on files that the client has no initial intention to write to at time of opening the file. +</para> + +<para> +Kernel Oplocks are essentially a method that allows the Linux kernel to co-exist with +Samba's oplocked files, although this has provided better integration of MS Windows network +file locking with the under lying OS, SGI IRIX and Linux are the only two OS's that are +oplock aware at this time. +</para> + +<para> +Unless your system supports kernel oplocks, you should disable oplocks if you are +accessing the same files from both Unix/Linux and SMB clients. Regardless, oplocks should +always be disabled if you are sharing a database file (e.g., Microsoft Access) between +multiple clients, as any break the first client receives will affect synchronisation of +the entire file (not just the single record), which will result in a noticable performance +impairment and, more likely, problems accessing the database in the first place. Notably, +Microsoft Outlook's personal folders (*.pst) react very badly to oplocks. If in doubt, +disable oplocks and tune your system from that point. +</para> + +<para> +If client-side caching is desirable and reliable on your network, you will benefit from +turning on oplocks. If your network is slow and/or unreliable, or you are sharing your +files among other file sharing mechanisms (e.g., NFS) or across a WAN, or multiple people +will be accessing the same files frequently, you probably will not benefit from the overhead +of your client sending oplock breaks and will instead want to disable oplocks for the share. +</para> + +<para> +Another factor to consider is the perceived performance of file access. If oplocks provide no +measurable speed benefit on your network, it might not be worth the hassle of dealing with them. +</para> + +<para> +You can disable oplocks on a per-share basis with the following: + +<programlisting> + oplocks = False + level2 oplocks = False +</programlisting> + +Alternately, you could disable oplocks on a per-file basis within the share: + +<programlisting> + veto oplock files = /*.mdb/*.MDB/*.dbf/*.DBF/ +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para> +If you are experiencing problems with oplocks as apparent from Samba's log entries, +you may want to play it safe and disable oplocks and level2 oplocks. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</title> + +<para> +There is a known issue when running applications (like Norton Anti-Virus) on a Windows 2000/ XP +workstation computer that can affect any application attempting to access shared database files +across a network. This is a result of a default setting configured in the Windows 2000/XP +operating system known as <emphasis>Opportunistic Locking</emphasis>. When a workstation +attempts to access shared data files located on another Windows 2000/XP computer, +the Windows 2000/XP operating system will attempt to increase performance by locking the +files and caching information locally. When this occurs, the application is unable to +properly function, which results in an <emphasis>Access Denied</emphasis> + error message being displayed during network operations. +</para> + +<para> +All Windows operating systems in the NT family that act as database servers for data files +(meaning that data files are stored there and accessed by other Windows PCs) may need to +have opportunistic locking disabled in order to minimize the risk of data file corruption. +This includes Windows 9x/Me, Windows NT, Windows 200x and Windows XP. +</para> + +<para> +If you are using a Windows NT family workstation in place of a server, you must also +disable opportunistic locking (oplocks) on that workstation. For example, if you use a +PC with the Windows NT Workstation operating system instead of Windows NT Server, and you +have data files located on it that are accessed from other Windows PCs, you may need to +disable oplocks on that system. +</para> + +<para> +The major difference is the location in the Windows registry where the values for disabling +oplocks are entered. Instead of the LanManServer location, the LanManWorkstation location +may be used. +</para> + +<para> +You can verify (or change or add, if necessary) this Registry value using the Windows +Registry Editor. When you change this registry value, you will have to reboot the PC +to ensure that the new setting goes into effect. +</para> + +<para> +The location of the client registry entry for opportunistic locking has changed in +Windows 2000 from the earlier location in Microsoft Windows NT. +</para> + +<note><para> +Windows 2000 will still respect the EnableOplocks registry value used to disable oplocks +in earlier versions of Windows. +</para></note> + +<para> +You can also deny the granting of opportunistic locks by changing the following registry entries: +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\CurrentControlSet\Services\MRXSmb\Parameters\ + + OplocksDisabled REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 0 (not disabled) +</programlisting> +</para> + +<note><para> +The OplocksDisabled registry value configures Windows clients to either request or not +request opportunistic locks on a remote file. To disable oplocks, the value of + OplocksDisabled must be set to 1. +</para></note> + +<para> +<programlisting> + HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanServer\Parameters + + EnableOplocks REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 1 (Enabled by Default) + + EnableOpLockForceClose REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 0 (Disabled by Default) +</programlisting> +</para> + +<note><para> +The EnableOplocks value configures Windows-based servers (including Workstations sharing +files) to allow or deny opportunistic locks on local files. +</para></note> + +<para> +To force closure of open oplocks on close or program exit EnableOpLockForceClose must be set to 1. +</para> + +<para> +An illustration of how level II oplocks work: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para> + Station 1 opens the file, requesting oplock. + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + Since no other station has the file open, the server grants station 1 exclusive oplock. + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + Station 2 opens the file, requesting oplock. + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + Since station 1 has not yet written to the file, the server asks station 1 to Break + to Level II Oplock. + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + Station 1 complies by flushing locally buffered lock information to the server. + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + Station 1 informs the server that it has Broken to Level II Oplock (alternatively, + station 1 could have closed the file). + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + The server responds to station 2's open request, granting it level II oplock. + Other stations can likewise open the file and obtain level II oplock. + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + Station 2 (or any station that has the file open) sends a write request SMB. + The server returns the write response. + </para></listitem> + <listitem><para> + The server asks all stations that have the file open to Break to None, meaning no + station holds any oplock on the file. Because the workstations can have no cached + writes or locks at this point, they need not respond to the break-to-none advisory; + all they need do is invalidate locally cashed read-ahead data. + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<sect2> +<title>Workstation Service Entries</title> + +<para><programlisting> + \HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanWorkstation\Parameters + + UseOpportunisticLocking REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 1 (true) +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Indicates whether the redirector should use opportunistic-locking (oplock) performance +enhancement. This parameter should be disabled only to isolate problems. +</para> + +</sect2> +<sect2> +<title>Server Service Entries</title> + +<para><programlisting> + \HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanServer\Parameters + + EnableOplocks REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 1 (true) +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Specifies whether the server allows clients to use oplocks on files. Oplocks are a +significant performance enhancement, but have the potential to cause lost cached +data on some networks, particularly wide-area networks. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + MinLinkThroughput REG_DWORD 0 to infinite bytes per second + Default: 0 +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Specifies the minimum link throughput allowed by the server before it disables +raw and opportunistic locks for this connection. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + MaxLinkDelay REG_DWORD 0 to 100,000 seconds + Default: 60 +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Specifies the maximum time allowed for a link delay. If delays exceed this number, +the server disables raw I/O and opportunistic locking for this connection. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + OplockBreakWait REG_DWORD 10 to 180 seconds + Default: 35 +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Specifies the time that the server waits for a client to respond to an oplock break +request. Smaller values can allow detection of crashed clients more quickly but can +potentially cause loss of cached data. +</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Persistent Data Corruption</title> + +<para> +If you have applied all of the settings discussed in this paper but data corruption problems +and other symptoms persist, here are some additional things to check out: +</para> + +<para> +We have credible reports from developers that faulty network hardware, such as a single +faulty network card, can cause symptoms similar to read caching and data corruption. +If you see persistent data corruption even after repeated reindexing, you may have to +rebuild the data files in question. This involves creating a new data file with the +same definition as the file to be rebuilt and transferring the data from the old file +to the new one. There are several known methods for doing this that can be found in +our Knowledge Base. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Additional Reading</title> + +<para> +You may want to check for an updated version of this white paper on our Web site from +time to time. Many of our white papers are updated as information changes. For those papers, +the Last Edited date is always at the top of the paper. +</para> + +<para> +Section of the Microsoft MSDN Library on opportunistic locking: +</para> + +<para> +Opportunistic Locks, Microsoft Developer Network (MSDN), Windows Development > +Windows Base Services > Files and I/O > SDK Documentation > File Storage > File Systems +> About File Systems > Opportunistic Locks, Microsoft Corporation. +<ulink url="http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/fileio/storage_5yk3.asp">http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/fileio/storage_5yk3.asp</ulink> +</para> + +<para> +Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q224992 "Maintaining Transactional Integrity with OPLOCKS", +Microsoft Corporation, April 1999, <ulink url="=http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q224992">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q224992</ulink>. +</para> + +<para> +Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q296264 "Configuring Opportunistic Locking in Windows 2000", +Microsoft Corporation, April 2001, <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q296264">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q296264</ulink>. +</para> + +<para> +Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q129202 "PC Ext: Explanation of Opportunistic Locking on Windows NT", + Microsoft Corporation, April 1995, <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q129202">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q129202</ulink>. +</para> + +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/msdfs_setup.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/msdfs_setup.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..a86cd74235c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/msdfs_setup.xml @@ -0,0 +1,116 @@ +<chapter id="msdfs"> + +<chapterinfo> + <author> + <firstname>Shirish</firstname><surname>Kalele</surname> + <affiliation> + <orgname>Samba Team & Veritas Software</orgname> + <address> + <email>samba@samba.org</email> + </address> + </affiliation> + </author> + + <pubdate>12 Jul 2000</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + + +<title>Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</title> + +<sect1> + + <title>Instructions</title> + + <para>The Distributed File System (or Dfs) provides a means of + separating the logical view of files and directories that users + see from the actual physical locations of these resources on the + network. It allows for higher availability, smoother storage expansion, + load balancing etc. For more information about Dfs, refer to <ulink + url="http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp"> + Microsoft documentation</ulink>. </para> + + <para>This document explains how to host a Dfs tree on a Unix + machine (for Dfs-aware clients to browse) using Samba.</para> + + <para>To enable SMB-based DFS for Samba, configure it with the + <parameter>--with-msdfs</parameter> option. Once built, a + Samba server can be made a Dfs server by setting the global + boolean <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#HOSTMSDFS"><parameter> + host msdfs</parameter></ulink> parameter in the <filename>smb.conf + </filename> file. You designate a share as a Dfs root using the share + level boolean <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#MSDFSROOT"><parameter> + msdfs root</parameter></ulink> parameter. A Dfs root directory on + Samba hosts Dfs links in the form of symbolic links that point + to other servers. For example, a symbolic link + <filename>junction->msdfs:storage1\share1</filename> in + the share directory acts as the Dfs junction. When Dfs-aware + clients attempt to access the junction link, they are redirected + to the storage location (in this case, \\storage1\share1).</para> + + <para>Dfs trees on Samba work with all Dfs-aware clients ranging + from Windows 95 to 2000.</para> + + <para>Here's an example of setting up a Dfs tree on a Samba + server.</para> + + <para><programlisting> +# The smb.conf file: +[global] + netbios name = SAMBA + host msdfs = yes + +[dfs] + path = /export/dfsroot + msdfs root = yes + </programlisting></para> + + + <para>In the /export/dfsroot directory we set up our dfs links to + other servers on the network.</para> + + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>cd /export/dfsroot</userinput></para> + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>chown root /export/dfsroot</userinput></para> + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>chmod 755 /export/dfsroot</userinput></para> + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>ln -s msdfs:storageA\\shareA linka</userinput></para> + <para><prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>ln -s msdfs:serverB\\share,serverC\\share linkb</userinput></para> + + + <para>You should set up the permissions and ownership of + the directory acting as the Dfs root such that only designated + users can create, delete or modify the msdfs links. Also note + that symlink names should be all lowercase. This limitation exists + to have Samba avoid trying all the case combinations to get at + the link name. Finally set up the symbolic links to point to the + network shares you want, and start Samba.</para> + + <para>Users on Dfs-aware clients can now browse the Dfs tree + on the Samba server at \\samba\dfs. Accessing + links linka or linkb (which appear as directories to the client) + takes users directly to the appropriate shares on the network.</para> + + <sect2> + <title>Notes</title> + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Windows clients need to be rebooted + if a previously mounted non-dfs share is made a dfs + root or vice versa. A better way is to introduce a + new share and make it the dfs root.</para> + </listitem> + + <listitem><para>Currently there's a restriction that msdfs + symlink names should all be lowercase.</para> + </listitem> + + <listitem><para>For security purposes, the directory + acting as the root of the Dfs tree should have ownership + and permissions set so that only designated users can + modify the symbolic links in the directory.</para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </sect2> +</sect1> + + + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/passdb.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/passdb.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..cc497f7d937 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/passdb.xml @@ -0,0 +1,970 @@ +<chapter id="passdb"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jelmer; + &author.jerry; + &author.jeremy; + &author.jht; + <author> + <firstname>Olivier (lem)</firstname><surname>Lemaire</surname> + <affiliation> + <orgname>IDEALX</orgname> + <address><email>olem@IDEALX.org</email></address> + </affiliation> + </author> + + <pubdate>February 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>User information database</title> + +<sect1> + <title>Introduction</title> + + <para>Old windows clients send plain text passwords over the wire. + Samba can check these passwords by crypting them and comparing them + to the hash stored in the unix user database. + </para> + + <para> + Newer windows clients send encrypted passwords (so-called + Lanman and NT hashes) over + the wire, instead of plain text passwords. The newest clients + will only send encrypted passwords and refuse to send plain text + passwords, unless their registry is tweaked. + </para> + + <para>These passwords can't be converted to unix style encrypted + passwords. Because of that you can't use the standard unix + user database, and you have to store the Lanman and NT hashes + somewhere else. </para> + + <para>Next to a differently encrypted passwords, + windows also stores certain data for each user + that is not stored in a unix user database, e.g. + workstations the user may logon from, the location where his/her + profile is stored, etc. + Samba retrieves and stores this information using a "passdb backend". + Commonly + available backends are LDAP, plain text file, MySQL and nisplus. + For more information, see the documentation about the + <command>passdb backend = </command> parameter. + </para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Important Notes About Security</title> + + <para>The unix and SMB password encryption techniques seem similar + on the surface. This similarity is, however, only skin deep. The unix + scheme typically sends clear text passwords over the network when + logging in. This is bad. The SMB encryption scheme never sends the + cleartext password over the network but it does store the 16 byte + hashed values on disk. This is also bad. Why? Because the 16 byte hashed + values are a "password equivalent". You cannot derive the user's + password from them, but they could potentially be used in a modified + client to gain access to a server. This would require considerable + technical knowledge on behalf of the attacker but is perfectly possible. + You should thus treat the data stored in whatever + passdb backend you use (smbpasswd file, ldap, mysql) as though it contained the + cleartext passwords of all your users. Its contents must be kept + secret, and the file should be protected accordingly.</para> + + <para>Ideally we would like a password scheme which neither requires + plain text passwords on the net or on disk. Unfortunately this + is not available as Samba is stuck with being compatible with + other SMB systems (WinNT, WfWg, Win95 etc). </para> + + <warning> + <para>Note that Windows NT 4.0 Service pack 3 changed the + default for permissible authentication so that plaintext + passwords are <emphasis>never</emphasis> sent over the wire. + The solution to this is either to switch to encrypted passwords + with Samba or edit the Windows NT registry to re-enable plaintext + passwords. See the document WinNT.txt for details on how to do + this.</para> + + <para>Other Microsoft operating systems which also exhibit + this behavior includes</para> + + <para> These versions of MS Windows do not support full domain + security protocols, although they may log onto a domain environment. + Of these Only MS Windows XP Home does NOT support domain logons.</para> + + <simplelist> + <member>MS DOS Network client 3.0 with + the basic network redirector installed</member> + + <member>Windows 95 with the network redirector + update installed</member> + + <member>Windows 98 [se]</member> + + <member>Windows Me</member> + + <member>Windows XP Home</member> + </simplelist> + + <para> The following versions of MS Windows fully support domain + security protocols.</para> + + <simplelist> + <member>Windows NT 3.5x</member> + <member>Windows NT 4.0</member> + <member>Windows 2000 Professional</member> + <member>Windows 200x Server/Advanced Server</member> + <member>Windows XP Professional</member> + </simplelist> + </warning> + + <note><para>All current release of + Microsoft SMB/CIFS clients support authentication via the + SMB Challenge/Response mechanism described here. Enabling + clear text authentication does not disable the ability + of the client to participate in encrypted authentication.</para></note> + + <para>MS Windows clients will cache the encrypted password alone. + Even when plain text passwords are re-enabled, through the appropriate + registry change, the plain text password is NEVER cached. This means that + in the event that a network connections should become disconnected (broken) + only the cached (encrypted) password will be sent to the resource server + to affect a auto-reconnect. If the resource server does not support encrypted + passwords the auto-reconnect will fail. <emphasis>USE OF ENCRYPTED PASSWORDS + IS STRONGLY ADVISED.</emphasis></para> + + <sect2> + <title>Advantages of SMB Encryption</title> + + <simplelist> + <member>Plain text passwords are not passed across + the network. Someone using a network sniffer cannot just + record passwords going to the SMB server.</member> + + <member>WinNT doesn't like talking to a server + that does not support encrypted passwords. It will refuse + to browse the server if the server is also in user level + security mode. It will insist on prompting the user for the + password on each connection, which is very annoying. The + only things you can do to stop this is to use SMB encryption. + </member> + + <member>Encrypted password support allows automatic share + (resource) reconnects.</member> + </simplelist> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>Advantages of non-encrypted passwords</title> + + <simplelist> + <member>Plain text passwords are not kept + on disk, and are NOT cached in memory. </member> + + <member>Uses same password file as other unix + services such as login and ftp</member> + + <member>Use of other services (such as telnet and ftp) which + send plain text passwords over the net, so sending them for SMB + isn't such a big deal.</member> + </simplelist> + </sect2> +</sect1> + + +<sect1> + <title>The smbpasswd Command</title> + + <para>The smbpasswd utility is a utility similar to the + <command>passwd</command> or <command>yppasswd</command> programs. + It maintains the two 32 byte password fields in the passdb backend. </para> + + <para><command>smbpasswd</command> works in a client-server mode + where it contacts the local smbd to change the user's password on its + behalf. This has enormous benefits - as follows.</para> + + <para><command>smbpasswd</command> has the capability + to change passwords on Windows NT servers (this only works when + the request is sent to the NT Primary Domain Controller if you + are changing an NT Domain user's password).</para> + + <para>To run smbpasswd as a normal user just type :</para> + + <para><prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>smbpasswd</userinput></para> + <para><prompt>Old SMB password: </prompt><userinput><type old value here - + or hit return if there was no old password></userinput></para> + <para><prompt>New SMB Password: </prompt><userinput><type new value> + </userinput></para> + <para><prompt>Repeat New SMB Password: </prompt><userinput><re-type new value + </userinput></para> + + <para>If the old value does not match the current value stored for + that user, or the two new values do not match each other, then the + password will not be changed.</para> + + <para>If invoked by an ordinary user it will only allow the user + to change his or her own Samba password.</para> + + <para>If run by the root user smbpasswd may take an optional + argument, specifying the user name whose SMB password you wish to + change. Note that when run as root smbpasswd does not prompt for + or check the old password value, thus allowing root to set passwords + for users who have forgotten their passwords.</para> + + <para><command>smbpasswd</command> is designed to work in the same way + and be familiar to UNIX users who use the <command>passwd</command> or + <command>yppasswd</command> commands.</para> + + <para>For more details on using <command>smbpasswd</command> refer + to the man page which will always be the definitive reference.</para> +</sect1> + +<!-- +<sect1> +<title>The <command>pdbedit</command> command</title> +FIXME +</sect1> +--> + +<sect1> +<title>Plain text</title> +<para> +Older versions of samba retrieved user information from the unix user database +and eventually some other fields from the file <filename>/etc/samba/smbpasswd</filename> +or <filename>/etc/smbpasswd</filename>. When password encryption is disabled, no +data is stored at all. +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>TDB</title> +<para>Samba can also store the user data in a "TDB" (Trivial Database). Using this backend +doesn't require any additional configuration. This backend is recommended for new installations that +don not require LDAP. +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>LDAP</title> + +<sect2> +<title>Introduction</title> + +<para> +This document describes how to use an LDAP directory for storing Samba user +account information traditionally stored in the smbpasswd(5) file. It is +assumed that the reader already has a basic understanding of LDAP concepts +and has a working directory server already installed. For more information +on LDAP architectures and Directories, please refer to the following sites. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>OpenLDAP - <ulink url="http://www.openldap.org/">http://www.openldap.org/</ulink></para></listitem> + <listitem><para>iPlanet Directory Server - <ulink url="http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory">http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory</ulink></para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Note that <ulink url="http://www.ora.com/">O'Reilly Publishing</ulink> is working on +a guide to LDAP for System Administrators which has a planned release date of +early summer, 2002. +</para> + +<para> +Two additional Samba resources which may prove to be helpful are +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>The <ulink url="http://www.unav.es/cti/ldap-smb/ldap-smb-3-howto.html">Samba-PDC-LDAP-HOWTO</ulink> + maintained by Ignacio Coupeau.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>The NT migration scripts from <ulink url="http://samba.idealx.org/">IDEALX</ulink> that are + geared to manage users and group in such a Samba-LDAP Domain Controller configuration. + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Encrypted Password Database</title> + +<para> +Traditionally, when configuring <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">"encrypt +passwords = yes"</ulink> in Samba's <filename>smb.conf</filename> file, user account +information such as username, LM/NT password hashes, password change times, and account +flags have been stored in the <filename>smbpasswd(5)</filename> file. There are several +disadvantages to this approach for sites with very large numbers of users (counted +in the thousands). +</para> + +<itemizedlist> +<listitem><para> +The first is that all lookups must be performed sequentially. Given that +there are approximately two lookups per domain logon (one for a normal +session connection such as when mapping a network drive or printer), this +is a performance bottleneck for large sites. What is needed is an indexed approach +such as is used in databases. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> +The second problem is that administrators who desired to replicate a +smbpasswd file to more than one Samba server were left to use external +tools such as <command>rsync(1)</command> and <command>ssh(1)</command> +and wrote custom, in-house scripts. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> +And finally, the amount of information which is stored in an +smbpasswd entry leaves no room for additional attributes such as +a home directory, password expiration time, or even a Relative +Identified (RID). +</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +As a result of these defeciencies, a more robust means of storing user attributes +used by smbd was developed. The API which defines access to user accounts +is commonly referred to as the samdb interface (previously this was called the passdb +API, and is still so named in the CVS trees). +</para> + +<para> +There are a few points to stress about that the ldapsam +does not provide. The LDAP support referred to in the this documentation does not +include: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>A means of retrieving user account information from + an Windows 2000 Active Directory server.</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>A means of replacing /etc/passwd.</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +The second item can be accomplished by using LDAP NSS and PAM modules. LGPL +versions of these libraries can be obtained from PADL Software +(<ulink url="http://www.padl.com/">http://www.padl.com/</ulink>). More +information about the configuration of these packages may be found at "LDAP, +System Administration; Gerald Carter, O'Reilly; Chapter 6: Replacing NIS". +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Supported LDAP Servers</title> + +<!-- FIXME: This is outdated for 3.0 --> + +<para> +The LDAP samdb code in 2.2.3 (and later) has been developed and tested +using the OpenLDAP 2.0 server and client libraries. +The same code should be able to work with Netscape's Directory Server +and client SDK. However, due to lack of testing so far, there are bound +to be compile errors and bugs. These should not be hard to fix. +If you are so inclined, please be sure to forward all patches to +<ulink url="mailto:samba-patches@samba.org">samba-patches@samba.org</ulink> and +<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink>. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Schema and Relationship to the RFC 2307 posixAccount</title> + + +<para> +Samba 3.0 includes the necessary schema file for OpenLDAP 2.0 in +<filename>examples/LDAP/samba.schema</filename>. The sambaAccount objectclass is given here: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +objectclass ( 1.3.1.5.1.4.1.7165.2.2.2 NAME 'sambaAccount' SUP top AUXILIARY + DESC 'Samba Account' + MUST ( uid $ rid ) + MAY ( cn $ lmPassword $ ntPassword $ pwdLastSet $ logonTime $ + logoffTime $ kickoffTime $ pwdCanChange $ pwdMustChange $ acctFlags $ + displayName $ smbHome $ homeDrive $ scriptPath $ profilePath $ + description $ userWorkstations $ primaryGroupID $ domain )) +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The samba.schema file has been formatted for OpenLDAP 2.0. The OID's are +owned by the Samba Team and as such is legal to be openly published. +If you translate the schema to be used with Netscape DS, please +submit the modified schema file as a patch to <ulink +url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink> +</para> + +<para> +Just as the smbpasswd file is meant to store information which supplements a +user's <filename>/etc/passwd</filename> entry, so is the sambaAccount object +meant to supplement the UNIX user account information. A sambaAccount is a +<constant>STRUCTURAL</constant> objectclass so it can be stored individually +in the directory. However, there are several fields (e.g. uid) which overlap +with the posixAccount objectclass outlined in RFC2307. This is by design. +</para> + +<!--olem: we should perhaps have a note about shadowAccounts too as many +systems use them, isn'it ? --> + +<para> +In order to store all user account information (UNIX and Samba) in the directory, +it is necessary to use the sambaAccount and posixAccount objectclasses in +combination. However, smbd will still obtain the user's UNIX account +information via the standard C library calls (e.g. getpwnam(), et. al.). +This means that the Samba server must also have the LDAP NSS library installed +and functioning correctly. This division of information makes it possible to +store all Samba account information in LDAP, but still maintain UNIX account +information in NIS while the network is transitioning to a full LDAP infrastructure. +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Configuring Samba with LDAP</title> + + +<sect3> +<title>OpenLDAP configuration</title> + +<para> +To include support for the sambaAccount object in an OpenLDAP directory +server, first copy the samba.schema file to slapd's configuration directory. +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root# </prompt><userinput>cp samba.schema /etc/openldap/schema/</userinput> +</para> + +<para> +Next, include the <filename>samba.schema</filename> file in <filename>slapd.conf</filename>. +The sambaAccount object contains two attributes which depend upon other schema +files. The 'uid' attribute is defined in <filename>cosine.schema</filename> and +the 'displayName' attribute is defined in the <filename>inetorgperson.schema</filename> +file. Both of these must be included before the <filename>samba.schema</filename> file. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +## /etc/openldap/slapd.conf + +## schema files (core.schema is required by default) +include /etc/openldap/schema/core.schema + +## needed for sambaAccount +include /etc/openldap/schema/cosine.schema +include /etc/openldap/schema/inetorgperson.schema +include /etc/openldap/schema/samba.schema +include /etc/openldap/schema/nis.schema + +.... +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +It is recommended that you maintain some indices on some of the most usefull attributes, +like in the following example, to speed up searches made on sambaAccount objectclasses +(and possibly posixAccount and posixGroup as well). +</para> +<para><programlisting> +# Indices to maintain +## required by OpenLDAP 2.0 +index objectclass eq + +## support pb_getsampwnam() +index uid pres,eq +## support pdb_getsambapwrid() +index rid eq + +## uncomment these if you are storing posixAccount and +## posixGroup entries in the directory as well +##index uidNumber eq +##index gidNumber eq +##index cn eq +##index memberUid eq + +# (both fetched via ldapsearch): +index primaryGroupID eq +index displayName pres,eq + +</programlisting></para> +</sect3> + + +<sect3> +<title>Configuring Samba</title> + +<para> +The following parameters are available in smb.conf only with <parameter>--with-ldapsam</parameter> +was included when compiling Samba. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#PASSDBBACKEND">passdb backend [ldapsam|ldapsam_nua]:url</ulink></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSSL">ldap ssl</ulink></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN">ldap admin dn</ulink></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix</ulink></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPFILTER">ldap filter</ulink></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPPORT">ldap port</ulink></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPMACHINSUFFIX">ldap machine suffix</ulink></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPUSERSUFFIX">ldap user suffix</ulink></para></listitem> + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPDELETEDN">ldap delete dn</ulink></para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +These are described in the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5)</ulink> man +page and so will not be repeated here. However, a sample smb.conf file for +use with an LDAP directory could appear as +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +## /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf +[global] + security = user + encrypt passwords = yes + + netbios name = TASHTEGO + workgroup = NARNIA + + # ldap related parameters + + # define the DN to use when binding to the directory servers + # The password for this DN is not stored in smb.conf. Rather it + # must be set by using 'smbpasswd -w <replaceable>secretpw</replaceable>' to store the + # passphrase in the secrets.tdb file. If the "ldap admin dn" values + # change, this password will need to be reset. + ldap admin dn = "cn=Samba Manager,ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org" + + # Define the SSL option when connecting to the directory + # ('off', 'start tls', or 'on' (default)) + ldap ssl = start tls + + passdb backend ldapsam:ldap://ahab.samba.org + + # smbpasswd -x delete the entire dn-entry + ldap delete dn = no + + # the machine and user suffix added to the base suffix + # wrote WITHOUT quotes. NULL siffixes by default + ldap user suffix = ou=People + ldap machine suffix = ou=Systems + + # define the port to use in the LDAP session (defaults to 636 when + # "ldap ssl = on") + ldap port = 389 + + # specify the base DN to use when searching the directory + ldap suffix = "ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org" + + # generally the default ldap search filter is ok + # ldap filter = "(&(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaAccount))" +</programlisting></para> + + +</sect3> +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title>Accounts and Groups management</title> + +<para> +As users accounts are managed thru the sambaAccount objectclass, you should +modify your existing administration tools to deal with sambaAccount attributes. +</para> + +<para> +Machines accounts are managed with the sambaAccount objectclass, just +like users accounts. However, it's up to you to store thoses accounts +in a different tree of you LDAP namespace: you should use +"ou=Groups,dc=plainjoe,dc=org" to store groups and +"ou=People,dc=plainjoe,dc=org" to store users. Just configure your +NSS and PAM accordingly (usually, in the /etc/ldap.conf configuration +file). +</para> + +<para> +In Samba release 3.0, the group management system is based on posix +groups. This means that Samba makes usage of the posixGroup objectclass. +For now, there is no NT-like group system management (global and local +groups). +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Security and sambaAccount</title> + + +<para> +There are two important points to remember when discussing the security +of sambaAccount entries in the directory. +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para><emphasis>Never</emphasis> retrieve the lmPassword or + ntPassword attribute values over an unencrypted LDAP session.</para></listitem> + <listitem><para><emphasis>Never</emphasis> allow non-admin users to + view the lmPassword or ntPassword attribute values.</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +These password hashes are clear text equivalents and can be used to impersonate +the user without deriving the original clear text strings. For more information +on the details of LM/NT password hashes, refer to the <link +linkend="passdb">User Database</link> of the Samba-HOWTO-Collection. +</para> + +<para> +To remedy the first security issue, the "ldap ssl" smb.conf parameter defaults +to require an encrypted session (<command>ldap ssl = on</command>) using +the default port of 636 +when contacting the directory server. When using an OpenLDAP 2.0 server, it +is possible to use the use the StartTLS LDAP extended operation in the place of +LDAPS. In either case, you are strongly discouraged to disable this security +(<command>ldap ssl = off</command>). +</para> + +<para> +Note that the LDAPS protocol is deprecated in favor of the LDAPv3 StartTLS +extended operation. However, the OpenLDAP library still provides support for +the older method of securing communication between clients and servers. +</para> + +<para> +The second security precaution is to prevent non-administrative users from +harvesting password hashes from the directory. This can be done using the +following ACL in <filename>slapd.conf</filename>: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +## allow the "ldap admin dn" access, but deny everyone else +access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword + by dn="cn=Samba Admin,ou=people,dc=plainjoe,dc=org" write + by * none +</programlisting></para> + + +</sect2> + + + +<sect2> +<title>LDAP specials attributes for sambaAccounts</title> + +<para> +The sambaAccount objectclass is composed of the following attributes: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + + <listitem><para><constant>lmPassword</constant>: the LANMAN password 16-byte hash stored as a character + representation of a hexidecimal string.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>ntPassword</constant>: the NT password hash 16-byte stored as a character + representation of a hexidecimal string.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>pwdLastSet</constant>: The integer time in seconds since 1970 when the + <constant>lmPassword</constant> and <constant>ntPassword</constant> attributes were last set. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>acctFlags</constant>: string of 11 characters surrounded by square brackets [] + representing account flags such as U (user), W(workstation), X(no password expiration), and + D(disabled).</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>logonTime</constant>: Integer value currently unused</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>logoffTime</constant>: Integer value currently unused</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>kickoffTime</constant>: Integer value currently unused</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>pwdCanChange</constant>: Integer value currently unused</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>pwdMustChange</constant>: Integer value currently unused</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>homeDrive</constant>: specifies the drive letter to which to map the + UNC path specified by homeDirectory. The drive letter must be specified in the form "X:" + where X is the letter of the drive to map. Refer to the "logon drive" parameter in the + smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>scriptPath</constant>: The scriptPath property specifies the path of + the user's logon script, .CMD, .EXE, or .BAT file. The string can be null. The path + is relative to the netlogon share. Refer to the "logon script" parameter in the + smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>profilePath</constant>: specifies a path to the user's profile. + This value can be a null string, a local absolute path, or a UNC path. Refer to the + "logon path" parameter in the smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>smbHome</constant>: The homeDirectory property specifies the path of + the home directory for the user. The string can be null. If homeDrive is set and specifies + a drive letter, homeDirectory should be a UNC path. The path must be a network + UNC path of the form \\server\share\directory. This value can be a null string. + Refer to the "logon home" parameter in the smb.conf(5) man page for more information. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>userWorkstation</constant>: character string value currently unused. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>rid</constant>: the integer representation of the user's relative identifier + (RID).</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><constant>primaryGroupID</constant>: the relative identifier (RID) of the primary group + of the user.</para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +The majority of these parameters are only used when Samba is acting as a PDC of +a domain (refer to the <ulink url="Samba-PDC-HOWTO.html">Samba-PDC-HOWTO</ulink> for details on +how to configure Samba as a Primary Domain Controller). The following four attributes +are only stored with the sambaAccount entry if the values are non-default values: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>smbHome</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>scriptPath</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>logonPath</para></listitem> + <listitem><para>homeDrive</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +These attributes are only stored with the sambaAccount entry if +the values are non-default values. For example, assume TASHTEGO has now been +configured as a PDC and that <command>logon home = \\%L\%u</command> was defined in +its <filename>smb.conf</filename> file. When a user named "becky" logons to the domain, +the <parameter>logon home</parameter> string is expanded to \\TASHTEGO\becky. +If the smbHome attribute exists in the entry "uid=becky,ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org", +this value is used. However, if this attribute does not exist, then the value +of the <parameter>logon home</parameter> parameter is used in its place. Samba +will only write the attribute value to the directory entry if the value is +something other than the default (e.g. \\MOBY\becky). +</para> + + +</sect2> + + + +<sect2> +<title>Example LDIF Entries for a sambaAccount</title> + + +<para> +The following is a working LDIF with the inclusion of the posixAccount objectclass: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +dn: uid=guest2, ou=people,dc=plainjoe,dc=org +ntPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 +pwdMustChange: 2147483647 +primaryGroupID: 1201 +lmPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE +pwdLastSet: 1010179124 +logonTime: 0 +objectClass: sambaAccount +uid: guest2 +kickoffTime: 2147483647 +acctFlags: [UX ] +logoffTime: 2147483647 +rid: 19006 +pwdCanChange: 0 +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The following is an LDIF entry for using both the sambaAccount and +posixAccount objectclasses: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +dn: uid=gcarter, ou=people,dc=plainjoe,dc=org +logonTime: 0 +displayName: Gerald Carter +lmPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE +primaryGroupID: 1201 +objectClass: posixAccount +objectClass: sambaAccount +acctFlags: [UX ] +userPassword: {crypt}BpM2ej8Rkzogo +uid: gcarter +uidNumber: 9000 +cn: Gerald Carter +loginShell: /bin/bash +logoffTime: 2147483647 +gidNumber: 100 +kickoffTime: 2147483647 +pwdLastSet: 1010179230 +rid: 19000 +homeDirectory: /home/tashtego/gcarter +pwdCanChange: 0 +pwdMustChange: 2147483647 +ntPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 +</programlisting></para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>MySQL</title> + +<sect2> +<title>Creating the database</title> + +<para> +You either can set up your own table and specify the field names to pdb_mysql (see below +for the column names) or use the default table. The file <filename>examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</filename> +contains the correct queries to create the required tables. Use the command : + +<command>mysql -u<replaceable>username</replaceable> -h<replaceable>hostname</replaceable> -p<replaceable>password</replaceable> <replaceable>databasename</replaceable> > <filename>/path/to/samba/examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</filename></command> + +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Configuring</title> + +<para>This plugin lacks some good documentation, but here is some short info:</para> + +<para>Add a the following to the <command>passdb backend</command> variable in your <filename>smb.conf</filename>: +<programlisting> +passdb backend = [other-plugins] mysql:identifier [other-plugins] +</programlisting> +</para> + +<para>The identifier can be any string you like, as long as it doesn't collide with +the identifiers of other plugins or other instances of pdb_mysql. If you +specify multiple pdb_mysql.so entries in 'passdb backend', you also need to +use different identifiers! +</para> + +<para> +Additional options can be given thru the smb.conf file in the [global] section. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +identifier:mysql host - host name, defaults to 'localhost' +identifier:mysql password +identifier:mysql user - defaults to 'samba' +identifier:mysql database - defaults to 'samba' +identifier:mysql port - defaults to 3306 +identifier:table - Name of the table containing users +</programlisting></para> + +<warning> +<para> +Since the password for the mysql user is stored in the +smb.conf file, you should make the the smb.conf file +readable only to the user that runs samba. This is considered a security +bug and will be fixed soon. +</para> +</warning> + +<para>Names of the columns in this table(I've added column types those columns should have first):</para> + +<para><programlisting> +identifier:logon time column - int(9) +identifier:logoff time column - int(9) +identifier:kickoff time column - int(9) +identifier:pass last set time column - int(9) +identifier:pass can change time column - int(9) +identifier:pass must change time column - int(9) +identifier:username column - varchar(255) - unix username +identifier:domain column - varchar(255) - NT domain user is part of +identifier:nt username column - varchar(255) - NT username +identifier:fullname column - varchar(255) - Full name of user +identifier:home dir column - varchar(255) - Unix homedir path +identifier:dir drive column - varchar(2) - Directory drive path (eg: 'H:') +identifier:logon script column - varchar(255) + - Batch file to run on client side when logging on +identifier:profile path column - varchar(255) - Path of profile +identifier:acct desc column - varchar(255) - Some ASCII NT user data +identifier:workstations column - varchar(255) + - Workstations user can logon to (or NULL for all) +identifier:unknown string column - varchar(255) - unknown string +identifier:munged dial column - varchar(255) - ? +identifier:user sid column - varchar(255) - NT user SID +identifier:group sid column - varchar(255) - NT group ID +identifier:lanman pass column - varchar(255) - encrypted lanman password +identifier:nt pass column - varchar(255) - encrypted nt passwd +identifier:plain pass column - varchar(255) - plaintext password +identifier:acct control column - int(9) - nt user data +identifier:unknown 3 column - int(9) - unknown +identifier:logon divs column - int(9) - ? +identifier:hours len column - int(9) - ? +identifier:unknown 5 column - int(9) - unknown +identifier:unknown 6 column - int(9) - unknown +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Eventually, you can put a colon (:) after the name of each column, which +should specify the column to update when updating the table. You can also +specify nothing behind the colon - then the data from the field will not be +updated. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Using plaintext passwords or encrypted password</title> + +<para> +I strongly discourage the use of plaintext passwords, however, you can use them: +</para> + +<para> +If you would like to use plaintext passwords, set +'identifier:lanman pass column' and 'identifier:nt pass column' to +'NULL' (without the quotes) and 'identifier:plain pass column' to the +name of the column containing the plaintext passwords. +</para> + +<para> +If you use encrypted passwords, set the 'identifier:plain pass +column' to 'NULL' (without the quotes). This is the default. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Getting non-column data from the table</title> + +<para> +It is possible to have not all data in the database and making some 'constant'. +</para> + +<para> +For example, you can set 'identifier:fullname column' to : +<command>CONCAT(First_name,' ',Sur_name)</command> +</para> + +<para> +Or, set 'identifier:workstations column' to : +<command>NULL</command></para> + +<para>See the MySQL documentation for more language constructs.</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>XML</title> + +<para>This module requires libxml2 to be installed.</para> + +<para>The usage of pdb_xml is pretty straightforward. To export data, use: +</para> + +<para> + <userinput>pdbedit -e xml:filename</userinput> +</para> + +<para> +(where filename is the name of the file to put the data in) +</para> + +<para> +To import data, use: +<userinput>pdbedit -i xml:filename -e current-pdb</userinput> +</para> +<para> +Where filename is the name to read the data from and current-pdb to put it in. +</para> +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/printer_driver2.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/printer_driver2.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..da3eb838f23 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/printer_driver2.xml @@ -0,0 +1,1038 @@ +<chapter id="printing"> + +<chapterinfo> + &author.jerry; + <author> + <firstname>Patrick</firstname><surname>Powell</surname> + <affiliation> + <address><email>papowell@lprng.org</email></address> + </affiliation> + </author> + <pubdate> (3 May 2001) </pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Printing Support</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Introduction</title> + +<para>Beginning with the 2.2.0 release, Samba supports +the native Windows NT printing mechanisms implemented via +MS-RPC (i.e. the SPOOLSS named pipe). Previous versions of +Samba only supported LanMan printing calls.</para> + +<para>The additional functionality provided by the new +SPOOLSS support includes:</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Support for downloading printer driver + files to Windows 95/98/NT/2000 clients upon demand. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Uploading of printer drivers via the + Windows NT Add Printer Wizard (APW) or the + Imprints tool set (refer to <ulink + url="http://imprints.sourceforge.net">http://imprints.sourceforge.net</ulink>). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Support for the native MS-RPC printing + calls such as StartDocPrinter, EnumJobs(), etc... (See + the MSDN documentation at <ulink + url="http://msdn.microsoft.com/">http://msdn.microsoft.com/</ulink> + for more information on the Win32 printing API) + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Support for NT Access Control Lists (ACL) + on printer objects</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Improved support for printer queue manipulation + through the use of an internal databases for spooled job + information</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +There has been some initial confusion about what all this means +and whether or not it is a requirement for printer drivers to be +installed on a Samba host in order to support printing from Windows +clients. As a side note, Samba does not use these drivers in any way to process +spooled files. They are utilized entirely by the clients. +</para> + +<para> +The following MS KB article, may be of some help if you are dealing with +Windows 2000 clients: <emphasis>How to Add Printers with No User +Interaction in Windows 2000</emphasis> +</para> + +<para> +<ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/Q189/1/05.ASP">http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/Q189/1/05.ASP</ulink> +</para> + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> +<title>Configuration</title> + +<warning> +<title>[print$] vs. [printer$]</title> + +<para> +Previous versions of Samba recommended using a share named [printer$]. +This name was taken from the printer$ service created by Windows 9x +clients when a printer was shared. Windows 9x printer servers always have +a printer$ service which provides read-only access via no +password in order to support printer driver downloads. +</para> + +<para> +However, the initial implementation allowed for a +parameter named <parameter>printer driver location</parameter> +to be used on a per share basis to specify the location of +the driver files associated with that printer. Another +parameter named <parameter>printer driver</parameter> provided +a means of defining the printer driver name to be sent to +the client. +</para> + +</warning> + +<sect2> +<title>Creating [print$]</title> + +<para> +In order to support the uploading of printer driver +files, you must first configure a file share named [print$]. +The name of this share is hard coded in Samba's internals so +the name is very important (print$ is the service used by +Windows NT print servers to provide support for printer driver +download). +</para> + +<para>You should modify the server's smb.conf file to add the global +parameters and to create the +following file share (of course, some of the parameter values, +such as 'path' are arbitrary and should be replaced with +appropriate values for your site):</para> + +<para><programlisting> +[global] + ; members of the ntadmin group should be able + ; to add drivers and set printer properties + ; root is implicitly a 'printer admin' + printer admin = @ntadmin + +[print$] + path = /usr/local/samba/printers + guest ok = yes + browseable = yes + read only = yes + ; since this share is configured as read only, then we need + ; a 'write list'. Check the file system permissions to make + ; sure this account can copy files to the share. If this + ; is setup to a non-root account, then it should also exist + ; as a 'printer admin' + write list = @ntadmin,root +</programlisting></para> + +<para>The <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#WRITELIST"><parameter> +write list</parameter></ulink> is used to allow administrative +level user accounts to have write access in order to update files +on the share. See the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf(5) +man page</ulink> for more information on configuring file shares.</para> + +<para>The requirement for <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#GUESTOK"><command>guest +ok = yes</command></ulink> depends upon how your +site is configured. If users will be guaranteed to have +an account on the Samba host, then this is a non-issue.</para> + +<note> +<title>Author's Note</title> + +<para> +The non-issue is that if all your Windows NT users are guaranteed to be +authenticated by the Samba server (such as a domain member server and the NT +user has already been validated by the Domain Controller in +order to logon to the Windows NT console), then guest access +is not necessary. Of course, in a workgroup environment where +you just want to be able to print without worrying about +silly accounts and security, then configure the share for +guest access. You'll probably want to add <ulink +url="smb.conf.5.html#MAPTOGUEST"><command>map to guest = Bad User +</command></ulink> in the [global] section as well. Make sure +you understand what this parameter does before using it +though. --jerry +</para> +</note> + +<para>In order for a Windows NT print server to support +the downloading of driver files by multiple client architectures, +it must create subdirectories within the [print$] service +which correspond to each of the supported client architectures. +Samba follows this model as well.</para> + +<para>Next create the directory tree below the [print$] share +for each architecture you wish to support.</para> + +<para><computeroutput> +[print$]----- + |-W32X86 ; "Windows NT x86" + |-WIN40 ; "Windows 95/98" + |-W32ALPHA ; "Windows NT Alpha_AXP" + |-W32MIPS ; "Windows NT R4000" + |-W32PPC ; "Windows NT PowerPC" +</computeroutput></para> + +<warning> +<title>ATTENTION! REQUIRED PERMISSIONS</title> + +<para> +In order to currently add a new driver to you Samba host, +one of two conditions must hold true: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>The account used to connect to the Samba host + must have a uid of 0 (i.e. a root account)</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>The account used to connect to the Samba host + must be a member of the <ulink + url="smb.conf.5.html#PRINTERADMIN"><parameter>printer + admin</parameter></ulink> list.</para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Of course, the connected account must still possess access +to add files to the subdirectories beneath [print$]. Remember +that all file shares are set to 'read only' by default. +</para> +</warning> + + +<para> +Once you have created the required [print$] service and +associated subdirectories, simply log onto the Samba server using +a root (or <parameter>printer admin</parameter>) account +from a Windows NT 4.0/2k client. Open "Network Neighbourhood" or +"My Network Places" and browse for the Samba host. Once you have located +the server, navigate to the "Printers..." folder. +You should see an initial listing of printers +that matches the printer shares defined on your Samba host. +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Setting Drivers for Existing Printers</title> + +<para>The initial listing of printers in the Samba host's +Printers folder will have no real printer driver assigned +to them. This defaults to a NULL string to allow the use +of the local Add Printer Wizard on NT/2000 clients. +Attempting to view the printer properties for a printer +which has this default driver assigned will result in +the error message:</para> + +<para> +<emphasis>Device settings cannot be displayed. The driver +for the specified printer is not installed, only spooler +properties will be displayed. Do you want to install the +driver now?</emphasis> +</para> + +<para> +Click "No" in the error dialog and you will be presented with +the printer properties window. The way to assign a driver to a +printer is to either +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Use the "New Driver..." button to install + a new printer driver, or</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Select a driver from the popup list of + installed drivers. Initially this list will be empty.</para> + </listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para>If you wish to install printer drivers for client +operating systems other than "Windows NT x86", you will need +to use the "Sharing" tab of the printer properties dialog.</para> + +<para>Assuming you have connected with a root account, you +will also be able modify other printer properties such as +ACLs and device settings using this dialog box.</para> + +<para>A few closing comments for this section, it is possible +on a Windows NT print server to have printers +listed in the Printers folder which are not shared. Samba does +not make this distinction. By definition, the only printers of +which Samba is aware are those which are specified as shares in +<filename>smb.conf</filename>.</para> + +<para>Another interesting side note is that Windows NT clients do +not use the SMB printer share, but rather can print directly +to any printer on another Windows NT host using MS-RPC. This +of course assumes that the printing client has the necessary +privileges on the remote host serving the printer. The default +permissions assigned by Windows NT to a printer gives the "Print" +permissions to the "Everyone" well-known group. +</para> + +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title>Support a large number of printers</title> + +<para>One issue that has arisen during the development +phase of Samba 2.2 is the need to support driver downloads for +100's of printers. Using the Windows NT APW is somewhat +awkward to say the list. If more than one printer are using the +same driver, the <ulink url="rpcclient.1.html"><command>rpcclient's +setdriver command</command></ulink> can be used to set the driver +associated with an installed driver. The following is example +of how this could be accomplished:</para> + +<para> +<prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>rpcclient pogo -U root%secret -c "enumdrivers"</userinput> +<programlisting> +Domain=[NARNIA] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.0-alpha3] + +[Windows NT x86] +Printer Driver Info 1: + Driver Name: [HP LaserJet 4000 Series PS] + +Printer Driver Info 1: + Driver Name: [HP LaserJet 2100 Series PS] + +Printer Driver Info 1: + Driver Name: [HP LaserJet 4Si/4SiMX PS] +</programlisting> +<prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>rpcclient pogo -U root%secret -c "enumprinters"</userinput> +<programlisting> +Domain=[NARNIA] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.0-alpha3] + flags:[0x800000] + name:[\\POGO\hp-print] + description:[POGO\\POGO\hp-print,NO DRIVER AVAILABLE FOR THIS PRINTER,] + comment:[] + +</programlisting> +<prompt>$ </prompt><userinput>rpcclient pogo -U root%secret -c "setdriver hp-print \"HP LaserJet 4000 Series PS\""</userinput> +<programlisting> +Domain=[NARNIA] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.0-alpha3] +Successfully set hp-print to driver HP LaserJet 4000 Series PS. +</programlisting></para> +</sect2> + + + +<sect2> +<title>Adding New Printers via the Windows NT APW</title> + +<para> +By default, Samba offers all printer shares defined in <filename>smb.conf</filename> +in the "Printers..." folder. Also existing in this folder is the Windows NT +Add Printer Wizard icon. The APW will be show only if +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>The connected user is able to successfully + execute an OpenPrinterEx(\\server) with administrative + privileges (i.e. root or <parameter>printer admin</parameter>). + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para><ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"><parameter>show + add printer wizard = yes</parameter></ulink> (the default). + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +In order to be able to use the APW to successfully add a printer to a Samba +server, the <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>add +printer command</parameter></ulink> must have a defined value. The program +hook must successfully add the printer to the system (i.e. +<filename>/etc/printcap</filename> or appropriate files) and +<filename>smb.conf</filename> if necessary. +</para> + +<para> +When using the APW from a client, if the named printer share does +not exist, <command>smbd</command> will execute the <parameter>add printer +command</parameter> and reparse to the <filename>smb.conf</filename> +to attempt to locate the new printer share. If the share is still not defined, +an error of "Access Denied" is returned to the client. Note that the +<parameter>add printer program</parameter> is executed under the context +of the connected user, not necessarily a root account. +</para> + +<para> +There is a complementary <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>delete +printer command</parameter></ulink> for removing entries from the "Printers..." +folder. +</para> + +<para> +The following is an example <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#ADDPRINTERCOMMAN"><parameter>add printer command</parameter></ulink> script. It adds the appropriate entries to <filename>/etc/printcap.local</filename> (change that to what you need) and returns a line of 'Done' which is needed for the whole process to work. +</para> + +<programlisting> +#!/bin/sh + +# Script to insert a new printer entry into printcap.local +# +# $1, printer name, used as the descriptive name +# $2, share name, used as the printer name for Linux +# $3, port name +# $4, driver name +# $5, location, used for the device file of the printer +# $6, win9x location + +# +# Make sure we use the location that RedHat uses for local printer defs +PRINTCAP=/etc/printcap.local +DATE=`date +%Y%m%d-%H%M%S` +LP=lp +RESTART="service lpd restart" + +# Keep a copy +cp $PRINTCAP $PRINTCAP.$DATE +# Add the printer to $PRINTCAP +echo "" >> $PRINTCAP +echo "$2|$1:\\" >> $PRINTCAP +echo " :sd=/var/spool/lpd/$2:\\" >> $PRINTCAP +echo " :mx=0:ml=0:sh:\\" >> $PRINTCAP +echo " :lp=/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn:" >> $PRINTCAP + +touch "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" >> /tmp/printadd.$$ 2>&1 +chown $LP "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" >> /tmp/printadd.$$ 2>&1 + +mkdir /var/spool/lpd/$2 +chmod 700 /var/spool/lpd/$2 +chown $LP /var/spool/lpd/$2 +#echo $1 >> "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" +#echo $2 >> "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" +#echo $3 >> "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" +#echo $4 >> "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" +#echo $5 >> "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" +#echo $6 >> "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" +$RESTART >> "/usr/local/samba/var/print/$5.prn" +# Not sure if this is needed +touch /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf +# +# You need to return a value, but I am not sure what it means. +# +echo "Done" +exit 0 +</programlisting> + +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title>Samba and Printer Ports</title> + +<para> +Windows NT/2000 print servers associate a port with each printer. These normally +take the form of LPT1:, COM1:, FILE:, etc... Samba must also support the +concept of ports associated with a printer. By default, only one printer port, +named "Samba Printer Port", exists on a system. Samba does not really a port in +order to print, rather it is a requirement of Windows clients. +</para> + +<para> +Note that Samba does not support the concept of "Printer Pooling" internally +either. This is when a logical printer is assigned to multiple ports as +a form of load balancing or fail over. +</para> + +<para> +If you require that multiple ports be defined for some reason, +<filename>smb.conf</filename> possesses a <ulink +url="smb.conf.5.html#ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"><parameter>enumports +command</parameter></ulink> which can be used to define an external program +that generates a listing of ports on a system. +</para> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + + +<sect1> + <title>The Imprints Toolset</title> + + <para>The Imprints tool set provides a UNIX equivalent of the + Windows NT Add Printer Wizard. For complete information, please + refer to the Imprints web site at <ulink url="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/"> + http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</ulink> as well as the documentation + included with the imprints source distribution. This section will + only provide a brief introduction to the features of Imprints.</para> + + + <sect2> + <title>What is Imprints?</title> + + <para>Imprints is a collection of tools for supporting the goals + of</para> + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Providing a central repository information + regarding Windows NT and 95/98 printer driver packages</para> + </listitem> + + <listitem><para>Providing the tools necessary for creating + the Imprints printer driver packages.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Providing an installation client which + will obtain and install printer drivers on remote Samba + and Windows NT 4 print servers.</para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>Creating Printer Driver Packages</title> + + <para>The process of creating printer driver packages is beyond + the scope of this document (refer to Imprints.txt also included + with the Samba distribution for more information). In short, + an Imprints driver package is a gzipped tarball containing the + driver files, related INF files, and a control file needed by the + installation client.</para> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>The Imprints server</title> + + <para>The Imprints server is really a database server that + may be queried via standard HTTP mechanisms. Each printer + entry in the database has an associated URL for the actual + downloading of the package. Each package is digitally signed + via GnuPG which can be used to verify that package downloaded + is actually the one referred in the Imprints database. It is + <emphasis>not</emphasis> recommended that this security check + be disabled.</para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>The Installation Client</title> + + <para>More information regarding the Imprints installation client + is available in the <filename>Imprints-Client-HOWTO.ps</filename> + file included with the imprints source package.</para> + + <para>The Imprints installation client comes in two forms.</para> + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>a set of command line Perl scripts</para> + </listitem> + + <listitem><para>a GTK+ based graphical interface to + the command line perl scripts</para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + <para>The installation client (in both forms) provides a means + of querying the Imprints database server for a matching + list of known printer model names as well as a means to + download and install the drivers on remote Samba and Windows + NT print servers.</para> + + <para>The basic installation process is in four steps and + perl code is wrapped around <command>smbclient</command> + and <command>rpcclient</command>.</para> + +<para><programlisting> +foreach (supported architecture for a given driver) +{ + 1. rpcclient: Get the appropriate upload directory + on the remote server + 2. smbclient: Upload the driver files + 3. rpcclient: Issues an AddPrinterDriver() MS-RPC +} + +4. rpcclient: Issue an AddPrinterEx() MS-RPC to actually + create the printer +</programlisting></para> + + <para>One of the problems encountered when implementing + the Imprints tool set was the name space issues between + various supported client architectures. For example, Windows + NT includes a driver named "Apple LaserWriter II NTX v51.8" + and Windows 95 calls its version of this driver "Apple + LaserWriter II NTX"</para> + + <para>The problem is how to know what client drivers have + been uploaded for a printer. As astute reader will remember + that the Windows NT Printer Properties dialog only includes + space for one printer driver name. A quick look in the + Windows NT 4.0 system registry at</para> + + <para><filename>HKLM\System\CurrentControlSet\Control\Print\Environment + </filename></para> + + <para>will reveal that Windows NT always uses the NT driver + name. This is ok as Windows NT always requires that at least + the Windows NT version of the printer driver is present. + However, Samba does not have the requirement internally. + Therefore, how can you use the NT driver name if is has not + already been installed?</para> + + <para>The way of sidestepping this limitation is to require + that all Imprints printer driver packages include both the Intel + Windows NT and 95/98 printer drivers and that NT driver is + installed first.</para> + </sect2> + +</sect1> + +<!-- + + This comment from rpc_server/srv_spoolss_nt.c:_spoolss_open_printer_ex() + needs to be added into a section probably. This is to remind me it needs + to be done. -jerry + + /* + * If the openprinterex rpc call contains a devmode, + * it's a per-user one. This per-user devmode is derivated + * from the global devmode. Openprinterex() contains a per-user + * devmode for when you do EMF printing and spooling. + * In the EMF case, the NT workstation is only doing half the job + * of rendering the page. The other half is done by running the printer + * driver on the server. + * The EMF file doesn't contain the page description (paper size, orientation, ...). + * The EMF file only contains what is to be printed on the page. + * So in order for the server to know how to print, the NT client sends + * a devicemode attached to the openprinterex call. + * But this devicemode is short lived, it's only valid for the current print job. + * + * If Samba would have supported EMF spooling, this devicemode would + * have been attached to the handle, to sent it to the driver to correctly + * rasterize the EMF file. + * + * As Samba only supports RAW spooling, we only receive a ready-to-print file, + * we just act as a pass-thru between windows and the printer. + * + * In order to know that Samba supports only RAW spooling, NT has to call + * getprinter() at level 2 (attribute field) or NT has to call startdoc() + * and until NT sends a RAW job, we refuse it. + * + * But to call getprinter() or startdoc(), you first need a valid handle, + * and to get an handle you have to call openprintex(). Hence why you have + * a devicemode in the openprinterex() call. + * + * + * Differences between NT4 and NT 2000. + * NT4: + * + * On NT4, you only have a global devicemode. This global devicemode can be changed + * by the administrator (or by a user with enough privs). Every time a user + * wants to print, the devicemode is reset to the default. In Word, every time + * you print, the printer's characteristics are always reset to the global devicemode. + * + * NT 2000: + * + * In W2K, there is the notion of per-user devicemode. The first time you use + * a printer, a per-user devicemode is build from the global devicemode. + * If you change your per-user devicemode, it is saved in the registry, under the + * H_KEY_CURRENT_KEY sub_tree. So that every time you print, you have your default + * printer preferences available. + * + * To change the per-user devicemode: it's the "Printing Preferences ..." button + * on the General Tab of the printer properties windows. + * + * To change the global devicemode: it's the "Printing Defaults..." button + * on the Advanced Tab of the printer properties window. +--> + +<sect1> +<title>Diagnosis</title> + +<sect2> +<title>Introduction</title> + +<para> +This is a short description of how to debug printing problems with +Samba. This describes how to debug problems with printing from a SMB +client to a Samba server, not the other way around. For the reverse +see the examples/printing directory. +</para> + +<para> +Ok, so you want to print to a Samba server from your PC. The first +thing you need to understand is that Samba does not actually do any +printing itself, it just acts as a middleman between your PC client +and your Unix printing subsystem. Samba receives the file from the PC +then passes the file to a external "print command". What print command +you use is up to you. +</para> + +<para> +The whole things is controlled using options in smb.conf. The most +relevant options (which you should look up in the smb.conf man page) +are: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + [global] + print command - send a file to a spooler + lpq command - get spool queue status + lprm command - remove a job + [printers] + path = /var/spool/lpd/samba +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The following are nice to know about: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + queuepause command - stop a printer or print queue + queueresume command - start a printer or print queue +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Example: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + print command = /usr/bin/lpr -r -P%p %s + lpq command = /usr/bin/lpq -P%p %s + lprm command = /usr/bin/lprm -P%p %j + queuepause command = /usr/sbin/lpc -P%p stop + queuepause command = /usr/sbin/lpc -P%p start +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Samba should set reasonable defaults for these depending on your +system type, but it isn't clairvoyant. It is not uncommon that you +have to tweak these for local conditions. The commands should +always have fully specified pathnames, as the smdb may not have +the correct PATH values. +</para> + +<para> +When you send a job to Samba to be printed, it will make a temporary +copy of it in the directory specified in the [printers] section. +and it should be periodically cleaned out. The lpr -r option +requests that the temporary copy be removed after printing; If +printing fails then you might find leftover files in this directory, +and it should be periodically cleaned out. Samba used the lpq +command to determine the "job number" assigned to your print job +by the spooler. +</para> + +<para> +The %>letter< are "macros" that get dynamically replaced with appropriate +values when they are used. The %s gets replaced with the name of the spool +file that Samba creates and the %p gets replaced with the name of the +printer. The %j gets replaced with the "job number" which comes from +the lpq output. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Debugging printer problems</title> + +<para> +One way to debug printing problems is to start by replacing these +command with shell scripts that record the arguments and the contents +of the print file. A simple example of this kind of things might +be: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + print command = /tmp/saveprint %p %s + + #!/bin/saveprint + # we make sure that we are the right user + /usr/bin/id -p >/tmp/tmp.print + # we run the command and save the error messages + # replace the command with the one appropriate for your system + /usr/bin/lpr -r -P$1 $2 2>>&/tmp/tmp.print +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Then you print a file and try removing it. You may find that the +print queue needs to be stopped in order to see the queue status +and remove the job: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + +h4: {42} % echo hi >/tmp/hi +h4: {43} % smbclient //localhost/lw4 +added interface ip=10.0.0.4 bcast=10.0.0.255 nmask=255.255.255.0 +Password: +Domain=[ASTART] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.0.7] +smb: \> print /tmp/hi +putting file /tmp/hi as hi-17534 (0.0 kb/s) (average 0.0 kb/s) +smb: \> queue +1049 3 hi-17534 +smb: \> cancel 1049 +Error cancelling job 1049 : code 0 +smb: \> cancel 1049 +Job 1049 cancelled +smb: \> queue +smb: \> exit +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The 'code 0' indicates that the job was removed. The comment +by the smbclient is a bit misleading on this. +You can observe the command output and then and look at the +/tmp/tmp.print file to see what the results are. You can quickly +find out if the problem is with your printing system. Often people +have problems with their /etc/printcap file or permissions on +various print queues. +</para> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>What printers do I have?</title> + +<para> +You can use the 'testprns' program to check to see if the printer +name you are using is recognized by Samba. For example, you can +use: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + testprns printer /etc/printcap +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Samba can get its printcap information from a file or from a program. +You can try the following to see the format of the extracted +information: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + testprns -a printer /etc/printcap + + testprns -a printer '|/bin/cat printcap' +</programlisting></para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Setting up printcap and print servers</title> + +<para> +You may need to set up some printcaps for your Samba system to use. +It is strongly recommended that you use the facilities provided by +the print spooler to set up queues and printcap information. +</para> + +<para> +Samba requires either a printcap or program to deliver printcap +information. This printcap information has the format: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + name|alias1|alias2...:option=value:... +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +For almost all printing systems, the printer 'name' must be composed +only of alphanumeric or underscore '_' characters. Some systems also +allow hyphens ('-') as well. An alias is an alternative name for the +printer, and an alias with a space in it is used as a 'comment' +about the printer. The printcap format optionally uses a \ at the end of lines +to extend the printcap to multiple lines. +</para> + +<para> +Here are some examples of printcap files: +</para> + +<para> +<orderedlist> +<listitem><para> +pr just printer name +</para></listitem> +<listitem><para> +pr|alias printer name and alias +</para></listitem> +<listitem><para> +pr|My Printer printer name, alias used as comment +</para></listitem> +<listitem><para> +pr:sh:\ Same as pr:sh:cm= testing + :cm= \ + testing +</para></listitem> +<listitem><para> +pr:sh Same as pr:sh:cm= testing + :cm= testing +</para></listitem> +</orderedlist> +</para> + +<para> +Samba reads the printcap information when first started. If you make +changes in the printcap information, then you must do the following: +</para> + +<orderedlist> + +<listitem><para> +make sure that the print spooler is aware of these changes. +The LPRng system uses the 'lpc reread' command to do this. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> +make sure that the spool queues, etc., exist and have the +correct permissions. The LPRng system uses the 'checkpc -f' +command to do this. +</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para> +You now should send a SIGHUP signal to the smbd server to have +it reread the printcap information. +</para></listitem> +</orderedlist> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Job sent, no output</title> + +<para> +This is the most frustrating part of printing. You may have sent the +job, verified that the job was forwarded, set up a wrapper around +the command to send the file, but there was no output from the printer. +</para> + +<para> +First, check to make sure that the job REALLY is getting to the +right print queue. If you are using a BSD or LPRng print spooler, +you can temporarily stop the printing of jobs. Jobs can still be +submitted, but they will not be printed. Use: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + lpc -Pprinter stop +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Now submit a print job and then use 'lpq -Pprinter' to see if the +job is in the print queue. If it is not in the print queue then +you will have to find out why it is not being accepted for printing. +</para> + +<para> +Next, you may want to check to see what the format of the job really +was. With the assistance of the system administrator you can view +the submitted jobs files. You may be surprised to find that these +are not in what you would expect to call a printable format. +You can use the UNIX 'file' utitily to determine what the job +format actually is: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + cd /var/spool/lpd/printer # spool directory of print jobs + ls # find job files + file dfA001myhost +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +You should make sure that your printer supports this format OR that +your system administrator has installed a 'print filter' that will +convert the file to a format appropriate for your printer. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Job sent, strange output</title> + +<para> +Once you have the job printing, you can then start worrying about +making it print nicely. +</para> + +<para> +The most common problem is extra pages of output: banner pages +OR blank pages at the end. +</para> + +<para> +If you are getting banner pages, check and make sure that the +printcap option or printer option is configured for no banners. +If you have a printcap, this is the :sh (suppress header or banner +page) option. You should have the following in your printer. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + printer: ... :sh +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +If you have this option and are still getting banner pages, there +is a strong chance that your printer is generating them for you +automatically. You should make sure that banner printing is disabled +for the printer. This usually requires using the printer setup software +or procedures supplied by the printer manufacturer. +</para> + +<para> +If you get an extra page of output, this could be due to problems +with your job format, or if you are generating PostScript jobs, +incorrect setting on your printer driver on the MicroSoft client. +For example, under Win95 there is a option: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + Printers|Printer Name|(Right Click)Properties|Postscript|Advanced| +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +that allows you to choose if a Ctrl-D is appended to all jobs. +This is a very bad thing to do, as most spooling systems will +automatically add a ^D to the end of the job if it is detected as +PostScript. The multiple ^D may cause an additional page of output. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Raw PostScript printed</title> + +<para> +This is a problem that is usually caused by either the print spooling +system putting information at the start of the print job that makes +the printer think the job is a text file, or your printer simply +does not support PostScript. You may need to enable 'Automatic +Format Detection' on your printer. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Advanced Printing</title> + +<para> +Note that you can do some pretty magic things by using your +imagination with the "print command" option and some shell scripts. +Doing print accounting is easy by passing the %U option to a print +command shell script. You could even make the print command detect +the type of output and its size and send it to an appropriate +printer. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Real debugging</title> + +<para> +If the above debug tips don't help, then maybe you need to bring in +the bug guns, system tracing. See Tracing.txt in this directory. +</para> +</sect2> +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/samba-doc.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/samba-doc.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..e06ce2901e1 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/samba-doc.xml @@ -0,0 +1,133 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?> +<!DOCTYPE book SYSTEM "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd" [ +<!ENTITY % globalentities SYSTEM '../global.ent'> %globalentities; +]> + +<book id="Samba-HOWTO-Collection"> +<title>SAMBA Project Documentation</title> + +<bookinfo> + <author> + <othername>SAMBA Team</othername> + <affiliation><address><email>samba@samba.org</email></address></affiliation> + </author> + <editor>&person.jelmer;</editor> + <editor>&person.jht;</editor> + <editor>&person.jerry;</editor> + + <pubdate>Monday April 21, 2003</pubdate> + +<abstract> +<para> +This book is a collection of HOWTOs added to Samba documentation over the years. +Samba is always under development, and so is its' documentation. This release of the +documentation represents a major revision or layout as well as contents. +The most recent version of this document can be found at +<ulink url="http://www.samba.org/">http://www.samba.org/</ulink> +on the "Documentation" page. Please send updates to +<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">Jelmer Venrooij</ulink>, +<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">John Terpstra</ulink> or +<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">Gerald (Jerry) Carter</ulink>. +</para> + +<para> +The Samba-Team would like to express sincere thanks to the many people who have with +or without their knowledge contributed to this update. The size and scope of this +project would not have been possible without significant community contribution. A not +insignificant number of ideas for inclusion (if not content itself) has been obtained +from a number of Unofficial HOWTOs - to each such author a big "Thank-you" is also offered. +Please keep publishing your Unofficial HOWTO's - they are a source of inspiration and +application knowledge that is most to be desired by many Samba users and administrators. +</para> + +</abstract> +<legalnotice> +<para> +This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL) +version 2. A copy of the license is included with the Samba source +distribution. A copy can be found on-line at <ulink +url="http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt">http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt</ulink> +</para> +</legalnotice> +</bookinfo> + +<!-- Contents --> +<toc/> + +<!-- Chapters --> +<part id="introduction"> +<title>General Installation</title> +<partintro> +<title>Preparing Samba for Configuration</title> +<para>This section of the Samba-HOWTO-Collection contains general info on how to install samba +and how to configure the parts of samba you will most likely need. +PLEASE read this.</para> +</partintro> +&IntroSMB; +&UNIX-INSTALL; +</part> + +<part id="type"> +<title>Server Configuration Basics</title> +<partintro> +<title>First Steps in Server Configuration</title> +<para> +Samba can operate in various modes within SMB networks. This HOWTO section contains information on +configuring samba to function as the type of server your network requires. Please read this +section carefully. +</para> +</partintro> +&ServerType; +&SECURITY-LEVEL; +&Samba-PDC-HOWTO; +&Samba-BDC-HOWTO; +&ADS-HOWTO; +&DOMAIN-MEMBER; +</part> + +<part id="optional"> +<title>Advanced Configuration</title> +<partintro> +<title>Valuable Nuts and Bolts Information</title> +<para> +Samba has several features that you might want or might not want to use. The chapters in this part each cover specific Samba features. +</para> +</partintro> +&NetworkBrowsing; +&Passdb; +&NT-Security; +&GROUP-MAPPING-HOWTO; +&PRINTER-DRIVER2; +&CUPS; +&WINBIND; +&AdvancedNetworkAdmin; +&PolicyMgmt; +&ProfileMgmt; +&Trusts; +&Samba-PAM; +&VFS; +&MS-Dfs-Setup; +&IntegratingWithWindows; +&SecuringSamba; +&unicode; +&locking; +</part> + +<part id="troubleshooting"> +<title>Troubleshooting</title> +&Diagnosis; +&problems; +&BUGS; +</part> + +<part id="Appendixes"> +<title>Appendixes</title> +&Compiling; +&NT4Migration; +&Portability; +&Other-Clients; +&SWAT; +&SPEED; +</part> + +</book> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/securing-samba.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/securing-samba.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..d320767a77c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/securing-samba.xml @@ -0,0 +1,205 @@ +<chapter id="securing-samba"> + +<chapterinfo> + &author.tridge; + &author.jht; + <pubdate>17 March 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Securing Samba</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Introduction</title> +<para> +This note was attached to the Samba 2.2.8 release notes as it contained an +important security fix. The information contained here applies to Samba +installations in general. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Using host based protection</title> + +<para> +In many installations of Samba the greatest threat comes for outside +your immediate network. By default Samba will accept connections from +any host, which means that if you run an insecure version of Samba on +a host that is directly connected to the Internet you can be +especially vulnerable. +</para> + +<para> +One of the simplest fixes in this case is to use the <command>hosts allow</command> and +<command>hosts deny</command> options in the Samba &smb.conf; configuration file to only +allow access to your server from a specific range of hosts. An example +might be: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + hosts allow = 127.0.0.1 192.168.2.0/24 192.168.3.0/24 + hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0 +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The above will only allow SMB connections from 'localhost' (your own +computer) and from the two private networks 192.168.2 and +192.168.3. All other connections will be refused as soon +as the client sends its first packet. The refusal will be marked as a +'not listening on called name' error. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> + +<title>Using interface protection</title> + +<para> +By default Samba will accept connections on any network interface that +it finds on your system. That means if you have a ISDN line or a PPP +connection to the Internet then Samba will accept connections on those +links. This may not be what you want. +</para> + +<para> +You can change this behaviour using options like the following: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + interfaces = eth* lo + bind interfaces only = yes +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +This tells Samba to only listen for connections on interfaces with a +name starting with 'eth' such as eth0, eth1, plus on the loopback +interface called 'lo'. The name you will need to use depends on what +OS you are using, in the above I used the common name for Ethernet +adapters on Linux. +</para> + +<para> +If you use the above and someone tries to make a SMB connection to +your host over a PPP interface called 'ppp0' then they will get a TCP +connection refused reply. In that case no Samba code is run at all as +the operating system has been told not to pass connections from that +interface to any samba process. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Using a firewall</title> + +<para> +Many people use a firewall to deny access to services that they don't +want exposed outside their network. This can be a very good idea, +although I would recommend using it in conjunction with the above +methods so that you are protected even if your firewall is not active +for some reason. +</para> + +<para> +If you are setting up a firewall then you need to know what TCP and +UDP ports to allow and block. Samba uses the following: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + UDP/137 - used by nmbd + UDP/138 - used by nmbd + TCP/139 - used by smbd + TCP/445 - used by smbd +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The last one is important as many older firewall setups may not be +aware of it, given that this port was only added to the protocol in +recent years. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Using a IPC$ share deny</title> + +<para> +If the above methods are not suitable, then you could also place a +more specific deny on the IPC$ share that is used in the recently +discovered security hole. This allows you to offer access to other +shares while denying access to IPC$ from potentially untrustworthy +hosts. +</para> + +<para> +To do that you could use: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + [ipc$] + hosts allow = 192.168.115.0/24 127.0.0.1 + hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0 +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +this would tell Samba that IPC$ connections are not allowed from +anywhere but the two listed places (localhost and a local +subnet). Connections to other shares would still be allowed. As the +IPC$ share is the only share that is always accessible anonymously +this provides some level of protection against attackers that do not +know a username/password for your host. +</para> + +<para> +If you use this method then clients will be given a 'access denied' +reply when they try to access the IPC$ share. That means that those +clients will not be able to browse shares, and may also be unable to +access some other resources. +</para> + +<para> +This is not recommended unless you cannot use one of the other +methods listed above for some reason. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>NTLMv2 Security</title> + +<para> +To configure NTLMv2 authentication the following registry keys are worth knowing about: +</para> + +<para> +<programlisting> + [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\Lsa] + "lmcompatibilitylevel"=dword:00000003 + + 0x3 - Send NTLMv2 response only. Clients will use NTLMv2 authentication, + use NTLMv2 session security if the server supports it. Domain + controllers accept LM, NTLM and NTLMv2 authentication. + + [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\Lsa\MSV1_0] + "NtlmMinClientSec"=dword:00080000 + + 0x80000 - NTLMv2 session security. If either NtlmMinClientSec or + NtlmMinServerSec is set to 0x80000, the connection will fail if NTLMv2 + session security is not negotiated. +</programlisting> +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Upgrading Samba</title> + +<para> +Please check regularly on <ulink url="http://www.samba.org/">http://www.samba.org/</ulink> for updates and +important announcements. Occasionally security releases are made and +it is highly recommended to upgrade Samba when a security vulnerability +is discovered. +</para> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/security_level.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/security_level.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..528c87c52c3 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/security_level.xml @@ -0,0 +1,340 @@ +<chapter id="securitylevels"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.tridge; + &author.jelmer; +</chapterinfo> +<title>Samba as Stand-Alone Server</title> + +<para> +In this section the function and purpose of Samba's <emphasis>security</emphasis> +modes are described. +</para> + +<sect1> +<title>User and Share security level</title> + +<para> +A SMB server tells the client at startup what "security level" it is +running. There are two options "share level" and "user level". Which +of these two the client receives affects the way the client then tries +to authenticate itself. It does not directly affect (to any great +extent) the way the Samba server does security. I know this is +strange, but it fits in with the client/server approach of SMB. In SMB +everything is initiated and controlled by the client, and the server +can only tell the client what is available and whether an action is +allowed. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>User Level Security</title> + +<para> +I'll describe user level security first, as its simpler. In user level +security the client will send a "session setup" command directly after +the protocol negotiation. This contains a username and password. The +server can either accept or reject that username/password +combination. Note that at this stage the server has no idea what +share the client will eventually try to connect to, so it can't base +the "accept/reject" on anything other than: +</para> + +<orderedlist> +<listitem><para>the username/password</para></listitem> +<listitem><para>the machine that the client is coming from</para></listitem> +</orderedlist> + +<para> +If the server accepts the username/password then the client expects to +be able to mount any share (using a "tree connection") without +specifying a password. It expects that all access rights will be as +the username/password specified in the "session setup". +</para> + +<para> +It is also possible for a client to send multiple "session setup" +requests. When the server responds it gives the client a "uid" to use +as an authentication tag for that username/password. The client can +maintain multiple authentication contexts in this way (WinDD is an +example of an application that does this) +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Share Level Security</title> + +<para> +Ok, now for share level security. In share level security the client +authenticates itself separately for each share. It will send a +password along with each "tree connection" (share mount). It does not +explicitly send a username with this operation. The client is +expecting a password to be associated with each share, independent of +the user. This means that samba has to work out what username the +client probably wants to use. It is never explicitly sent the +username. Some commercial SMB servers such as NT actually associate +passwords directly with shares in share level security, but samba +always uses the unix authentication scheme where it is a +username/password that is authenticated, not a "share/password". +</para> + +<para> +Many clients send a "session setup" even if the server is in share +level security. They normally send a valid username but no +password. Samba records this username in a list of "possible +usernames". When the client then does a "tree connection" it also adds +to this list the name of the share they try to connect to (useful for +home directories) and any users listed in the <command>user =</command> &smb.conf; +line. The password is then checked in turn against these "possible +usernames". If a match is found then the client is authenticated as +that user. +</para> + +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Server Level Security</title> + +<para> +Finally "server level" security. In server level security the samba +server reports to the client that it is in user level security. The +client then does a "session setup" as described earlier. The samba +server takes the username/password that the client sends and attempts +to login to the "password server" by sending exactly the same +username/password that it got from the client. If that server is in +user level security and accepts the password then samba accepts the +clients connection. This allows the samba server to use another SMB +server as the "password server". +</para> + +<para> +You should also note that at the very start of all this, where the +server tells the client what security level it is in, it also tells +the client if it supports encryption. If it does then it supplies the +client with a random "cryptkey". The client will then send all +passwords in encrypted form. You have to compile samba with encryption +enabled to support this feature, and you have to maintain a separate +smbpasswd file with SMB style encrypted passwords. It is +cryptographically impossible to translate from unix style encryption +to SMB style encryption, although there are some fairly simple management +schemes by which the two could be kept in sync. +</para> + +<para> +"security = server" means that Samba reports to clients that +it is running in "user mode" but actually passes off all authentication +requests to another "user mode" server. This requires an additional +parameter "password server =" that points to the real authentication server. +That real authentication server can be another Samba server or can be a +Windows NT server, the later natively capable of encrypted password support. +</para> + +<note><para> +<emphasis>Server</emphasis> level security is incompatible with what is known +as <emphasis>schannel</emphasis> or "sign and seal" protocols. This means that +if you want to use <emphasis>server</emphasis> level security you must disable +the use of "sign and seal" on all machines on your network. +</para></note> + +<sect3> +<title>Configuring Samba for Seemless Windows Network Integration</title> + +<para> +MS Windows clients may use encrypted passwords as part of a challenege/response +authentication model (a.k.a. NTLMv1) or alone, or clear text strings for simple +password based authentication. It should be realized that with the SMB protocol +the password is passed over the network either in plain text or encrypted, but +not both in the same authentication request. +</para> + +<para> +When encrypted passwords are used a password that has been entered by the user +is encrypted in two ways: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>An MD4 hash of the UNICODE of the password + string. This is known as the NT hash. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>The password is converted to upper case, + and then padded or trucated to 14 bytes. This string is + then appended with 5 bytes of NULL characters and split to + form two 56 bit DES keys to encrypt a "magic" 8 byte value. + The resulting 16 bytes for the LanMan hash. + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +MS Windows 95 pre-service pack 1, MS Windows NT versions 3.x and version 4.0 +pre-service pack 3 will use either mode of password authentication. All +versions of MS Windows that follow these versions no longer support plain +text passwords by default. +</para> + +<para> +MS Windows clients have a habit of dropping network mappings that have been idle +for 10 minutes or longer. When the user attempts to use the mapped drive +connection that has been dropped, the client re-establishes the connection using +a cached copy of the password. +</para> + +<para> +When Microsoft changed the default password mode, support was dropped for caching +of the plain text password. This means that when the registry parameter is changed +to re-enable use of plain text passwords it appears to work, but when a dropped +service connection mapping attempts to revalidate it will fail if the remote +authentication server does not support encrypted passwords. This means that it +is definitely not a good idea to re-enable plain text password support in such clients. +</para> + +<para> +The following parameters can be used to work around the issue of Windows 9x client +upper casing usernames and password before transmitting them to the SMB server +when using clear text authentication. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDLEVEL">passsword level</ulink> = <replaceable>integer</replaceable> + <ulink url="smb.conf.5.html#USERNAMELEVEL">username level</ulink> = <replaceable>integer</replaceable> +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +By default Samba will lower case the username before attempting to lookup the user +in the database of local system accounts. Because UNIX usernames conventionally +only contain lower case character, the <parameter>username level</parameter> parameter +is rarely needed. +</para> + +<para> +However, passwords on UNIX systems often make use of mixed case characters. +This means that in order for a user on a Windows 9x client to connect to a Samba +server using clear text authentication, the <parameter>password level</parameter> +must be set to the maximum number of upper case letter which <emphasis>could</emphasis> +appear is a password. Note that the server OS uses the traditional DES version +of crypt(), a <parameter>password level</parameter> of 8 will result in case +insensitive passwords as seen from Windows users. This will also result in longer +login times as Samba has to compute the permutations of the password string and +try them one by one until a match is located (or all combinations fail). +</para> + +<para> +The best option to adopt is to enable support for encrypted passwords +where ever Samba is used. There are three configuration possibilities +for support of encrypted passwords: +</para> + +</sect3> +<sect3> +<title>Use MS Windows NT as an authentication server</title> + +<para> +This method involves the additions of the following parameters in the &smb.conf; file: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + encrypt passwords = Yes + security = server + password server = "NetBIOS_name_of_PDC" +</programlisting></para> + + +<para> +There are two ways of identifying whether or not a username and +password pair was valid or not. One uses the reply information provided +as part of the authentication messaging process, the other uses +just an error code. +</para> + +<para> +The down-side of this mode of configuration is the fact that +for security reasons Samba will send the password server a bogus +username and a bogus password and if the remote server fails to +reject the username and password pair then an alternative mode +of identification of validation is used. Where a site uses password +lock out after a certain number of failed authentication attempts +this will result in user lockouts. +</para> + +<para> +Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be +a standard Unix account for the user, this account can be blocked +to prevent logons by other than MS Windows clients. +</para> + +</sect3> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>Domain Level Security</title> + +<para> +When samba is operating in <emphasis>security = domain</emphasis> mode this means that +the Samba server has a domain security trust account (a machine account) and will cause +all authentication requests to be passed through to the domain controllers. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>Samba as a member of an MS Windows NT security domain</title> + +<para> +This method involves addition of the following parameters in the &smb.conf; file: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + encrypt passwords = Yes + security = domain + workgroup = "name of NT domain" + password server = * +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The use of the "*" argument to <command>password server</command> will cause samba to locate the +domain controller in a way analogous to the way this is done within MS Windows NT. +This is the default behaviour. +</para> + +<para> +In order for this method to work the Samba server needs to join the +MS Windows NT security domain. This is done as follows: +</para> + +<itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>On the MS Windows NT domain controller using + the Server Manager add a machine account for the Samba server. + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Next, on the Linux system execute: + <command>smbpasswd -r PDC_NAME -j DOMAIN_NAME</command> (samba 2.x) + + <command>net join -U administrator%password</command> (samba-3) + </para></listitem> +</itemizedlist> + +<para> +Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard Unix account +for the user in order to assign a uid once the account has been authenticated by +the remote Windows DC. This account can be blocked to prevent logons by clients other than +MS Windows through things such as setting an invalid shell in the +<filename>/etc/passwd</filename> entry. +</para> + +<para> +An alternative to assigning UIDs to Windows users on a Samba member server is +presented in the <link linkend="winbind">Winbind Overview</link> chapter +in this HOWTO collection. +</para> + +</sect3> +</sect2> + +<sect2> +<title>ADS Level Security</title> + +<para> +For information about the configuration option please refer to the entire section entitled +<emphasis>Samba as an ADS Domain Member.</emphasis> +</para> + +</sect2> +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/unicode.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/unicode.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..2351668e565 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/unicode.xml @@ -0,0 +1,142 @@ +<chapter id="unicode"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jelmer; + <author> + <firstname>TAKAHASHI</firstname><surname>Motonobu</surname> + <affiliation> + <address><email>monyo@home.monyo.com</email></address> + </affiliation> + </author> + <pubdate>25 March 2003</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Unicode/Charsets</title> + +<sect1> +<title>What are charsets and unicode?</title> + +<para> +Computers communicate in numbers. In texts, each number will be +translated to a corresponding letter. The meaning that will be assigned +to a certain number depends on the <emphasis>character set(charset) +</emphasis> that is used. +A charset can be seen as a table that is used to translate numbers to +letters. Not all computers use the same charset (there are charsets +with German umlauts, Japanese characters, etc). Usually a charset contains +256 characters, which means that storing a character with it takes +exactly one byte. </para> + +<para> +There are also charsets that support even more characters, +but those need twice(or even more) as much storage space. These +charsets can contain <command>256 * 256 = 65536</command> characters, which +is more then all possible characters one could think of. They are called +multibyte charsets (because they use more then one byte to +store one character). +</para> + +<para> +A standardised multibyte charset is unicode, info is available at +<ulink url="http://www.unicode.org/">www.unicode.org</ulink>. +A big advantage of using a multibyte charset is that you only need one; no +need to make sure two computers use the same charset when they are +communicating. +</para> + +<para>Old windows clients used to use single-byte charsets, named +'codepages' by microsoft. However, there is no support for +negotiating the charset to be used in the smb protocol. Thus, you +have to make sure you are using the same charset when talking to an old client. +Newer clients (Windows NT, 2K, XP) talk unicode over the wire. +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Samba and charsets</title> + +<para> +As of samba 3.0, samba can (and will) talk unicode over the wire. Internally, +samba knows of three kinds of character sets: +</para> + +<variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>unix charset</term> + <listitem><para> + This is the charset used internally by your operating system. + The default is <constant>ASCII</constant>, which is fine for most + systems. + </para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>display charset</term> + <listitem><para>This is the charset samba will use to print messages + on your screen. It should generally be the same as the <command>unix charset</command>. + </para></listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>dos charset</term> + <listitem><para>This is the charset samba uses when communicating with + DOS and Windows 9x clients. It will talk unicode to all newer clients. + The default depends on the charsets you have installed on your system. + Run <command>testparm -v | grep "dos charset"</command> to see + what the default is on your system. + </para></listitem> + </varlistentry> +</variablelist> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Conversion from old names</title> + +<para>Because previous samba versions did not do any charset conversion, +characters in filenames are usually not correct in the unix charset but only +for the local charset used by the DOS/Windows clients.</para> + +<para>The following script from Steve Langasek converts all +filenames from CP850 to the iso8859-15 charset.</para> + +<para> +<prompt>#</prompt><userinput>find <replaceable>/path/to/share</replaceable> -type f -exec bash -c 'CP="{}"; ISO=`echo -n "$CP" | iconv -f cp850 \ + -t iso8859-15`; if [ "$CP" != "$ISO" ]; then mv "$CP" "$ISO"; fi' \; +</userinput> +</para> +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Japanese charsets</title> + +<para>Samba doesn't work correctly with Japanese charsets yet. Here are +points of attention when setting it up:</para> + +<itemizedlist> + +<listitem><para>You should set <command>mangling method = +hash</command></para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>There are various iconv() implementations around and not +all of them work equally well. glibc2's iconv() has a critical problem +in CP932. libiconv-1.8 works with CP932 but still has some problems and +does not work with EUC-JP.</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>You should set <command>dos charset = CP932</command>, not +Shift_JIS, SJIS...</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>Currently only <command>unix charset = CP932</command> +will work (but still has some problems...) because of iconv() issues. +<command>unix charset = EUC-JP</command> doesn't work well because of +iconv() issues.</para></listitem> + +<listitem><para>Currently Samba 3.0 does not support <command>unix charset += UTF8-MAC/CAP/HEX/JIS*</command></para></listitem> + +</itemizedlist> + +<para>More information (in Japanese) is available at: <ulink url="http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html">http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html</ulink>.</para> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/upgrading-to-3.0.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/upgrading-to-3.0.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..3dc4816664e --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/upgrading-to-3.0.xml @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +<chapter id="upgrading-to-3.0"> +<chapterinfo> + &author.jelmer; + <pubdate>25 October 2002</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Issues when upgrading from 2.2 to 3.0</title> + +<sect1> +<title>Charsets</title> + +<para>You might experience problems with special characters +when communicating with old DOS clients. Codepage +support has changed in samba 3.0. Read the chapter +<link linkend="unicode">Unicode support</link> for details. +</para> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> +<title>Obsolete configuration options</title> + +<para> +In 3.0, the following configuration options have been removed. +</para> + +<simplelist> +<member>printer driver (replaced by new driver procedures) </member> +<member>printer driver file (replaced by new driver procedures)</member> +<member>printer driver location (replaced by new driver procedures)</member> +<member>use rhosts</member> +<member>postscript</member> +<member>client code page (replaced by dos charset)</member> +</simplelist> +</sect1> +</chapter> diff --git a/docs/docbook/projdoc/winbind.xml b/docs/docbook/projdoc/winbind.xml new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..cb6a56687dc --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/docbook/projdoc/winbind.xml @@ -0,0 +1,1169 @@ +<chapter id="winbind"> + +<chapterinfo> + <authorgroup> + <author> + <firstname>Tim</firstname><surname>Potter</surname> + <affiliation> + <orgname>Samba Team</orgname> + <address><email>tpot@linuxcare.com.au</email></address> + </affiliation> + </author> + &author.tridge; + &author.jht; + <author> + <firstname>Naag</firstname><surname>Mummaneni</surname> + <affiliation> + <address><email>getnag@rediffmail.com</email></address> + </affiliation> + </author> + &author.jelmer; + </authorgroup> + <pubdate>27 June 2002</pubdate> +</chapterinfo> + +<title>Unified Logons between Windows NT and UNIX using Winbind</title> + +<sect1> + <title>Abstract</title> + + <para>Integration of UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT through + a unified logon has been considered a "holy grail" in heterogeneous + computing environments for a long time. We present + <emphasis>winbind</emphasis>, a component of the Samba suite + of programs as a solution to the unified logon problem. Winbind + uses a UNIX implementation + of Microsoft RPC calls, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and the Name + Service Switch to allow Windows NT domain users to appear and operate + as UNIX users on a UNIX machine. This paper describes the winbind + system, explaining the functionality it provides, how it is configured, + and how it works internally.</para> +</sect1> + + +<sect1> + <title>Introduction</title> + + <para>It is well known that UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT have + different models for representing user and group information and + use different technologies for implementing them. This fact has + made it difficult to integrate the two systems in a satisfactory + manner.</para> + + <para>One common solution in use today has been to create + identically named user accounts on both the UNIX and Windows systems + and use the Samba suite of programs to provide file and print services + between the two. This solution is far from perfect however, as + adding and deleting users on both sets of machines becomes a chore + and two sets of passwords are required both of which + can lead to synchronization problems between the UNIX and Windows + systems and confusion for users.</para> + + <para>We divide the unified logon problem for UNIX machines into + three smaller problems:</para> + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Obtaining Windows NT user and group information + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Authenticating Windows NT users + </para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>Password changing for Windows NT users + </para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + + <para>Ideally, a prospective solution to the unified logon problem + would satisfy all the above components without duplication of + information on the UNIX machines and without creating additional + tasks for the system administrator when maintaining users and + groups on either system. The winbind system provides a simple + and elegant solution to all three components of the unified logon + problem.</para> +</sect1> + + +<sect1> + <title>What Winbind Provides</title> + + <para>Winbind unifies UNIX and Windows NT account management by + allowing a UNIX box to become a full member of a NT domain. Once + this is done the UNIX box will see NT users and groups as if + they were native UNIX users and groups, allowing the NT domain + to be used in much the same manner that NIS+ is used within + UNIX-only environments.</para> + + <para>The end result is that whenever any + program on the UNIX machine asks the operating system to lookup + a user or group name, the query will be resolved by asking the + NT domain controller for the specified domain to do the lookup. + Because Winbind hooks into the operating system at a low level + (via the NSS name resolution modules in the C library) this + redirection to the NT domain controller is completely + transparent.</para> + + <para>Users on the UNIX machine can then use NT user and group + names as they would use "native" UNIX names. They can chown files + so that they are owned by NT domain users or even login to the + UNIX machine and run a UNIX X-Window session as a domain user.</para> + + <para>The only obvious indication that Winbind is being used is + that user and group names take the form DOMAIN\user and + DOMAIN\group. This is necessary as it allows Winbind to determine + that redirection to a domain controller is wanted for a particular + lookup and which trusted domain is being referenced.</para> + + <para>Additionally, Winbind provides an authentication service + that hooks into the Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) system + to provide authentication via a NT domain to any PAM enabled + applications. This capability solves the problem of synchronizing + passwords between systems since all passwords are stored in a single + location (on the domain controller).</para> + + <sect2> + <title>Target Uses</title> + + <para>Winbind is targeted at organizations that have an + existing NT based domain infrastructure into which they wish + to put UNIX workstations or servers. Winbind will allow these + organizations to deploy UNIX workstations without having to + maintain a separate account infrastructure. This greatly + simplifies the administrative overhead of deploying UNIX + workstations into a NT based organization.</para> + + <para>Another interesting way in which we expect Winbind to + be used is as a central part of UNIX based appliances. Appliances + that provide file and print services to Microsoft based networks + will be able to use Winbind to provide seamless integration of + the appliance into the domain.</para> + </sect2> +</sect1> + + + +<sect1> + <title>How Winbind Works</title> + + <para>The winbind system is designed around a client/server + architecture. A long running <command>winbindd</command> daemon + listens on a UNIX domain socket waiting for requests + to arrive. These requests are generated by the NSS and PAM + clients and processed sequentially.</para> + + <para>The technologies used to implement winbind are described + in detail below.</para> + + <sect2> + <title>Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</title> + + <para>Over the last few years, efforts have been underway + by various Samba Team members to decode various aspects of + the Microsoft Remote Procedure Call (MSRPC) system. This + system is used for most network related operations between + Windows NT machines including remote management, user authentication + and print spooling. Although initially this work was done + to aid the implementation of Primary Domain Controller (PDC) + functionality in Samba, it has also yielded a body of code which + can be used for other purposes.</para> + + <para>Winbind uses various MSRPC calls to enumerate domain users + and groups and to obtain detailed information about individual + users or groups. Other MSRPC calls can be used to authenticate + NT domain users and to change user passwords. By directly querying + a Windows PDC for user and group information, winbind maps the + NT account information onto UNIX user and group names.</para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Microsoft Active Directory Services</title> + + <para> + Since late 2001, Samba has gained the ability to + interact with Microsoft Windows 2000 using its 'Native + Mode' protocols, rather than the NT4 RPC services. + Using LDAP and Kerberos, a domain member running + winbind can enumerate users and groups in exactly the + same way as a Win2k client would, and in so doing + provide a much more efficient and + effective winbind implementation. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Name Service Switch</title> + + <para>The Name Service Switch, or NSS, is a feature that is + present in many UNIX operating systems. It allows system + information such as hostnames, mail aliases and user information + to be resolved from different sources. For example, a standalone + UNIX workstation may resolve system information from a series of + flat files stored on the local filesystem. A networked workstation + may first attempt to resolve system information from local files, + and then consult a NIS database for user information or a DNS server + for hostname information.</para> + + <para>The NSS application programming interface allows winbind + to present itself as a source of system information when + resolving UNIX usernames and groups. Winbind uses this interface, + and information obtained from a Windows NT server using MSRPC + calls to provide a new source of account enumeration. Using standard + UNIX library calls, one can enumerate the users and groups on + a UNIX machine running winbind and see all users and groups in + a NT domain plus any trusted domain as though they were local + users and groups.</para> + + <para>The primary control file for NSS is + <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename>. + When a UNIX application makes a request to do a lookup + the C library looks in <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> + for a line which matches the service type being requested, for + example the "passwd" service type is used when user or group names + are looked up. This config line species which implementations + of that service should be tried and in what order. If the passwd + config line is:</para> + + <para><command>passwd: files example</command></para> + + <para>then the C library will first load a module called + <filename>/lib/libnss_files.so</filename> followed by + the module <filename>/lib/libnss_example.so</filename>. The + C library will dynamically load each of these modules in turn + and call resolver functions within the modules to try to resolve + the request. Once the request is resolved the C library returns the + result to the application.</para> + + <para>This NSS interface provides a very easy way for Winbind + to hook into the operating system. All that needs to be done + is to put <filename>libnss_winbind.so</filename> in <filename>/lib/</filename> + then add "winbind" into <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> at + the appropriate place. The C library will then call Winbind to + resolve user and group names.</para> + </sect2> + + <sect2> + <title>Pluggable Authentication Modules</title> + + <para>Pluggable Authentication Modules, also known as PAM, + is a system for abstracting authentication and authorization + technologies. With a PAM module it is possible to specify different + authentication methods for different system applications without + having to recompile these applications. PAM is also useful + for implementing a particular policy for authorization. For example, + a system administrator may only allow console logins from users + stored in the local password file but only allow users resolved from + a NIS database to log in over the network.</para> + + <para>Winbind uses the authentication management and password + management PAM interface to integrate Windows NT users into a + UNIX system. This allows Windows NT users to log in to a UNIX + machine and be authenticated against a suitable Primary Domain + Controller. These users can also change their passwords and have + this change take effect directly on the Primary Domain Controller. + </para> + + <para>PAM is configured by providing control files in the directory + <filename>/etc/pam.d/</filename> for each of the services that + require authentication. When an authentication request is made + by an application the PAM code in the C library looks up this + control file to determine what modules to load to do the + authentication check and in what order. This interface makes adding + a new authentication service for Winbind very easy, all that needs + to be done is that the <filename>pam_winbind.so</filename> module + is copied to <filename>/lib/security/</filename> and the PAM + control files for relevant services are updated to allow + authentication via winbind. See the PAM documentation + for more details.</para> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>User and Group ID Allocation</title> + + <para>When a user or group is created under Windows NT + is it allocated a numerical relative identifier (RID). This is + slightly different to UNIX which has a range of numbers that are + used to identify users, and the same range in which to identify + groups. It is winbind's job to convert RIDs to UNIX id numbers and + vice versa. When winbind is configured it is given part of the UNIX + user id space and a part of the UNIX group id space in which to + store Windows NT users and groups. If a Windows NT user is + resolved for the first time, it is allocated the next UNIX id from + the range. The same process applies for Windows NT groups. Over + time, winbind will have mapped all Windows NT users and groups + to UNIX user ids and group ids.</para> + + <para>The results of this mapping are stored persistently in + an ID mapping database held in a tdb database). This ensures that + RIDs are mapped to UNIX IDs in a consistent way.</para> + </sect2> + + + <sect2> + <title>Result Caching</title> + + <para>An active system can generate a lot of user and group + name lookups. To reduce the network cost of these lookups winbind + uses a caching scheme based on the SAM sequence number supplied + by NT domain controllers. User or group information returned + by a PDC is cached by winbind along with a sequence number also + returned by the PDC. This sequence number is incremented by + Windows NT whenever any user or group information is modified. If + a cached entry has expired, the sequence number is requested from + the PDC and compared against the sequence number of the cached entry. + If the sequence numbers do not match, then the cached information + is discarded and up to date information is requested directly + from the PDC.</para> + </sect2> +</sect1> + + +<sect1> + <title>Installation and Configuration</title> + +<para> +Many thanks to John Trostel <ulink +url="mailto:jtrostel@snapserver.com">jtrostel@snapserver.com</ulink> +for providing the HOWTO for this section. +</para> + +<para> +This HOWTO describes how to get winbind services up and running +to control access and authenticate users on your Linux box using +the winbind services which come with SAMBA 3.0. +</para> + +<sect2> +<title>Introduction</title> + +<para> +This HOWTO describes the procedures used to get winbind up and +running on my RedHat 7.1 system. Winbind is capable of providing access +and authentication control for Windows Domain users through an NT +or Win2K PDC for 'regular' services, such as telnet a nd ftp, as +well for SAMBA services. +</para> + +<para> +This HOWTO has been written from a 'RedHat-centric' perspective, so if +you are using another distribution, you may have to modify the instructions +somewhat to fit the way your distribution works. +</para> + + +<itemizedlist> +<listitem> + <para> + <emphasis>Why should I to this?</emphasis> + </para> + + <para>This allows the SAMBA administrator to rely on the + authentication mechanisms on the NT/Win2K PDC for the authentication + of domain members. NT/Win2K users no longer need to have separate + accounts on the SAMBA server. + </para> +</listitem> + +<listitem> + <para> + <emphasis>Who should be reading this document?</emphasis> + </para> + + <para> + This HOWTO is designed for system administrators. If you are + implementing SAMBA on a file server and wish to (fairly easily) + integrate existing NT/Win2K users from your PDC onto the + SAMBA server, this HOWTO is for you. That said, I am no NT or PAM + expert, so you may find a better or easier way to accomplish + these tasks. + </para> +</listitem> +</itemizedlist> +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title>Requirements</title> + +<para> +If you have a samba configuration file that you are currently +using... <emphasis>BACK IT UP!</emphasis> If your system already uses PAM, +<emphasis>back up the <filename>/etc/pam.d</filename> directory +contents!</emphasis> If you haven't already made a boot disk, +<emphasis>MAKE ONE NOW!</emphasis> +</para> + +<para> +Messing with the pam configuration files can make it nearly impossible +to log in to yourmachine. That's why you want to be able to boot back +into your machine in single user mode and restore your +<filename>/etc/pam.d</filename> back to the original state they were in if +you get frustrated with the way things are going. ;-) +</para> + +<para> +The latest version of SAMBA (version 3.0 as of this writing), now +includes a functioning winbindd daemon. Please refer to the +<ulink url="http://samba.org/">main SAMBA web page</ulink> or, +better yet, your closest SAMBA mirror site for instructions on +downloading the source code. +</para> + +<para> +To allow Domain users the ability to access SAMBA shares and +files, as well as potentially other services provided by your +SAMBA machine, PAM (pluggable authentication modules) must +be setup properly on your machine. In order to compile the +winbind modules, you should have at least the pam libraries resident +on your system. For recent RedHat systems (7.1, for instance), that +means <filename>pam-0.74-22</filename>. For best results, it is helpful to also +install the development packages in <filename>pam-devel-0.74-22</filename>. +</para> + +</sect2> + + +<sect2> +<title>Testing Things Out</title> + +<para> +Before starting, it is probably best to kill off all the SAMBA +related daemons running on your server. Kill off all <command>smbd</command>, +<command>nmbd</command>, and <command>winbindd</command> processes that may +be running. To use PAM, you will want to make sure that you have the +standard PAM package (for RedHat) which supplies the <filename>/etc/pam.d</filename> +directory structure, including the pam modules are used by pam-aware +services, several pam libraries, and the <filename>/usr/doc</filename> +and <filename>/usr/man</filename> entries for pam. Winbind built better +in SAMBA if the pam-devel package was also installed. This package includes +the header files needed to compile pam-aware applications. For instance, +my RedHat system has both <filename>pam-0.74-22</filename> and +<filename>pam-devel-0.74-22</filename> RPMs installed. +</para> + +<sect3> +<title>Configure and compile SAMBA</title> + +<para> +The configuration and compilation of SAMBA is pretty straightforward. +The first three steps may not be necessary depending upon +whether or not you have previously built the Samba binaries. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>autoconf</command> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>make clean</command> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>rm config.cache</command> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>./configure</command> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>make</command> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>make install</command> +</programlisting></para> + + +<para> +This will, by default, install SAMBA in <filename>/usr/local/samba</filename>. +See the main SAMBA documentation if you want to install SAMBA somewhere else. +It will also build the winbindd executable and libraries. +</para> + +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Configure <filename>nsswitch.conf</filename> and the +winbind libraries on Linux and Solaris</title> + +<para> +The libraries needed to run the <command>winbindd</command> daemon +through nsswitch need to be copied to their proper locations, so +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/libnss_winbind.so /lib</command> +</para> + +<para> +I also found it necessary to make the following symbolic link: +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>ln -s /lib/libnss_winbind.so /lib/libnss_winbind.so.2</command> +</para> + +<para>And, in the case of Sun solaris:</para> +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <userinput>ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</userinput> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <userinput>ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/nss_winbind.so.1</userinput> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <userinput>ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/nss_winbind.so.2</userinput> +</para> + +<para> +Now, as root you need to edit <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> to +allow user and group entries to be visible from the <command>winbindd</command> +daemon. My <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> file look like +this after editing: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + passwd: files winbind + shadow: files + group: files winbind +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The libraries needed by the winbind daemon will be automatically +entered into the <command>ldconfig</command> cache the next time +your system reboots, but it +is faster (and you don't need to reboot) if you do it manually: +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>/sbin/ldconfig -v | grep winbind</command> +</para> + +<para> +This makes <filename>libnss_winbind</filename> available to winbindd +and echos back a check to you. +</para> + +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>NSS Winbind on AIX</title> + +<para>(This section is only for those running AIX)</para> + +<para> +The winbind AIX identification module gets built as libnss_winbind.so in the +nsswitch directory of the samba source. This file can be copied to +/usr/lib/security, and the AIX naming convention would indicate that it +should be named WINBIND. A stanza like the following: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +WINBIND: + program = /usr/lib/security/WINBIND + options = authonly +</programlisting></para> + +<para>can then be added to +<filename>/usr/lib/security/methods.cfg</filename>. This module only +supports identification, but there have been success reports using the +standard winbind pam module for authentication. Use caution configuring +loadable authentication modules as it is possible to make it impossible +to logon to the system. More information about the AIX authentication +module API can be found at "Kernel Extensions and Device Support +Programming Concepts for AIX": <ulink +url="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixprggd/kernextc/sec_load_mod.htm"> +Chapter 18. Loadable Authentication Module Programming Interface</ulink> +and more information on administering the modules at <ulink +url="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixbman/baseadmn/iandaadmin.htm"> +"System Management Guide: Operating System and Devices"</ulink>. +</para> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Configure smb.conf</title> + +<para> +Several parameters are needed in the smb.conf file to control +the behavior of <command>winbindd</command>. Configure +<filename>smb.conf</filename> These are described in more detail in +the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle> +<manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> man page. My +<filename>smb.conf</filename> file was modified to +include the following entries in the [global] section: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +[global] + <...> + # separate domain and username with '+', like DOMAIN+username + <ulink url="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR">winbind separator</ulink> = + + # use uids from 10000 to 20000 for domain users + <ulink url="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDUID">winbind uid</ulink> = 10000-20000 + # use gids from 10000 to 20000 for domain groups + <ulink url="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDGID">winbind gid</ulink> = 10000-20000 + # allow enumeration of winbind users and groups + <ulink url="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMUSERS">winbind enum users</ulink> = yes + <ulink url="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMGROUP">winbind enum groups</ulink> = yes + # give winbind users a real shell (only needed if they have telnet access) + <ulink url="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR">template homedir</ulink> = /home/winnt/%D/%U + <ulink url="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATESHELL">template shell</ulink> = /bin/bash +</programlisting></para> + +</sect3> + + +<sect3> +<title>Join the SAMBA server to the PDC domain</title> + +<para> +Enter the following command to make the SAMBA server join the +PDC domain, where <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable> is the name of +your Windows domain and <replaceable>Administrator</replaceable> is +a domain user who has administrative privileges in the domain. +</para> + + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>/usr/local/samba/bin/net join -S PDC -U Administrator</command> +</para> + + +<para> +The proper response to the command should be: "Joined the domain +<replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable>" where <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable> +is your DOMAIN name. +</para> + +</sect3> + + +<sect3> +<title>Start up the winbindd daemon and test it!</title> + +<para> +Eventually, you will want to modify your smb startup script to +automatically invoke the winbindd daemon when the other parts of +SAMBA start, but it is possible to test out just the winbind +portion first. To start up winbind services, enter the following +command as root: +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>/usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd</command> +</para> + +<para> +Winbindd can now also run in 'dual daemon mode'. This will make it +run as 2 processes. The first will answer all requests from the cache, +thus making responses to clients faster. The other will +update the cache for the query that the first has just responded. +Advantage of this is that responses stay accurate and are faster. +You can enable dual daemon mode by adding '-B' to the commandline: +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>/usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B</command> +</para> + +<para> +I'm always paranoid and like to make sure the daemon +is really running... +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>ps -ae | grep winbindd</command> +</para> +<para> +This command should produce output like this, if the daemon is running +</para> +<para> +3025 ? 00:00:00 winbindd +</para> + +<para> +Now... for the real test, try to get some information about the +users on your PDC +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>/usr/local/samba/bin/wbinfo -u</command> +</para> + +<para> +This should echo back a list of users on your Windows users on +your PDC. For example, I get the following response: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + CEO+Administrator + CEO+burdell + CEO+Guest + CEO+jt-ad + CEO+krbtgt + CEO+TsInternetUser +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Obviously, I have named my domain 'CEO' and my <parameter>winbind +separator</parameter> is '+'. +</para> + +<para> +You can do the same sort of thing to get group information from +the PDC: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>/usr/local/samba/bin/wbinfo -g</command> + CEO+Domain Admins + CEO+Domain Users + CEO+Domain Guests + CEO+Domain Computers + CEO+Domain Controllers + CEO+Cert Publishers + CEO+Schema Admins + CEO+Enterprise Admins + CEO+Group Policy Creator Owners +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The function 'getent' can now be used to get unified +lists of both local and PDC users and groups. +Try the following command: +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>getent passwd</command> +</para> + +<para> +You should get a list that looks like your <filename>/etc/passwd</filename> +list followed by the domain users with their new uids, gids, home +directories and default shells. +</para> + +<para> +The same thing can be done for groups with the command +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>getent group</command> +</para> + +</sect3> + + +<sect3> +<title>Fix the init.d startup scripts</title> + +<sect4> +<title>Linux</title> + +<para> +The <command>winbindd</command> daemon needs to start up after the +<command>smbd</command> and <command>nmbd</command> daemons are running. +To accomplish this task, you need to modify the startup scripts of your system. +They are located at <filename>/etc/init.d/smb</filename> in RedHat and +<filename>/etc/init.d/samba</filename> in Debian. +script to add commands to invoke this daemon in the proper sequence. My +startup script starts up <command>smbd</command>, +<command>nmbd</command>, and <command>winbindd</command> from the +<filename>/usr/local/samba/bin</filename> directory directly. The 'start' +function in the script looks like this: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +start() { + KIND="SMB" + echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd $SMBDOPTIONS + RETVAL=$? + echo + KIND="NMB" + echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd $NMBDOPTIONS + RETVAL2=$? + echo + KIND="Winbind" + echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd + RETVAL3=$? + echo + [ $RETVAL -eq 0 -a $RETVAL2 -eq 0 -a $RETVAL3 -eq 0 ] && \ + touch /var/lock/subsys/smb || RETVAL=1 + return $RETVAL +} +</programlisting></para> + +<para>If you would like to run winbindd in dual daemon mode, replace +the line +<programlisting> + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd +</programlisting> + +in the example above with: + +<programlisting> + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B +</programlisting>. +</para> + +<para> +The 'stop' function has a corresponding entry to shut down the +services and looks like this: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> +stop() { + KIND="SMB" + echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " + killproc smbd + RETVAL=$? + echo + KIND="NMB" + echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " + killproc nmbd + RETVAL2=$? + echo + KIND="Winbind" + echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " + killproc winbindd + RETVAL3=$? + [ $RETVAL -eq 0 -a $RETVAL2 -eq 0 -a $RETVAL3 -eq 0 ] && \ + rm -f /var/lock/subsys/smb + echo "" + return $RETVAL +} +</programlisting></para> +</sect4> + +<sect4> +<title>Solaris</title> + +<para>Winbind doesn't work on solaris 9, see the <link linkend="winbind-solaris9">Portability</link> chapter for details.</para> + +<para>On solaris, you need to modify the +<filename>/etc/init.d/samba.server</filename> startup script. It usually +only starts smbd and nmbd but should now start winbindd too. If you +have samba installed in <filename>/usr/local/samba/bin</filename>, +the file could contains something like this: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + ## + ## samba.server + ## + + if [ ! -d /usr/bin ] + then # /usr not mounted + exit + fi + + killproc() { # kill the named process(es) + pid=`/usr/bin/ps -e | + /usr/bin/grep -w $1 | + /usr/bin/sed -e 's/^ *//' -e 's/ .*//'` + [ "$pid" != "" ] && kill $pid + } + + # Start/stop processes required for samba server + + case "$1" in + + 'start') + # + # Edit these lines to suit your installation (paths, workgroup, host) + # + echo Starting SMBD + /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -D -s \ + /usr/local/samba/smb.conf + + echo Starting NMBD + /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd -D -l \ + /usr/local/samba/var/log -s /usr/local/samba/smb.conf + + echo Starting Winbind Daemon + /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd + ;; + + 'stop') + killproc nmbd + killproc smbd + killproc winbindd + ;; + + *) + echo "Usage: /etc/init.d/samba.server { start | stop }" + ;; + esac +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +Again, if you would like to run samba in dual daemon mode, replace +<programlisting> + /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd +</programlisting> + +in the script above with: + +<programlisting> + /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B +</programlisting> +</para> + +</sect4> + +<sect4> +<title>Restarting</title> +<para> +If you restart the <command>smbd</command>, <command>nmbd</command>, +and <command>winbindd</command> daemons at this point, you +should be able to connect to the samba server as a domain member just as +if you were a local user. +</para> +</sect4> +</sect3> + +<sect3> +<title>Configure Winbind and PAM</title> + +<para> +If you have made it this far, you know that winbindd and samba are working +together. If you want to use winbind to provide authentication for other +services, keep reading. The pam configuration files need to be altered in +this step. (Did you remember to make backups of your original +<filename>/etc/pam.d</filename> files? If not, do it now.) +</para> + +<para> +You will need a pam module to use winbindd with these other services. This +module will be compiled in the <filename>../source/nsswitch</filename> directory +by invoking the command +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>make nsswitch/pam_winbind.so</command> +</para> + +<para> +from the <filename>../source</filename> directory. The +<filename>pam_winbind.so</filename> file should be copied to the location of +your other pam security modules. On my RedHat system, this was the +<filename>/lib/security</filename> directory. On Solaris, the pam security +modules reside in <filename>/usr/lib/security</filename>. +</para> + +<para> +<prompt>root#</prompt> <command>cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/pam_winbind.so /lib/security</command> +</para> + +<sect4> +<title>Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</title> + +<para> +The <filename>/etc/pam.d/samba</filename> file does not need to be changed. I +just left this fileas it was: +</para> + + +<para><programlisting> + auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth + account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The other services that I modified to allow the use of winbind +as an authentication service were the normal login on the console (or a terminal +session), telnet logins, and ftp service. In order to enable these +services, you may first need to change the entries in +<filename>/etc/xinetd.d</filename> (or <filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename>). +RedHat 7.1 uses the new xinetd.d structure, in this case you need +to change the lines in <filename>/etc/xinetd.d/telnet</filename> +and <filename>/etc/xinetd.d/wu-ftp</filename> from +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + enable = no +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +to +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + enable = yes +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +For ftp services to work properly, you will also need to either +have individual directories for the domain users already present on +the server, or change the home directory template to a general +directory for all domain users. These can be easily set using +the <filename>smb.conf</filename> global entry +<command>template homedir</command>. +</para> + +<para> +The <filename>/etc/pam.d/ftp</filename> file can be changed +to allow winbind ftp access in a manner similar to the +samba file. My <filename>/etc/pam.d/ftp</filename> file was +changed to look like this: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + auth required /lib/security/pam_listfile.so item=user sense=deny \ + file=/etc/ftpusers onerr=succeed + auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so + auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth + auth required /lib/security/pam_shells.so + account sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so + account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth + session required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +The <filename>/etc/pam.d/login</filename> file can be changed nearly the +same way. It now looks like this: +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so + auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so + auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass + auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth + auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so + account sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so + account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth + password required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth + session required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth + session optional /lib/security/pam_console.so +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +In this case, I added the <command>auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so</command> +lines as before, but also added the <command>required pam_securetty.so</command> +above it, to disallow root logins over the network. I also added a +<command>sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass</command> +line after the <command>winbind.so</command> line to get rid of annoying +double prompts for passwords. +</para> + +</sect4> + +<sect4> +<title>Solaris-specific configuration</title> + +<para> +The /etc/pam.conf needs to be changed. I changed this file so that my Domain +users can logon both locally as well as telnet.The following are the changes +that I made.You can customize the pam.conf file as per your requirements,but +be sure of those changes because in the worst case it will leave your system +nearly impossible to boot. +</para> + +<para><programlisting> + # + #ident "@(#)pam.conf 1.14 99/09/16 SMI" + # + # Copyright (c) 1996-1999, Sun Microsystems, Inc. + # All Rights Reserved. + # + # PAM configuration + # + # Authentication management + # + login auth required /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so + login auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass + login auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_dial_auth.so.1 try_first_pass + # + rlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so + rlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_rhosts_auth.so.1 + rlogin auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass + # + dtlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so + dtlogin auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass + # + rsh auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_rhosts_auth.so.1 + other auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so + other auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 try_first_pass + # + # Account management + # + login account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so + login account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1 + login account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 + # + dtlogin account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so + dtlogin account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1 + dtlogin account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 + # + other account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so + other account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1 + other account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 + # + # Session management + # + other session required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 + # + # Password management + # + #other password sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so + other password required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 + dtsession auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_unix.so.1 + # + # Support for Kerberos V5 authentication (uncomment to use Kerberos) + # + #rlogin auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass + #login auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass + #dtlogin auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass + #other auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass + #dtlogin account optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 + #other account optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 + #other session optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 + #other password optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass +</programlisting></para> + +<para> +I also added a try_first_pass line after the winbind.so line to get rid of +annoying double prompts for passwords. +</para> + +<para> +Now restart your Samba and try connecting through your application that you +configured in the pam.conf. +</para> + +</sect4> + +</sect3> + +</sect2> + +</sect1> + +<sect1> + <title>Limitations</title> + + <para>Winbind has a number of limitations in its current + released version that we hope to overcome in future + releases:</para> + + <itemizedlist> + <listitem><para>Winbind is currently only available for + the Linux, Solaris and IRIX operating systems, although ports to other operating + systems are certainly possible. For such ports to be feasible, + we require the C library of the target operating system to + support the Name Service Switch and Pluggable Authentication + Modules systems. This is becoming more common as NSS and + PAM gain support among UNIX vendors.</para></listitem> + + <listitem><para>The mappings of Windows NT RIDs to UNIX ids + is not made algorithmically and depends on the order in which + unmapped users or groups are seen by winbind. It may be difficult + to recover the mappings of rid to UNIX id mapping if the file + containing this information is corrupted or destroyed.</para> + </listitem> + + <listitem><para>Currently the winbind PAM module does not take + into account possible workstation and logon time restrictions + that may be been set for Windows NT users, this is + instead up to the PDC to enforce.</para></listitem> + </itemizedlist> +</sect1> + + +<sect1> + <title>Conclusion</title> + + <para>The winbind system, through the use of the Name Service + Switch, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and appropriate + Microsoft RPC calls have allowed us to provide seamless + integration of Microsoft Windows NT domain users on a + UNIX system. The result is a great reduction in the administrative + cost of running a mixed UNIX and NT network.</para> + +</sect1> + +</chapter> |